o . n o * . » * i * r "» * • o. : J% • • » .\ F * • > < ' 1 1 l0 V .li* " • • • . "oV* L^ .*'** "^ ,Q V # n « * o. m a A& >^, ^o i> :M$^« & *LLL>+ *> i>V t • o • «^ o, * * v ^ V-o^ r oV W cr o $> - N O ^ 1 * q, *•,••• A *$> ^0* \Ac*ftt*»« <**«>. rt*. w<* 9 t>* «*«*. THE CONQUEST OF FLORIDA, BY HERNANDO DE SOTO. BY THEODOKE IKYING, M.A. Son quattromila, e bene armati e bene Instrutti, usi al disagio e tolleranti. Buona e Ja gente, e non pub da piu dotta O da piii forte guida esser condotta.— Tasso. COMPLETE IN ONE VOLUME. NEW- YORK: GEORGE P. PUTNAM, 155 BROADWAY 1851. ! J * • Entered, according to Act of Congress, in the year 1851, by Theodore Irving, in the Clerk's Office of the District Court for the Southern District of New- York. JOHN F. TROW, gutter aitir JStmotjjptr ^w/""") 49 Ann-Street V \ J\ . * . v *• j- y \ \ ,-\ - . - "» *~r ; • %. \ , DEDICATION. TO WASHINGTON IBVING-, Esq. My Dear Uncle : I know of no person to whom I can with more propriety dedicate the following pages than to yourself, since they were written at your suggestion, and the materials of which they are composed were moulded into their present form and feature under your affec- tionate and judicious advice. Often, in the course' of my labors, when I have been dismayed by unlooked for difficulties, and dis- heartened by those misgivings which beset an inexpe- rienced writer, you have dispelled my doubts, cheered forward my faltering spirit, and encouraged me to persevere. vi DEDICATION. I would be pardoned for alluding to other and greater obligations yet nearer to my heart: with, the anxious interest of a parents eye 7 you have watched over the most critical period of my life. Amid the excitement and snares of foreign scenes, and in the quiet employments of our home, your counsels have been my guide — your friendship — the circumstances will excuse the term from one so much your junior — your friendship my happiness and pride. The heedlessness of boyhood could not arrest your assiduous care — the wayward habits of youth have not wearied your un- ceasing solicitude. That I have been thus far led in safety, claims the fervent gratitude of Your affectionate nephew, THEODORE IRVING. PREFACE. While studying the Spanish language, some few years since, at Madrid, an old chronicle was placed in my hands, relating to the early discoveries and achievements of the Spaniards in America. It was denominated " The Florida of the Inca, or the History of the Adelantado, Hernando de Soto, Governor and Captain-Gene- ral of the Kingdom of Florida, and of other heroic cavaliers, Spaniards and Indians : written by the Inca Garcilaso de la Vega." As I read, I became insensibly engrossed by the extra- ordinary enterprise therein narrated : I dwelt with intense interest upon the harebrained adventures and daring exploits of steel-clad warriors, and the no less valiant and chivalrous deeds of savage chieftains, which entitle this narrative to the high praise bestowed upon it by Mr. Southey, of being one of the most delightful works in the Spanish language. While thus employed, I had the good fortune to meet with a narrative on the same subject, written by a Portuguese soldier, who was present in the expedition. This led to further research and closer examination ; and, finding that the striking events and perilous adventures in the chronicles of the Inca were borne viii PREFACE. out, in the main, by this narrative from another hand, and that various lights had been thrown by modern travellers upon the line of march said to have been taken by the adventurous band of De Soto, I was convinced, that what I had before regarded almost as a work of fiction, was an authentic, though, perhaps^ occasionally exaggerated history. Deeming, therefore, that a full account of an expedition which throws such an air of romance over the early history of a portion of our country, would possess interest in the eyes of my countrymen, I resolved, to the best of my abilities, to digest a work from the materials before me. The two main sources from which I have derived my facts, are the narratives already mentioned, by the Inca G-arcilaso de la Vega, and by the anonymous Portuguese adventurer. The for- mer I have consulted in a folio edition, printed in Madrid, in 1723, and in the history of the Indias, by Herrera, in which it is incorporated almost at full length. The Portuguese narrative I have found in an English translation, published in London, in 1686, and in an abridgment in Purchas's Pilgrims. It has been the fashion, in later days, to distrust the narra- tive of the Inca, and to put more faith in that of the Portuguese. This has occasionally been done without due examination into their respective claims to credibility. Grarcilaso de la Yega was a man of rank and honor. He was descended from an ancient Spanish stock by the father's side, while by the mother's, he was of the lofty Peruvian line of the Incas. His narrative was originally taken down by himself, from the lips of a friend ; a cavalier of worth and respectability, who had been an officer un- der De Soto, and for whose probity we have the word of the Inca as a guarantee. It was authenticated and enriched by the writ- PREFACE. is ten journals or memorandums of two other soldiers, who had served in the expedition. He had the testimony, therefore, of three eye-witnesses. The Portuguese narrative, on the other hand, is the evidence of merely a single eye-witness, who gives himself out as a cava- lier, or gentleman ; but for this we have merely his own word, and he is anonymous. There is nothing intrinsic in his work that should entitle it to the exclusive belief that has been claim- ed for it. It agrees with the narrative of the Inca, as to the leading facts which form the framework of the story : it differs from it occasionally, as to the plans and views of Hernando de Soto ; but here the Inca is most to be depended upon — the Spanish cavalier from whom he derived his principal information being more likely to be admitted to the intimate councils of his commander than one of a different nation, and being free from the tinge of national jealousy which may have influenced the statements of the Portuguese. The narrative of the Portuguese is more meagre and con- cise than that of G-arcilaso ; omitting a thousand interesting anecdotes and personal adventures ; but this does not increase its credibility. A multitude of facts, gathered and gleaned from three different persons, may easily have escaped the knowledge, or failed to excite the attention of a solitary individual. These anecdotes are not the less credible because they were striking and extraordinary ; the whole expedition was daring and extra- vagant, and those concerned in it men who delighted in adventure and exploit.* I have been induced, therefore, in the following pages, to * The reader will find a note concerning Garcilaso de la Vega and his work, in the Appendix. PREFACE. draw my facts more freely and copiously than others, in later days, have seemed inclined to do, from the work of the Inca ; still I have scrupulously and diligently collated the two narra- tives, endeavoring to reconcile them where they disagreed, and to ascertain, with strict impartiality, which was most likely to he correct, where they materially varied, and to throw upon the whole subject the scattered lights furnished "by various modern investigators. While I have discarded many incidents which appeared hyperbolical, or which savored too strongly of the gossip of idle soldiery, I have retained, as much as possible, those every-day and familiar anecdotes which give so lively a picture of the characters, habits, persons and manners of the Spanish discoverers of those days, and to my mind bear so strongly the impress of truth and nature. My great object has been to present a clear, connected, and characteristic narrative of this singular expedition : how far I have succeeded, it is for the public to judge. PREFACE TO THE REVISED EDITION. Since publishing the last edition of the Conquest of Florida, much valuable light has been thrown upon the expedition by the investigation of several literary gentlemen residing in our Southern States, and I have been gratified to find, that their statements corroborate, in the main, the account I have given of De Soto's expedition. I am indebted to Gr. R. Fairbanks, Esq., of St. Augustine, for the results of a very careful personal examination of the route of the Spaniards until they reached Apalachee Bay, and have been much aided, by a diagram with which he very kindly furnished me, in tracing the line of march through East Florida. Buckingham Smith, Esq., very politely forwarded me from Washington, the most recent maps of East Florida, and gave me some useful hints with reference to the route of De Soto. 1* SB PREFACE. A valuable article, entitled u Sketches of the History of Ala- bama," by Alexander Meek, Esq., published in the " Southron Monthly Magazine and Review," Jan., 1839, confirms the gene- ral accuracy of my work in regard to localities. Col. Albert J. Pickett, a young author of reputation, at the South, has issued in pamphlet form the first chapter of a History of Alabama he is preparing for the press, and which promises to be a valuable addition to the historical literature of our country.* This chapter is taken up with the Expedition of De Soto, and has been written, as he says, " while armed at all points with the best traditions and authorities." As I have differed from some writers on certain points, it is gratifying to meet the following re- mark in Mr. Pickett's preface. " Theodore Irving, in his Con- quest of Florida, has in a great measure been accurate and faith- ful in describing the route of De Soto, and the incidents attend- ing it." A third account of this expedition, written by Biedma^ Be Soto's commissary, was placed in my hands by Joseph Gr. Gogs- well, Esq., the accomplished and courteous librarian of the Astor Library. It is a confused statement of an illiterate soldier, who. although an eye-witness of what he relates, had not the gift of describing lucidly what he saw, but, so far as his narrative throws any light on the subject, the accuracy of History, as here given, is confirmed. * " The History of Alabama, and incidentally of Georgia and Mississippi," by Albert James Pickett, of Montgomery, Ala., 2 vols. PREFACE. xiii The growing interest manifested in our country for every- thing that tends to clear up the misty annals of our early history, has induced me to prepare a revised edition of my work for the press ; and if it only serves this purpose, I shall be fully rewarded for my labors. Since the publication of the first edition of this work, the war with the native tribes of Florida has occurred ; in which the United States troops have sustained many of the difficulties, hardships and perils sustained by the Spaniards in their adven- turous expedition. The same proud and unyielding spirit was exhibited by the native chiefs, which actuated their ancestors, and called forth the admiration of the Spanish historians. In- deed, the recent Indian campaigns in Florida cast back much illustration and interest on the romantic enterprise of De Soto. CONTENTS. CHAPTERS PAGE I. First discovery of Florida, . . . . 23 II. The expedition of Painphilo de ISTarvaez, . . .28 III. Hernando de Soto — his birth. — Adventures in Peru. — Fits out an armament for Florida. — Touches at the Canary Islands. — Arrival at Cuba, .... 34 IV. Rejoicings of the inhabitants of Cuba on the arrival of De Soto. — Deposition of Nufia Tobar. — Don Vasco Por- callo de Figueroa appointed Lieutenant General of the Forces, . . . . . . .45 V. Juan de Aiiasco twice dispatched to Florida. — His nar- row escape and safe return. — Final preparations of the Governor, . . . . . .49 VI. De Soto meets with an old comrade, Hernan Ponce, much against the will of the latter, . . . .51 VII. The armament sets sail from Cuba. — Arrival and landing in Florida. — Exploit of Vasco Porcallo. — They come upon the first traces of Pamphilo de Narvaez, . . 56 VIII. Story of Juan Ortiz, . . . . .62 IX. Baltazar de Gallegos dispatched in search of Juan Ortiz. — The Cacique Mucozo, and afterwards his mother, visit the Spanish camp, . . . . .68 XVI CONTENTS. XL XII. XIII. XIV. XV. XX. XXI. XXII. XXIII. XXV. XXVI. 73 77 82 CHAPTERS PAQB X. The Governor endeavors to gain the friendship of the stern Cacique of Hirrihigua. — Gallegos dispatched on an expedition to the village of Urribarracuxi. — He hears of a region to the westward, abounding in gold, The expedition of the veteran Vasco Porcallo, in quest of the Cacique Hirrihigua, and how he fared in a swamp, ....... De Soto leaves Pedro Calderon with a garrison in Hirri- higua, and sets out on his march into the interior. — The difficulties he encountered — Gonzalo Silvestre sent back with a message to Calderon, .... The perilous journey of Gonzalo Silvestre, and his friend, Juan Lopez, ...... Thirty lances sally forth with supplies for the Governor. — The haughty speech of the Cacique Acuera, The Governor arrives in the province of Ocali. — Occurrences there, ....... XVI. The fate of the Greyhound, .... XVII. The Spaniards enter the vast province of Vitachuco. — Their reception there, ...... XVIII. Haughty message of the Cacique Vitachuco, . XIX. The Cacique Vitachuco dissembles. — His plot to destroy the Spaniards, ...... Battle with Vitachuco, ..... Death of Vitachuco and his warriors, The army passes through the province of Osachile. — Come to a vast morass. Severe skii-mishing with the savages. — Preparations to cross the great morass, Of the perilous passage of the great morass, XXIV. The Indians make a desperate stand at a deep stream, — The Spaniards gain the pass, and arrive at the Indian village of Anhayca, in the province of Apalachee, . Juan de Afiasco sets out in search of the Ocean. — The ad- ventures he met with by the way, Juan de Afiasco arrives at the bay, where he finds traces of Pamphilo de Narvaez, . . . * 93 98 101 103 107 110 114 122 127 133 137 140 144 CONTENTS. xvu CHAPTERS XXVIL XXVIII XXIX. XXX. XXXI. XXXIL XXXIII. XXXIV. XXXV. XXXVI. XXXVII. XXXVIII. XXXIX. XL. XLI. XLII. XLIII. The expedition of Juan de Afiasco and his band of thirty troopers, . . . . . . .146 Continuation of the bold and perilous expedition of Juan de Afiasco and his thirty lances, . . . 150 De Soto's enterprise against the Cacique of Capafi, Singular escape of the Cacique Capafi, . Continuation of the expedition of Juan de Afiasco and his thirty lances, and what further befell them, 154 157 160 165 Passage of the great morass. — The troopers suffer from ex- treme cold. — The vexation of Gomez Arias, They capture some of the natives. — Perplexed with fears for the safety of the garrison at Hirrihigua. — Their arri- val there, ...... 169 Afiasco sails in quest of the bay of Aute. — Gomez Arias embarks for the Havana — and Calderon prepares to march to join the army, . . . .175 Breaking up of the garrison at Hirrihigua. — Pedro Calde- ron sets out to rejoin the Governor. — Desperate conflict with the natives in crossing the great swamp, . 177 Fierce struggle with the natives at the passage of a stream. — Arrival at the village of Apalachee, . .183 The exploring expedition of Diego Maldonado, . 186 Strange adventures that befell the Spaniards while winter- ing in Apalachee, . . . . .188 Tidings of a gold region. — The Spaniards break up their winter cantonment. — A fatal encounter, . . 193 Reception of the Spaniards by the natives of Atapaha. — Their arrival at the province of Cofa — and what hap- pened there, . . . . . .199 Reception of the army by the Cacique. — Preparations for penetrating to the province of Cofachiqui, . . 201 Some account of the Chieftain Patofa. — The Indian boy Pedro has a marvellous visitation, . . . 204 The desertion of an Indian, and how he was punished. — The army lost in a trackless wilderness, . . 207 xvm CONTENTS. CHAPTERS PAGE XLIV. Parties dispatched in different directions, to seek some outlet to this wilderness. — Sufferings of the army for want of food.— Success of Juan de Afiasco's expedition, 211 XLV. The half famished army revived by the tidings of Anasco's discovery of an abundant region. — The ravages com- mitted by Patofa and his warriors. — De Soto's reception by the beautiful Princess of Cofachiqui, . .215 XLVI. The army quartered in the village of the young Princess. — Aiiasco dispatched after a certain rich widow. — Some account of the young warrior by whom he was guided, 222 XLVII. The melancholy fate of the young Indian guide. — Anasco makes another attempt to capture the old princess, 225 XL VIII. Disappointment of the Spaniards with respect to gold. — The treasure they find. — They discover some European relics, ...... 228 XLIX. The Spaniards resume their march. — The Princess of Co- fachiqui carried away captive — A mutiny. — The army traverse the territory of the Cherokees. — Escape of the young Priucess. — Juan Terron and his pearls, . . 235 L. Arrival of the army at Guaxule. — Reception of the Span- iards by the Cacique of Ychiaha. — Two troopers dis- patched to the mountains in search of gold, and what success they had, ..... 241 LI. The manner in which the Indians extracted the pearls from the shell. — Generosity of a soldier. — What befell Luis Bravo de Xeres while fishing, . . . . 245 LII. How they were treated by the Cacique of Acoste, at whose village they arrived. — The manner in which the young Cacique, Cosa, came forth to meet them. The Indians show a hostile disposition. — The Cacique Cosa escorts them to Talise, and why, .... 248 LIIL The gigantic chieftain, Tuscaluza. — His haughty recep- tion of the Spaniards. — Great sufferings of the army for the want of salt. — Strange malady occasioned there- by, . . . . . . .255 LIV. Tuscaloosa, his steed and raiment. — His village — Mysteri- ous disappearance of two soldiers. — Arrival at the village ofMauvila, ....... 259 CONTENTS. YIY LVI LVII LVIII LIX. LX. LXI. LXII. CHAPTERS LV. The disastrous battle of Mauvila, . Fall of Tuscaloosa, ..... The plight of the Spaniards after the battle of Mauvila, . De Soto becomes an altered man, and why, The Adelantado breaks up his encampment at Mauvila. — Manner of crossing a river. — The pass stoutly defended by the Indians, ...... De Soto sends a messenger to the natives with offers of peace. — Encamp in a Chickasaw village. — Two soldiers condemned to death, .... The desperate battle of Chicaza, . The Spaniards remove to Chicacilla. — Occurrences there. — The exploit of Juan de Guzman. — The invention of one of the soldiers as a protection against the cold, LXIII. Juan de Aiiasco, and a detachment of horse and foot, have a brush with the natives; and how he was taunted by them. — Storming of the fortress of Alibamo. — Challenge of an Indian warrior, and how he fared in consequence, ...... The Spaniards come in sight of the Mississippi. — The Ca- cique Chisca — his hostile movements, The Spaniards prepare to cross the Mississippi. — A Cacique, with a fleet of canoes, comes to visit the Governor : — the result of their interview — Passage of the Mississippi. — Arrival among the Kaskaskias Indians, A religious ceremony on the banks of the Mississippi, . Expedition against the Cacique Capaha. — His village is sacked. — Fortifies himself in an Island, where he is again assailed. — The Spaniards deserted by their allies, the Casquins, ...... Interview between the Cacique Capaha and De Soto. — His two beautiful wives, and their fate, Two soldiers dispatched in search of salt and gold, and the account they brought back. — The Spaniards arrive at Quiguate. — Juan Gaytan refuses to perform his duty, and what De Soto did thereupon. PAGE 263 274 279 283 LXIV. LXV. LXVI. LXVIL LXVIII. LXIX. 287 291 295 300 303 309 313 318 321 327 330 XX CONTENTS. CHAPTERS LXX. LXXI. LXXII. LXXIII. LXXIV. LXXV. LXXVI. LXXVII. LXXVIII. LXXIX. The Spaniards arrive at Coligoa — pass through the pro- vince of Palisema, into the country of the Tunicas. — The manner in which the natives made salt. — Enter the province of Tula. — Attack upon an Indian village. — Struggle between a soldier and five women, . 330 What the Spaniards found in the village of Tula. — The tribe of Tula differed from any Indians they had seen. — They fall suddenly upon the encampment at night. — The prowess of an Indian, and his fate, . . 337 The army arrives at Utiangue. — The Governor determines to winter there. — Preparations accordingly. — Death of Juan Ortiz, the interpreter, .... 341 Change in the views and plans of De Soto. — He turns his steps towards the Mississippi. — A soldier drowned in attempting to cross a lake. — The Spaniards pass through the province of Anilco. — Hostile bearing of the Cacique. — Arrival at Guachoya, .... 345 Meeting between De Soto and the Cacique Guachoya. — Anasco dispatched to seek for the sea. — Expedition by land and water, against the Chieftain Anilco, and the result, . . . . . . 350 Difficulties with the Cacique of Quigualtanqui. — Illness and death of De Soto, .... 355 The burial of De Soto. — The Cacique sends two young Indians to be sacrificed to his manes. — "What Luis de Moscoso said in reply. — Disposal of the Governor's effects, . . . . . . .361 The Spaniards, under the command of Luis de Moscoso, commence their march to the westward. — Arrival at the province of Chaguate — where they find salt, . 365 Disappearance of Diego de Guzman. — Cause of his deser- tion, . . . . . . .369 The army arrives at Naguatex ; have a severe brush with the natives. — Imminent peril of two troopers and four foot-soldiers, and their rescue. — Severe treatment of the Indian captives. — Singular interview between the Cacique Naguatex and Moscoso. — The Spaniards per- plexed by a phenomenon, . . . .373 CONTENTS. xxi CHAPTERS LXXX. LXXXI. LXXXII. LXXXIII. LXXXIV. LXXXV. LXXXVI. LXXXVII. LXXXVIII. LXXXIX. XC. Vague tidings of Europeans to the West, — Wandering in a wilderness. — Treachery of an Indian guide, and his fate. — The hunting grounds of the Far West, . . 377 Feats of individual prowess of the Indians of the Far West, The Spaniards come in sight of high mountains to the west. — Exploring parties sent out to discover the coun- try : — the report they bring back. — Moscoso calls a council of his officers — then* determination, 381 384 Harassing march of the Spaniards, misadventure, -The trooper : — his 388 Francisco, the Genoese, with several of his comrades he in ambush to entrap some of the natives. — The severe skirmish they have with an Indian, and the result, . 391 They pass through the province of Chaguate, and Mos- coso dispatches a party of twelve troopers after Diego de Guzman. — Sufferings of the army. — Their arrival at the province of Anilco, and their despondency. — Cheered up by news of the fertile country of Ami- noya. — Afiasco dispatched to that province — and what he found there, . . , . . 394 The Spaniards arrive at Aminoya. — Commence building brigantines. — Quarrel between the Cacique Guachoya and the Captain-General of Anilco. — Singular chaUenge of the latter, ...... 399 The league of the Caciques against the Spaniards. — Gon- zalo Silvestre roughly handles an Indian. — How the de- signs of the hostile Caciques were frustrated, . 405 The Caciques of the League again prepare to attack the Spaniards. — An Indian spy. — A plot detected, . 409 Final preparations of Moscoso and his followers, . 412 Embarkation of the Spaniards upon the Mississippi. — A grand and concerted attack, by a large fleet of canoes ; and how the Spaniards fared. — Gonzalo Silvestre sent on shore, with a detachment of men, for provisions. — Loss of their horses, . . . . .415 CONTENTS. CHAPTERS PAGE XCI. Continuation of the voyage down the Mississippi. — The fool-hardy exploit of Estevan Anez. — The feat of Pedro Moron, the half-breed. — Uncertain fate of De Guzman, 421 XCII. The Spaniards reach the Ocean. — Disembark on an island of driftwood. — Fierce encounter with the natives of the coast. — They anchor off an uninhabited island, . 425 XCIII. A council of officers called to determine upon their future course. — They set sail. — Aiiasco prevails upon them to follow his advice, ..... 428 XCIV. Vessels in danger of stranding. — Come to some small islands, where they repair the brigantines — Overtaken by a violent gale, and two caravels driven to sea. — Mutiny of Juan Gaytan's crew, . . .432 XCV. Expedition of Gonzalo Silvestre, to obtain information about the country. — "What happened to Moscoso and the rest of the fleet. — How the Spaniards were received by the inhabitants of Panuco, .... 437 XCVI. Discontents and broils among the soldiery. — Their subse- quent fortunes, ..... 441 XCVII. The voyages of Maldonado and Gomez Arias, in search of De Soto. — Death of Dona Isabel de Bobadilla, . 445 CONOUEST OP FLORIDA • ■<» e - CHAPTER I. FIRST DISCOVERY OF FLORIDA. Never was the spirit of wild adventure more universally diffused than at the dawn of the sixteenth century. The wondrous dis- coveries of Columbus and his hardy companions and followers, the descriptions of the beautiful summer isles of the west, and the tales of unexplored regions of wealth locked up in unbounded wildernesses, had an effect upon the imaginations of the young and the adventurous, not unlike the preaching of the chivalric crusades for the recovery of the Holy Sepulchre. The gallant knight, the servile retainer, the soldier of fortune, the hooded friar, the painstaking mechanic, the toilful husbandman, the loose profligate, and the hardy mariner, all were touched with the per- vading passion, all left home, country, friends, wives, children, loves, to seek some imaginary Eldorado, confidently expecting to return with countless treasure. Of ail the enterprises undertaken in this spirit of daring ad- venture, none has surpassed for hardihood and variety of incident 24 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. that of the renowned Hernando de Soto and his band of cavaliers. It was poetry put in action ; it was the knight-errantry of the old world carried into the depths of the American wilderness ; indeed, the personal adventures, the feats of individual prowess, the picturesque descriptions of steel-clad cavaliers, with lance and helm and prancing steed, glittering through the wildernesses of Florida, Georgia, Alabama, and the prairies of the Far West, would seem to us mere fictions of romance, did they not come to us recorded in matter of fact narratives of contemporaries, and corroborated by minute and daily memoranda of eye-witnesses. Before we enter, however, upon the stirring and eventful story of the fortunes of De Soto and his followers, it is proper to notice briefly the discovery of the land which was the scene of his adventures, and the various expeditions to it which stimulated him to his great enterprise. Those who are conversant with the history of the Spanish discoveries will remember the chimerical cruise of the brave old governor of Porto Rico, Ponce de Leon, in search of the Foun- tain of Youth. This fabled fountain, according to Indian tra- dition, existed in one of the Bahama Islands. Ponce de Leon sought after it in vain, but in the course of his cruisings discov- ered a country of vast and unknown extent, to which, from the abundance of flowers, and from its being first seen on Palm Sun- day (Pascua Florida), he gave the name of Florida. Obtaining permission from the Spanish government to subju- gate and govern this country, he made a second voyage to its shores, but was mortally wounded in a conflict with the natives. Such was the fate of the first adventurer into the wild regions of Florida, and he really seems to have bequeathed his ill fortune to his successors. LUCAS VASQUEZ DE AYLLON'S EXPEDITION. 25 A few years after his defeat a captain of a caravel, named Diego Miruelo, was driven to the coast of Florida by stress of weather, where he obtained a small quantity of silver and gold in traffic from the natives. With this he returned well pleased to San Domingo, spreading the fame of the country he had visit- ed. About the same time a company of seven wealthy men of San Domingo, concerned in gold mines, at the head of which was the licentiate Lucas Vasquez de Ayllon, auditor and judge of appeals of that island, fitted out two vessels to cruise among the islands and entrap Indians to work in the mines. In the course of this righteous cruise the vessels were driven by stress of wea- ther to a cape on the east coast, to which they gave the name of St. Helena. The country in the neighborhood was called Chico- rea, and is the same now called South Carolina. Here they anchored at the mouth of a river which they called the Jordan, after the name of the sea-captain who discovered it. It is the same now known by its Indian appellation, the Cambahee.* The natives hastened to the shores at sight of the ships, which they mistook for huge sea-monsters ; but, when they beheld men issue from them, with white complexions and beards, and clad in raiment and shining armor, they fled in terror. The Spaniards soon dispelled their fears, and a friendly inter- course took place. The poor Indians were kind and hospitable, brought provisions to the ships, and made the strangers presents of marten skins, pearls, and a small quantity of gold and silver. * We follow the general opinion, strengthened by the circumstance that the neighboring Sound and Island are still called by the name of St. Helena. Herrera places Cape St. Helena and the river Jordan in the thirty-second degree of latitude, which is that of Savannah river. — Vide Herrera, D. ii. lib. x. c. 6. 26 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. The Spaniards gave them trinkets in return, and, having com pleted their supplies of wood and water and provisions, invited their savage friends on board of the ships. The Indians eagerly accepted the invitation. They thronged the vessels, gazing with wonder at every thing around them ; hut when a sufficient num- ber were below the decks, the Spaniards perfidiously closed the hatches upon them, and, weighing anchor, made sail for San Domingo. One of the ships was lost in the course of the voyage, the other arrived safe, but the Indians on board of her remained sullen and gloomy, and refused food, so that most of them perish- ed of famine and melancholy.* The reports, however, brought back by the kidnappers, of the country they had visited, as well as the specimens of gold and silver brought home about the same time by Diego Miruelo, roused the cupidity and ambition of the auditor Lucas Vasquez de Ayllon. Being shortly afterwards in Spain, he obtained from the Emperor Charles V. permission to conquer and govern the newly-discovered province of Chicorea. With this permission he returned to San Domingo, and fitted out an armament of three large vessels, embarking personally in the enterprise. Diego Miruelo persuaded him first to steer in quest of the country he had visited, and which he represented as much richer than Chicorea. He accompanied the expedition as pilot, but having, with a negligence unworthy of a practised mariner, neg- lected in his first visit to take an observation, he was unable to find the place at which he had formerly landed, and was so much mortified by the ridicule and reproaches of his employers, that he fell into a profound melancholy, lost his senses, and died in the course of a few days. * Hist, Florida, por el Inca, L. i. c. 2. Herrera, D. ii. L. x. c. 6. EXPEDITION" OF LUCAS VASQUEZ DE AYLLOK 27 Lucas Vasquez de Ayllon now prosecuted his voyage to the eastward in search of Chicorea. Arriving in the river Jordan (or Cambahee), the scene of perfidy in the preceding voyage, his principal ship stranded and was lost. With the remaining two lie passed further to the eastward, and landed on a coast adjoin- ing Chicorea, in a gentle and pleasant region. Here he was so well received that he considered the country already under his dominion, and permitted two hundred of his men to visit the principal village, about three leagues in the interior, while he remained with a small force to guard the ships. The inhabitants of the village entertained these visitors with feasting and rejoicing for three days, until, having put them com- pletely off their guard, they rose upon them in the night and massacred every soul. They then repaired by daybreak to the harbor, and surprised Vasquez de Ayllon and his handful of guards. The few who survived escaped wounded and dismayed to their ships, and making all sail from the fated coast, hastened back to San Domingo. According to some accounts Ayllon re- mained among the slain on the coast he sought to subjugate, but others assert that he returned wounded to San Domingo, where the humiliation of his defeat, and the ruin of his fortunes, con- spired with his bodily ills to hurry him broken-hearted to the grave. Thus signally did the natives of Chicorea revenge the wrongs of their people who had been so perfidiously kidnapped.* * Hist Florida, por el Inca, L. i. c. 2. Herrera, D. ii. L. x. c. 6. Idem. D. iii. lib. viii. c. 8. Peter Martyr, D. vii c. 11. Heylyns Cosmograpbie, L. iv. p. 100. Lond. Ed. 1669. CHAPTER II. THE EXPEDITION OF PAMPHILO DE NARVAEZ. A cavalier of greater note was the next who aspired to sub- jugate the unknown realms of Florida, This was the brave but ill-starred Pamphilo de Narvaez, the same who had attempted to arrest Hernando Cortes in his conquering career against Mexico, in which attempt he was defeated in battle, and lost an eye. Narvaez possessed favor at court, and was enabled to fit out a considerable armament for his new enterprise. He was invested by the Emperor Charles V. with the title of Adelantado, or mili- tary governor of the country, he expected to subdue and occupy, which was that part of Florida extending from its extreme cape to the river of Palms. In this expedition he trusted to wipe off the disgrace of his late defeat, and even to acquire laurels which might vie with those of Cortes. On the 12th of April, 1528, Narvaez anchored at the mouth of an open bay on the eastern coast of Florida, with a squadron of four barks and a brigantine. Here he landed his forces, consisting of four hundred men and forty-five horses ; having lost many of his men by desertion in the West India islands, and several of his horses in a storm. ARRIVAL OF KARVAEZ'S EXPEDITION". 29 Erecting the royal standard, he took possession of the conn- try for the crown of Spain, with no opposition from the natives. After having explored the vicinity, Narvaez determined to pene- trate the country in a northward direction, hoping to discover some great empire like that of Mexico or Pern. In the mean time, the ships were to proceed along the coast in quest of some convenient harbor, where they were either to await his arrival, or to steer for Havana and return with supplies for the army.* This plan was strongly opposed by the treasurer of the ex- pedition, one Alvar Nunez Cabeza de Vaca, a prudent and sagacious man. He represented the danger of plunging into an unknown wilderness without knowing a word of the language, and advised, rather, that they should continue on in their ships, until they found a secure harbor and a fertile country, from whence they might make incursions into the interior. This sound advice was slighted by Narvaez and his adventu- rous companions, whose imaginations were inflamed with the idea of inland conquest. The squadron, accordingly, set sail to the northward ; and Narvaez and his troops set out by land in the same direction, accompanied by the faithful Alvar Nunez ; who, since he could not dissuade his commander from his desperate career, resolved to share his fate. The force which proceeded by land consisted of three hun- dred men, forty of whom were mounted on horses. The allow- ance to each man consisted of two pounds of biscuit and half a pound of bacon. For the first few days they met with fields of maize, and villages containing provisions. Here, however, they outraged the feelings of the natives by rifling and laying waste their sepulchres, mistaking them for idolatrous temples. They * Herrera, Decad. iv. L. iv. c. 4. 30 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. afterwards journeyed many days through desert solitudes with- out house or inhabitant, suffering greatly from want of food, They crossed rapid rivers on rafts or by* swimming, continually exposed to the assaults of hordes of lurking savages ; they traversed swamps and forests, making their way with great dif- ficulty through matted thickets and over fallen trees, and suffer- ing every variety of misery and hardship. Still they were cheered onward by the assurances of certain captives who served as guides, that at some distance ahead lay a vast province called Apalachee, extremely fertile, and abounding in the gold they so eagerly sought after. At length they arrived in sight of the place which gave its name to this long desired province. Narvaez had pictured it to himself a second Mexico, and was chagrined at finding it a mere village of two hundred and forty houses. Alvar Nunez was sent forward to take possession of it, which he did without opposition, the men having all fled to the woods. The Spaniards remained twenty-five days in the village, exploring the neighboring country, and subsisting upon the pro- visions they found in the place. During this time they were harassed, day and night, by the natives of the province, who were an exceedingly warlike people. They were disappointed in their hopes of finding gold, and discouraged by the accounts given them of the country further on. They were told, however, that by shaping their course to the southward, towards the sea, they would, after nine days' journey, come to the village of Aute, where there was maize and vegetables and fish in abundance, and where the natives were of a friendly disposition. Towards Aute, therefore, did they turn their steps, more eager now for food than for gold. The journey was perilous and DIFFICULTIES ENCOUNTERED 31 full of disaster. They had to cross deep lagoons and dismal swamps, with the water often np to their breasts, their passage obstructed by rotten trees, and beset by hordes of savages. These appeared to the disheartened Spaniards of gigantic height ; they had bows of enormous size, from which they discharged arrows with such force as to penetrate armor at the distance of two hundred yards. At length, after incredible hardships, and with the loss of many men and horses, they arrived at the village of Aute. # The natives abandoned and burnt their houses on the approach of the invaders, but they left behind a quantity of maize, with which the Spaniards appeased their hunger. A day's march beyond the village brought them to a river, which gradually expanded into a large road, or arm of the sea. Here they came to a pause in their adventurous career, and held a consultation as to their future movements. Their hopes of wealth and conquest were at an end. Nearly a third of their original number had perished ; while of the survivors a great majority were ill, and disease was daily spreading among them. To attempt to retrace their steps, or to proceed along the coast in search of the fleet, would be to hazard all their lives. At length it was suggested that they should construct small barks, launch them upon the deep, and keep along the coast until they should find their ships. It was a forlorn hope, but they caught at it like desperate men. They accordingly set to work with great eagerness. One of them constructed a pair of bellows out of deer-skins, furnishing it with a wooden pipe. Others made charcoal and a forge. By the aid of these they soon turned their stirrups, spurs, crossbows, and other articles * Supposed to be on what is now called the Bay of St. Marks. 32 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. of iron, into nails, saws, and hatchets. The tails and manes of the horses, twisted with the fibres of the palm-tree, served for rigging ; their shirts, cut open and sewed together, furnished sails ; the fibrous part of the palm-tree, also, was used as oakum ; the resin of the pine-trees for tar ; the skins of horses were made into vessels to contain fresh water ; and a quantity of maize was won by hard fighting from the neighboring natives. A horse was killed every three days for provisions for the labor- ing hands and the sick. Having at length by great exertions completed five frail barks, they embarked on the 22d of Septem- ber, from forty to fifty persons being in each ; but so closely crowded were they, that there was scarcely room to move, while the gunwale of the boats was forced down by their weight to the water's edge. Setting sail from this bay, which they called the Bay of Caballos, they continued on for several days to an island where they secured five canoes that had been deserted by the Indians. These being attached to their barks, enabled them to sail with greater comfort. They passed through the strait between the island and the mainland, which they called the Strait of San Miguel, and sailed onward for many days, enduring all the torments of hunger and parching thirst : the skins which con- tained their fresh water having burst, some, driven to despera- tion, drank salt water, and died miserably. Their sufferings were aggravated by a fearful storm. At length they approached a more populous and fertile part of the coast, upon which they landed occasionally to procure provisions, and were immediately involved in bloody affrays with the natives. Thus harassed by sea and land, famishing with hunger, their barks shattered and scarcely manageable, these unfortunate wanderers lost all [NARVAEZ PERISHES AT SEA. 33 presence of mind, and became wild and desperate. They were again driven out to sea, and scattered during a stormy night. At daybreak three of these tempest-tossed barks rejoined each other. In one, which was the best manned and the best sailer, was Pamphilo de Narvaez. Alvar Nunez, who had command of another, seeing the Adelantado making for the land, called upon him for aid. Narvaez replied that it was no longer time to help others, but that every one must take care of himself. He then made for the shore, and abandoned Alvar Nunez to make the best of his way with the other bark. After wandering along the coast in his bark for many days, Narvaez anchored one night off the land. All his crew had gone ■on shore for provisions, excepting one sailor and a page who was sick. A violent gale sprang up from the north, and the vessel, in which was neither food nor water, was driven out to sea, and •no tidings ever heard of her after. Thus perished the ill-fated Pamphilo de Narvaez. The only survivors of this disastrous expedition were Alvar Nunez Cabeza de Yaca, and four of his companions. After the most singular and unparalleled hardships, they traversed the northern parts of Florida, crossed the Mississippi, and the desert and mountainous regions on the confines of Texas and the Rocky Monntains, passing from tribe to tribe of Indians, oftentimes as slaves, until at the end of several years they succeeded in reach- ing the Spanish settlement of Compostella. From thence Alvar Nunez proceeded to Mexico, and ultimately arrived at Lisbon in 1537 ; nearly ten years after his embarkation with Pamphilo de Narvaez.* * This chapter is chiefly taken from the " Naufragios de Alvar Nunez Cabeza de Vaca," with occasional references to Herrera. CHAPTER III. HERNANDO DE SOTO— HIS BIRTH— ADVENTURES IN PERU— FITS OUT AN ARMAMENT FOR FLORIDA— TOUCHES AT THE CANARY ISLANDS ARRIVAL AT CUBA. One would have thought that after the melancholy result of these sad enterprises, and others of less note, but equally unfor- tunate, the coast of Florida would have been avoided as a fated land. The Spanish discoverers, however, were not to be deterred by difficulties and clangers, and the accounts rendered of the. vast extent of this unknown country, and of opulent regions in its in- terior, served to prompt to still bolder and more costly enter- prises. It is proper to note that the Spaniards, at this period, had a very vague idea of the country called Florida, and by no means limited it to its present boundaries. They knew something of the maritime border of the peninsula, but Florida, according to their notions, extended far beyond, having the confines of Mexico in one direction, the banks of Newfoundland in another, and ex- panding into a vast Terra Incognita to the north. The accounts brought to Europe by Alvar Nunez, of the ex- pedition of Pamphilo de Narvaez, contributed to promote this BIRTH OF HERNANDO DE SOTO. 35 idea. It was supposed that this unfortunate cavalier, in his ex- tensive march, had but skirted the borders of immense internal empires, which might rival in opulence and barbaric splendor the recently discovered kingdoms of Mexico and Peru; and there was not wanting a bold and ambitious spirit to grasp immediately at the palm of conquest. The candidate that now presented himself for the subjugation of Florida, was Hernando de Soto, and as his expedition is the subject of the succeeding pages, it is proper to introduce him particularly to the reader. Hernando de Soto was born about the year 1501, in Villa nueva de Barcarota,* and was of the old Spanish hidalguia, or gentry, for we are assured by one of his biographers that " he was a gentleman by all four descents ;" that is to say, the parents both of his father and mother were of gentle blood ; a pedigree which, according to the rules of Spanish herald- ry, entitled him to admission into the noble order of Santiago. Whatever might be the dignity of his descent, however, he be- gan his career a mere soldier of fortune. All his estate, says his Portuguese historian, was but a sword and buckler. He accom- panied Pedrarias Davila,f when he went to America to assume the command of Terra Firma. The merits of De Soto soon gain- ed him favor in the eye of Pedrarias, who gave him command of a troop of horse : with these he followed Pizarro in his conquering expedition into Peru. Here he soon signalized himself by a rare combination of prudence and valor : he was excellent in council, yet foremost in every perilous exploit ; not recklessly seeking * The Portuguese narrator assigns Xeres de Badajos as the "birthplace of De Soto ; we follow, however, the authority of the Inca Garselasso de la Vega. Herrera (Hist. Ind. Dec. vi. L. vii. c. 9,) agrees with the Inca. f Properly written Pedro Arias de A Vila. 2* 36 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA, danger for clanger's sake, or through a vain thirst for notoriety, but bravely putting every thing at hazard where any important point was to be gained by intrepidity. Pizarro soon singled him out from the hardy spirits around him, and appointed him his lieuteuant.* Was there a service of especial danger to be performed — De Soto had it in charge : was there an enterprise requiring sound judgment and fearless daring — De Soto was sure to be called upon. A master at all weapons, and a complete horseman, his prowess and adroitness were the admiration of the Spanish soldiery. They declared that his lance alone was equal to any ten in the army : and that in the manage- ment of this chivalrous weapon, he was second only to Pizarro. He was sent by that commander on the first embassy to the renowned and ill-fated Inca Atahualpa, whose subjects, we are told, were filled with surprise and admiration on beholding his wonderful feats of horsemanship.! He afterwards commanded one of the squadrons of horse that captured this unfortunate Inca and routed his army of warriors.^ He led the way with a band of seventy horsemen, to the disco- very and subjugation of the great province of Cusco, in which he distinguished himself by the most daring and romantic achieve- * Herrera, Hist Ind., Decad. v. L. ii. c. 2. f Herrera, Hist. Ind., Decad. v. L. iii c. 10, says, Hernando de Soto sprang upon his horse, and aware that the eyes of the Inca were upon him. he made his steed curvet, caracole and leap, and striking in his spurs dashed up so near to the savage prince that he felt the very breath of the snorting animal. The haughty Inca was as serene and unmoved as if he had been accustomed all his life to the charge of a horse. Many of the Indians, however, fled in ter- ror. Atahualpa immediately ordered the fugitives to appear before him, and sternly reprehending them with their cowardice, ordered them all to be put to death for having behaved so dastardly in his royal presence. i Vega, Com. de Peru, L. L c. 21. Herrera. D. v. L. ii. c 11. DE SOTO'S ADVENTURES IN PERU. 87 merits.* We might trace him throughout the whole history of the Peruvian conquest by a series of perilous encounters and mar- vellous escapes, but our purpose is only to state briefly the cir- cumstances which directed his ambition into the career of con- quest, and which elevated him to the notice of his sovereign, and of all contemporary cavaliers of enterprising spirit. Hernando de Soto returned to Spain enriched by the spoils of the new world : his share of the treasures of Atahualpa having amounted, it is said, to the enormous sum of a hundred and eighty thousand crowns of gold. He now assumed great state and equip- age, and appeared at the court of the Emperor Charles V., at Valladolid, in magnificent style, having his steward, his major- domo, his master of the horse, his pages, lackeys, and all the other household officers that in those ostentatious days swelled the retinue of a Spanish nobleman. He was accompanied by a knot of brave cavaliers, all evidently bent on pushing their for- tunes at court. Some of them had been his brothers in arms in the conquest of Peru, and had returned with their purses well filled with Peruvian gold, which they expended in soldierlike -style, on horses, arms, and " rich array." Two or three of them deserve particular notice, as they will be found to figure conspi- cuously in the course of this narrative, Xuno Tobar, a native of Xeres de Badajos, was a }'oung cavalier of gallant bearing, great valor, and romantic generosity. Another, Luis de 3Ioscoso de Alvorado, likewise of Xeres, had signalized himself in his cam- paigns in the new world. A third, Juan de Anasco, was a native of Seville. He had not been in Peru, but was not inferior to the others in bravery of spirit, while he was noted for his nautical skill and his knowledge of cosmography and astronomy. * Herrera, Dec. v. L. iv. c. x ., and Lib. v. c. 2. 3. 38 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. The world was at that time resounding with the recent con- quest of Peru. The appearance at court of one of the conquer- ors, thus brilliantly attended, could not fail to attract attention, The personal qualifications of De Soto corresponded with his fame. He was in the prime of manhood, being about thirty-six years of age, of a commanding height, above the middle size, and a dark, animated, and expressive countenance. With such ad- vantages, of person and reputation, he soon succeeded in gaining the affections and the hand of a lady of distinguished rank and merit, Isabella de Bobadilla. daughter to Pedrarias Davila, Count of Puiio en Kostro. This marriage, connecting him with a pow- erful family, had a great effect in strengthening his influence at court.* De Soto might now have purchased estates, and passed the remainder of his days opulently and honorably in his native land, in the bosom of his connections, but he was excited by the remembrance of past adventures, and eager for further dis- tinction. Just at this juncture, Alvar Nuno Cabeza de Yaca returned to Spain with tidings of the fate of Pamphilo de Nar- vaez and his followers. His tale, it is true, was one of hardships and disasters, but it turned the thoughts of adventurous men to the vast and unknown interior of Florida, It is said that Alvar Nunez observed some reserve and mystery in his replies when questioned, as to whether they had found any riches in the country they had visited ; that he talked of asking permission of the crown to return there and prosecute the discovery, and that he had even sworn his fellow survivors to secrecy as to what they had seen, lest others should be induced to interfere with his prospects, f * Portuguese Narrative, c 1. f Portuguese Narrative, c. 2. EXPEDITION AGAINST FLORIDA. 39 The imagination of De Soto took fire from what he gathered of the narrative of Alvar Nunez. He doubted not there existed in the interior of Florida some regions of wealth, equalling, if not exceeding, Mexico and Peru. He had hitherto only followed in the course of conquest ; an opportunity now presented of rivalling the fame of Cortes and Pizarro ; his reputation, his wealth, his past services, and his marriage connections — all gave him the means of securing the chance before him. In the mag- nificent spirit of a Spanish cavalier, he asked permission of the Emperor to undertake the conquest of Florida at his own expense and risk. His prayer was readily granted. The Emperor conferred on him in advance, the title of Adelantado, which combines military and civil command, and granted him moreover a marquisite, with an estate of thirty leagues in length and fifteen in breadth, in any part of the country he might discover. He likewise cre- ated him governor and captain-general for life, of Florida, as well as of the Island of Cuba. The command of this island had been annexed at the especial request of De Soto, as he knew it would be important to have the complete control of it, to fit out and supply armaments for the meditated conquest. No sooner was he thus gratified in his wishes, than he pro- vided for the brothers in arms who had accompanied him to court. Nufio de Tobar he appointed his lieutenant-general, for which post he was well qualified by his great valor and his popular qualities. Luis de Moscoso de Alvarado he made camp- master-general, and he procured for Juan de Anasco the ap- pointment of Contador, or royal accountant, whose duty it was to take account of all the treasures gained in the expedition, and to set apart one fifth for the crown. 40 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. De Soto would likewise have engaged Alvar Nunez Cabeza de Vaca to accompany him, and offered him highly advantageous terms, which he was at first inclined to accept, but subsequently refused, being unwilling to march under the command of another in an enterprise in which he had aspired to take the lead. He afterwards obtained from the Emperor the government of Rio de la Plata.* But though Alvar Nunez declined to embark in the enter- prise, his representations of the country induced two of his kins- men to offer their services. One of them, a brave and hearty cavalier, named Balthazar de G-allegos, was so eager for the expe- dition that he sold his houses, vineyards and cornfields, and four- score and ten acres of olive orchards, in the neighborhood of Se- ville, and determined to take his wife with him to the new world. De Soto was so well pleased with his zeal, that he made him Al- guazil Mayor. The other kinsman of Alvar Nunez was named Christopher Spinola, a gentleman of Genoa, to whom De Soto gave the command of seventy halberdiers of his body-guard. It was soon promulgated throughout Spain that Hernando de Soto, one of the conquerors of Peru, was about to set out on the conquest of the great empire of Florida, an unknown country, equal if not superior in wealth and splendor to any of the golden empires of the new world, and that he was to do it at his own expense, with the riches gained in his previous conquests. This was enough to draw to his standard adventurers of all kinds and classes. Cavaliers of noble birth, soldiers of fortune who had served in various parts of the world, private citizens and peaceful artisans, all abandoned their homes and families, sold * Portuguese Narrative, c. 4. ARRIVAL OF PORTUGUESE HIDALGOS. 41 their effects, and offered themselves and their resources for this new conquest. A striking account is given us of the arrival of a party of these volunteers. As De Soto was one day in the gallery of his house at Seville, he saw a brilliant band of cavaliers enter the court-yard, and hastened to the foot of the stairs to receive them. They were Portuguese hidalgos, led by Andres de Yasconcelos ; several of them had served in the wars with the Moors on the African frontiers, and they had come to volunteer their services. De Soto joyfully accepted their offer. He detained them to sup- per, and ordered his Steward to provide quarters for them in his neighborhood. A muster being called of all the troops, the Spaniards appeared in splendid and showy attire, with silken doublets and cassocks pinked and embroidered. The Portu- guese, on the contrary, came in soldierlike style, in complete armor. De Soto was vexed at the unseasonable ostentation of his countrymen, and ordered another review in which all should appear armed. Here the Portuguese again came admirably equipped, while the Spaniards, who had been so gaudy in their silken dresses, made but a sorry show as soldiers, having old rusty coats of mail, battered head-pieces, and indifferent lances. The general, it is said, marked his preference of the Portuguese, by placing them near his standard. It must be observed, how- ever, that this account is given by a Portuguese historian, who naturally is disposed to give his countrymen the advantage of the Spaniards. Other accounts speak generally of the excellent equipments of all the forces. In little more than a year from the time of the first procla- mation of this enterprise, nine hundred and fifty Spaniards of all degrees had assembled in the port of San Lucar de Barrameda, 42 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. to embark in the expedition.* Never had a more gallant and brilliant body of men offered themselves for the new world. Scarcely one among them had gray hairs, all were young and vigorous, and fitted for the toils and hardships and dangers of so adventurous an undertaking. De Soto was munificent in his proffers of pecuniary assist- ance to aid the cavaliers in fitting themselves out according to their rank and station. Many were compelled, through neces- sity, to accept of his offers ; others, who had means, generously declined them, deeming it more proper that they should assist, than accept aid from him : many young cavaliers came equipped in splendid style, with rich armor, costly dresses, and a train of domestics. Indeed, some young men of quality had spent a great part of their substance in this manner. Nuno Tobar, Luis de Moscoso, and several other cavaliers, who had distinguished themselves in the conquest of Peru, ex- pended the greater part of their spoils in sumptuous equipments. Beside the cavaliers already specified, we may mention three brothers, relatives of the governor, who accompanied him ; Arias Tinoco and Alonzo Romo cle Cardenosa, both captains of in- fantry, and Diego Arias Tinoco, who was standard-bearer to the army. There were also enlisted in the enterprise twelve priests, eight clergymen of inferior rank, and four monks ; most of them relatives of the superior officers : for, in all the Spanish expedi- tions to the new world, the conversion of the heathen was not lost sight of in the rage for conquest. * The Portuguese narrator gives six hundred as the number of men as- sembled, but we follow the Iuca Garcilaso de la Vega, whose authority is corroborated by Herrera and others. DE SOTO VISITS THE CANARY ISLANDS. This brilliant armament embarked at San Lucar de Barra- nieda, on the sixth of April, 1538, in seven large and three small vessels In the largest, called the San Ohristoval, which was of eight hundred tons, embarked the governor, with his wife Dona Isabel cle Bobadilla, and all his family and retinue. They set sail in company with a fleet of twenty-six sail bound to Mexico,* and with great sound of trumpets and thunder of artil- lery. The armament of De Soto was so bountifully supplied with naval stores, that each man was allowed double rations. This led to useless waste ; but the governor was of a magnificent spirit, and so elated at finding in his train such noble and gallant cavaliers, that he thought he could not do enough to honor and gratify them. On the twenty-first of April, the fleet arrived at Gomera, one of the Canary Islands. Here they were received with great parade and courtesy by the governor, who bore the title of Count de Gomera. The count seems to have been a gay and luxurious cavalier, with somewhat of an amatory complexion, his domestic establishment being graced by several natural daughters. When he came forth to receive his guests he was dressed in white from head to foot, hat, cloak, doublet, breeches and shoes ; so that, according to the old Portuguese narrative, he looked not unlike a captain of a gang of gipsies. During three days that the fleet remained in the port, he entertained his guests in jovial style, with feastings and rejoicings. Among his daughters was one named Leonora de Bobadilla, who particularly attracted the notice of the youthful cavaliers. She was not more than seventeen years of age, and extremely beautiful. De Soto was so pleased and interested with her ap- * Portuguese Narrative, c. 4, 44 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. pearance and manners, that he entreated the count to permit her to accompany his wife, Dona Isabel de Bobadilla, who would cherish her as her own daughter ; intimating that he would procure an advantageous match for her among the noble cava- liers of his army, and advance her to rank and fortune in the country he should conquer. The Count de Gromera, knowing the munificence of De Soto, and that he would be disposed to perform even more than he promised, confided his daughter to his care, and to the maternal protection of his high-minded and virtuous wife. On the twenty-fourth April the fleet again set sail. The voyage was fair and prosperous, and about the last of May they arrived in the harbor of the city of Santiago de Cuba, CHAPTER IV. REJOICINGS OF THE INHABITANTS OF CUBA ON THE ARRIVAL OF DE SOTO. DEPOSITION OF NUNO TOBAR. DON VASCO POR- CALLO DE FIGUEROA, APPOINTED LIEUTENANT-GENERAL OF THE FORCES. The arrival of the new governor with so important an arma- ment was an event of great joy throughout the island of Cuba. When De Soto landed, the whole city of Santiago turned out to receive him. He found a beautiful horse, richly caparisoned, waiting for him, and likewise a mule for Donna Isabella ; which were furnished by a gentleman of the town. He was escorted to his lodgings, by the burghers on horse and on foot, and all his officers and men were hospitably entertained by them ; some being quartered in the town, and others in their country-houses.* For several days it was one continued festival. At night there were balls and masquerades ; by day, tilting matches, bull-fights, contests of skill in horsemanship, running at the ring, and other amusements of a chivalrous nature. The young cavaliers of the army vied with each other, and with the youth of the city, in the gallantry of their equipments, the elegance and novelty of their devices, and the wit and in- genuity of their mottoes. What gave peculiar splendor to * Portuguese Relation, c. 4. 46 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. these entertainments was the beauty and spirit and excellence of the horses. The great demand for these noble animals, for the conquests of Mexico and Peru, and other parts, rendered the raising of them one of the most profitable sources of speculation in the islands. The island of Cuba was naturally favorable to them ; and as great care and attention had been given to multiply and improve the breed, there was at this time an uncommon number, and of remarkably fine qualities. Many individuals had from twenty to thirty horses in their stables, and some of the rich had twice that number on their estates. The cavaliers of the army had spared no expense in furnish- ing themselves with the most superb and generous steeds for their intended expedition. Many individuals possessed three or four, caparisoned in the most costly manner ; and the governor aided liberally with his purse, such as had not the means of equipping themselves in suitable style. Thus freshly and magnificently mounted, and arrayed in their new dresses and burnished armor, the young cavaliers made a brilliant display, and carried off many of the prizes of gold, and silver, and silks, and brocades, which were adjudged to those who distinguished themselves at these chivalrous games. In these, no one carried off the prize more frequently than Nuno de Tobar, the lieutenant-general. He was, as has been said, a cavalier of high and generous qualities, who had gained laurels in the conquest of Peru. He appeared on these occasions in sumptuous array, mounted on a superb horse, of a silver gray dappled, and was always noted for the gracefulness of his car- riage, his noble demeanor, and his admirable address in the man- agement of lance and steed. VASCO PORCELLO VISITS THE GOVERNOR. 41 Unfortunately the manly qualifications of Nuno Tobar had procured him great favor in the eyes of the beautiful Leonora de Bobadilla, the daughter of the Count de Glomera. A secret amour was carried on between them, and the virtue of the lady was not proof against the solicitations of her lover.* The consequences of their unfortunate intercourse were soon too apparent to be concealed. De Soto was incensed at what he considered an outrage upon his rights as a guardian over the lady, and his confidence as a friend. He immediately deposed Nuno Tobar from his station as lieutenant-general ; and, though that really generous spirited cavalier endeavored to make every repa- ration in his power, by marrying the lady, De Soto could never afterwards be brought to look upon him with kindness. At this time there was on a visit to the governor in the city of Santiago, a cavalier, upwards of fifty years of age, named Vasco Porcallo de Figueroa. He was of a noble family, and of a brave and galliard disposition, having seen much hard fighting in the Indies, in Spain and Italy, and distinguished himself on various occasions. He now resided in the town of Trinidad in Cuba, living opulently and luxuriously upon the wealth he had gained in the wars, honored for his exploits, loved for his social qualities, and extolled for his hearty hospitality. This magnificent cavalier had come to Santiago with a pom- pous retinue, to pay his court to the governor, and witness the festivities and rejoicings. He passed some days in the city, and when he beheld the array of gallant cavaliers and hardy soldiers assembled for the enterprise, the splendor of their equipments, and the martial style with which they acquitted themselves in public, his military spirit again took fire, and forgetting his * Portuguese Narrative of Conq. of Florida, c. 7. 48 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. years, his past toils and troubles, and his present ease and opu- lence, he volunteered his services to De Soto, to follow him in his anticipated career of conquest. A volunteer of such military experience, ample wealth, and great influence in the island, was too important not to be received with open arms ; the governor immediately made him lieutenant- general of the army ; the post from which the gallant but unfor- tunate Nuno Tobar had recently been deposed. The conduct of Yasco Porcallo showed the policy of this ap- pointment. He was so elated with this distinction, that he lav- ished his money without stint in purchasing provisions for the armada. He was magnificent too in all his appointments, camp equipage, armor and equipments, having caught the gay and brag- gart spirit of his youthful companions in arms. He carried with him a great train of Spanish, Indian and negro servants, and a stud of thirty-six horses for his own use ; while, with the open- handed liberality for which he was noted, he gave upwards of fifty horses as presents to various cavaliers of the army. The example of this generous and high-mettled, though some- what whimsical old cavalier, had a powerful effect in animating the inhabitants of Cuba to promote the success of the expedition, and in inducing some of them to enroll themselves among the fol- lowers of De Soto.* * The Portuguese narrator dryly asserts that Vasco Porcallo engaged in the expedition merely with a view to get slaves for his estates in Cuba. This narrator, however, is to be distrusted, when he assigns motives to the Spanish leaders, for whom he seems to have entertained a national jealousy. I have preferred the motives attributed by the Inca, as they seem borne out by facts, and by the general conduct of tins veteran Porcallo, whose character is quite Spanish and peculiar. Indeed, throughout the whole work of the Inca, his rich and copious facts are always in harmony with the characteristics of his persons. CHAPTER V. JUAN BE ANASCO TWICE DISPATCHED TO FLORIDA. HIS NARROW ESCAPE AND SAFE RETURN. FINAL PREPARATIONS OF THE GOVERNOR. For three months the governor made a tour of the island, visit- ing the principal towns, appointing officers of justice to rule in his absence, purchasing horses, and making other provisions for his expedition. Towards the end of August he repaired to Ha- vana, where he was afterwards joined by his family and all his forces. Here he remained for a time, aiding the inhabitants, out of his own fortune, to rebuild their houses and churches, which had recently been destroyed by French corsairs. While thus occupied he twice dispatched the Contador Juan de Anasco, in a brigantine manned with picked sailors, to coast the shores of Florida, in quest of some commodious harbor to which the expedition might sail direct, and find secure anchorage, and a good landing place for the troops. Juan de Anasco was well fitted for such a service, combining the sailor with the soldier, and possessing some skill in nautical science. He was fond, too, of hazardous enterprise, never flinch- ing from toils or perils, and was an excellent leader, though some- what touchy and choleric. 50 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. Three months elapsed after his departure on his second voy- age, without any tidings of him, and great fears were entertained for his safety, when at length his tempest-tossed bark arrived at Havana. No sooner did Juan de Ailasco and his crew put foot upon land, than they threw themselves on their knees, and in this way crawled to church to hear mass, in fulfilment of a vow made in an hour of great peril. This done, they related all the dangers they had passed on sea and land ; having once been in imminent peril of foundering, and having passed two months on an uninhabited island, subsisting on shell-fish gathered along the beach, and wild- fowl knocked down with clubs. Anasco, however, had fulfilled the great object of his cruise, having found a secure harbor on the coast of Florida. He brought with him four of the captured natives, to serve as inter- preters and guides. All his forces being now assembled in Havana, and the sea- son favorable for sailing being at hand, the governor made his final arrangements, appointing his wife Dona Isabel de Bobadilla to govern the island during his absence, with Juan de Roxas as lieutenant-governor, and Francisco de Guzman as his lieutenant, in the city of Santiago. These two cavaliers had been in com- mand prior to his arrival at the island, and had proved them- selves worthy of this great mark of confidence.* * The Inca, Lib. i. c. 13. f Portuguese Relation, c. vii., Herrera, D. vi. L. vii c. 9. CHAPTER VI. PONCE MUCH AGAINST THE WILL OP THE LATTER. While the governor was waiting for a fair wind to embark and set sail, a ship was seen hovering off the port, driven thither by stress of weather, but evidently endeavoring to keep to sea. Three times it was forced to the mouth of the harbor, and as often fought its way against contrary winds to the broad ocean, as if the greatest anxiety of the crew was to avoid the port. At length, after struggling four or five days against tempestuous weather, it was compelled to come to anchor in the harbor. This ship came from Nombre de Dios, on the Isthmus of Panama, and this was the story of its singular conduct. On board it was Hernan Ponce, an old comrade of Hernando De Soto. They had sought their fortunes together in Peru, and when De Soto had left that country for a time to visit Spain, he entered into articles of partnership, or brotherhood, as it was called, with Hernan Ponce, as was frequently done by the Span- ish discoverers and soldiers of fortune in the new world. By these articles they bound themselves, during their lives, to an equal participation of gains and losses, and of all things, whether of honor or profit. 52 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. After the departure of De Soto for Spain, Hernan Ponce had amassed much wealth, and had recovered several debts which De Soto had left with him to be collected. Having turned all his property into gold and silver, and jewels and precious stones, he embarked for Spain, but, at the port of embarkation, heard of the new enterprise of his old companion De Soto, and that he was at Havana with a great and expensive armament for the con- quest of Florida. Hernan Ponce had no ambition of joining in the conquest ; and feared that De Soto, having expended all his own wealth upon his outfits, would claim his right of partnership and seek to share the treasures he was carrying home, if not to grasp the whole. Hernan Ponce, therefore, had been anxious to steer clear of the port of Havana and pursue his voyage, and had made large offers to the mariners to induce them to keep to sea, but tempestuous weather had absolutely driven them into port. No sooner did Hernando De Soto hear of the arrival of his ancient comrade and partner, than he sent persons on board to compliment and congratulate him upon his arrival, and invite him on shore to share with him his house, his possessions, and all his honors and commands. The message he followed up in person, repeating his congratulations and offers. Hernan Ponce would gladly have dispensed with both com- pliments and fraternity, and quaked in secret for the safety of his treasures. He affected, however, to reciprocate the joy and good will of his former comrade, but excused himself from landing until the following day, pleading the necessity of sleep and repose after the fatigues of the late tempest. De Soto left him to his repose, but suspecting, or having had some intimation of his real circumstances and designs, secretly stationed senti- HONORABLE CONDUCT OF DE SOTO. 63 nels by sea and by land to keep watch upon his movements. His precautions were not in vain. Hernan Ponce about midnight sent two coffers, containing all his gold, pearls, and precious stones, to be concealed in some hamlet, or buried on the shore, leaving only the silver on board, to keep up appearances, intend- ing to pass it off on his partner as the whole of his wealth. No sooner had the mariners landed the coffers, and conveyed them some distance from the boat, than a party of sentinels rushed out from a thicket, put them to flight, seized upon the treasure, and conveyed it to the governor. The confusion and distress of Hernan Ponce, at losing his beloved treasure, may easily be imagined. He landed the next day with a sorrowful countenance, and took up his abode with De Soto. In private conversation, he revealed the misfortune of the preceding night. De Soto had been waiting for the occasion, and now broke forth indignantly, reproaching him with having attempted to conceal his treasures, through want of faith in his justice and friendship. To show how groundless was his dis- trust, he ordered the coffers to be brought in, and requested him to open them and see if any thing were missing. He furthermore declared that all he had expended in his present undertaking, and all the titles, commands, and privileges he had obtained from the crown, he had considered as for their mutual benefit, according to their terms of co-partnership and fraternity ; as he could prove by witnesses with him, whft had been present at the execution of the writings He now offered, whether he chose to accompany him in his conquest or not, to share with him his titles and commands, or to yield to him such of them as he might prefer. 54 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. Hernan Ponce was confounded by the overwhelming courtesy of the governor, and the sense of his own delinquency ; but his heart yearned more after his own treasures than after all De Soto's anticipated conquests. He excused himself as well as he could for the past, pretended to be highly gratified at being still considered partner and brother, but declined all participation in De Soto's titles. He begged that their writings of co-partner- ship might be renewed and made public, and that his Excellency would proceed with his conquest, while he should return to Spain ; leaving to some future occasion the division of all their gains. To testify his acceptance of one half of the conquest, he entreated his Excellency to permit his wife Dona Isabel de Bobadilla, to receive from him ten thousand dollars in gold and silver, to aid in the expenses of the expedition ; being the half of what he had brought from Peru. De Soto granted his prayer ; the ten thousand dollars were paid into the hands of Dona Isabel, the articles of co-partnership were renewed, and during the whole stay of Hernan Ponce at Havana, he was always addressed as his Excellency, and received the same personal honors as the governor. The heart of Hernan Ponce, however, rested with his money bags, and delighted not in these empty honors. Under various pretexts, he deferred sailing for Spain until after the departure of De Soto and his army for Florida. Eight days after the governor had sailed, when there was no likelihood of his prompt return, Hernan Ponce addressed an instrument in writing to Juan de Rojas, the lieutenant-governor, declaring that the ten thousand dollars given to Hernando de Soto had not been paid as a just debt, but extorted through fear lest he should make use of his power to strip him of all his property. He begged, there- ESCAPE OF HERNAtf PONCE. 55 fore, that Dona Isabel de Bobadilla might be compelled to refund them, otherwise he should complain to the Emperor of the injus- tice with which he had been treated. To this claim, Dona Isabel replied, that there were many accounts both new and old to be settled between Hernan Ponce and her husband, as would be seen by their writings of co-part- nership. That Hernan Ponce owed her husband more than fifty thousand ducats, as half of the amount expended in the outfit for the conquest. She demanded, therefore, that he should be ar- rested and held in safety until all these accounts could be exam- ined and adjusted, which she offered immediately to attend to, in the name of her husband. Hernan Ponce obtained a hint of the new troubles preparing for him, and fearing, should he fall into the hands of justice, he would meet with but little mercy, he hoisted sail before the har- pies of the law could get hold of him, and made the best of his way to Spain, leaving his ten thousand dollars and all the unset- tled accounts in the hands of Dona Isabel.* Having thus dis- posed of this episode, we will step back eight days in our chro- nology, to relate the sailing of the expedition for Florida. * Hist, of Florida, per el Inca, Lib. i. c. 14, 15. CHAPTER VII. THE ARMAMENT SETS SAIL FROM CUBA ARRIVAL AND LANDING IN FLORIDA EXPLOIT OF VASCO PORCALLO THEY COME UPON THE FIRST TRACES OF PAMPHILO DE NARVAEZ. On the 12th May,* 1539, Hernando De Soto sailed from Havana on his great enterprise. His squadron consisted of eight large vessels, a caravel, and two brigantines, all freighted with ample means of conquest and colonization. In addition to the forces brought from Spain, he had been joined by many volunteers, and recruits in Cuba, so that his armament, besides the ships' crews, amounted to a thousand men, with three hundred and fifty horses. It was altogether the most splendid expedition that had yet set out for the new world. The prevalence of contrary winds kept the squadron tossing about, for several days, in the Grulf of Mexico. At length on Whitsunday, the twenty-fifth day of May, they arrived at the mouth of a deep bay, to which, in honor of the day, De Soto gave the name of Espiritu Santo, now known as Tampa Bay. They had scarce arrived on the coast, when they beheld bale- fires blazing along the shores, and columns of smoke rising in * la De Soto's letter to the magistrates of Santiago, he says, he sailed on the 18th of May. ENCOUNTER WITH THE INDIANS. 57 different directions. It was evident the natives had taken the alarm, and were summoning their warriors to assemble. De Sotto was cautious, therefore, as to debarking his troops, and re- mained several days on board ; sounding the harbor, and seeking a secure landing-place. In the mean time a boat sent on shore to procure grass for the horses, brought off a quantity of green grapes, which grew wild in the woods. They were of a kind different from any that the Spaniards had seen either in Mexico or Peru, and they regarded them with exultation as proofs of a fruitful and pleasant country. At length, on the last day of the month, a detachment of three hundred soldiers landed, and took formal possession of the country, in the name of Charles V. Not a single Indian was to be seen, and the troops remained all night on shore, in a state of careless security. Towards the dawn of day, however, an im- mense number of savages broke upon them with deafening yells ; several of the Spaniards were wounded with arrows, many were seized with panic, as new levied troops are apt to be in their first encounter, especially when in a strange land and assailed by strange foes. They retreated to the edge of the sea in confu- sion, crowding together so as to prevent each other from fighting to advantage, and sounding the alarm with drum and trumpet. The din of the tumult reached the fleet. The late seemingly lifeless hulks were immediately as busy as hives of bees, when their republic is invaded : armor was buckled on in haste, and a reinforcement landed. The lieutenant-general Yasco Porcallo, with seven horsemen, took the lead, not a little pleased with having so early an opportunity of displaying his prowess. Dash- ing his spurs into his horse, and brandishing his lance, he charged upon the savages, who made but slight resistance, and fled. He 58 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. pursued them for some distance, and then returned highly elated with this first snuff of battle. Scarcely had he reached the camp, however, when his horse staggered under him and fell dead, having been wounded by an arrow in the course of the skirmish. The shaft had been sent with such force as to pass through the saddle and its housings, and to bury itself, one third of its length, between the ribs of the horse. Yasco Porcallo rose triumphant from his fall, vaunt- ing that the first horse that had fallen in this expedition was his> and his the first lance raised against the infidels. The remainder of the troops were now disembarked and en- camped on the borders of the bay, where they remained a few days reposing after the fatigues of the sea. They then marched to a village situated about two leagues distant ; while the ships, being lightened by the landing of the troops, were enabled, with the aid of the tide, to take their station opposite. The village was deserted by the inhabitants. It consisted of several large houses, built of wood and thatched with palm- leaves. At one end stood a kind of temple, with the image of a bird on top, made of wood, with gilded eyes. In this edifice were found strings of pearls of small value, having been injured by the fire, in boring them for necklaces and bracelets. In an opposite quarter of the village, upon an artificial emi- nence near the shore, so constructed as to serve as a fortress, stood the dwelling of the cacique* Here the governor took up * Mr. G. R. Fairbanks informs me that there is now at Tampa, an artificial eminence near the water, corresponding to that on which the house of the cacique is said to have stood ; and adds, to strengthen the belief, that such artificial structures could last so many centuries, that excavations or embank- ments once made in a soil like that of Florida, do not become effaced for cer> CAPTURE OF THE INDIANS. 59 his residence, with his lieutenant, the veteran Porcallo, and his camp-master Luis de Moseoso. The other houses were converted into barracks for the troops, and storehouses for the provisions and ammunition brought on shore from the vessels. The trees and bushes were cleared away, for the distance of a bow-shot round the village, so as to give room for the cavalry to act, and to guard against sudden surprise in the night time. Sentinels also were placed at every point, and parties of horsemen patrolled the neighborhood. The governor at length succeeded in capturing a few strag- gling Indians, natives of the place, from whom he learned the cause of the fierce hostility of their countrymen, and their deser- tion of the village. Here it was that he first came upon the traces of his predecessor, Pamphilo de Narvaez, and unfortunately they were of a cruel character. Narvaez in his expedition to Florida had been bravely opposed by the cacique of this village, whose name was Hirrihigua.* He succeeded, at length, in winning his turies ; and that even the slight ridges made by cultivation, may be traced with exactness in forests densely covered with huge oaks. He says it is also so with the trails or paths, and as De Soto undoubtedly followed these as far as he was able, he thinks that in judging of Ms route, much attention should be paid to these Indian trails, which, from the many intervening streams, swamps, and lakes, must have been full and generally used. * We give this name according to Garcilaso de la Vega ; the Portuguese narrator calls the cacique Ucita. These two authorities often differ as to In- dian names. Sometimes they merely vary in the spelling, as is natural where the names were caught by ear, and did not originally exist in writing. At other times they differ entirely ; one narrator having probably heard a village and province called by its proper and permanent name, the other by the name of its cacique. These discrepancies are common and unavoidable, in the narratives of adventures among savage tribes, whose language is un- written and but little understood. Where irreconcilable differences occur, we are generally inclined to follow the Inca, as he received his facts from three 3* 60 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA, friendship, and a treaty was formed between them. Subsequent- ly, however, Narvaez became enraged at the cacique for some un- known reason, and in a transport of passion had ordered his nose to be cut off, and his mother to be torn to pieces by dogs. These merciless wrongs, as may well be supposed, had filled the heart of Hirrihigua with the bitterest hatred of the white men. De Soto endeavored to appease the cacique and gain his friendship. For this purpose he treated his subjects whom he had captured in the kindest manner, and sent them, laden with presents, to seek their chieftain and invite him to amicable inter- course. The Cacique was indignant at his subjects for daring to bring him messages from a race who had injured and insulted him so deeply. " I want none of their speeches nor promises," said he, bitterly, " bring me their heads, and I will receive them joy- fully." De Soto was reluctant to leave so powerful a foe between himself and his ships, and endeavored, by repeated envoys, to soften his animosity : but every message only provoked a more bitter and scornful reply. While thus negotiating with this vindictive savage, he receiv- ed intelligence that there was a Spaniard, a survivor of the fol- lowers of Famphilo de Narvaez, living under the protection of a neighboring cacique called Mucozo.* To obtain the services of this Spaniard was now a matter of great moment with the gover- nor, for, having lived upwards of ten years in the country, and different members of the expedition, one a gentleman of rank, the other two private soldiers ; whereas the Portuguese account has merely the authority of a single witness. The account of the transactions on landing are chiefly taken from the Inca, and occasionally from the Portuguese Narrative. * Mocoso. Portuguese Narrative. SUSPENSION" OF HOSTILITIES. 61 become acquainted with, the language and customs of the natives, he was well fitted to act as guide, interpreter, and negotiator. He accordingly dispatched the brave and trusty Baltasar de G-al- legos, the chief Alguazil, at the head of sixty lances, and under the guidance of a native Indian, on an embassy to the cacique Mucozo, to obtain the release of the Spaniard, and invite the chieftain to the camp, with assurances of great friendship and munificent rewards. As this Spaniard was subsequently of great service through- out the expedition, and as his story is illustrative of the character and customs of the natives, and of the implacable resentment of the cacique Hirrihigua, we will diverge for a moment from the main course of our narrative, to relate some particulars of his ad- ventures. CHAPTER VIII. STORY OF JUAN ORTIZ. Shortly after Pamphilo de Narvaez had left the village of Hirrihigua, on his disastrous march into the interior, a small vessel of his fleet, which was in quest of him, put into the bay of Espiritu Santo. Anchoring before the town, they saw a few Indians, who made signs for them to land, pointing to a letter in the end of a cleft reed, stuck in the ground. The Spaniards supposed, and probably with justice, that it was a letter of in- struction left by Narvaez, giving information of his movements and destination. They made signs for the Indians to bring it to them. The latter, however, refused, but getting into a canoe came on board, where four of them offered to remain as hostages for such Spaniards as chose to go on shore for the letter. Upon this, four Spaniards stepped into the canoe and were swiftly conveyed to the shore. The moment they landed, a multitude of savages rushed out of the village and surrounded them, and, at the same time, the hostages on board plunged into the sea and swam to shore. The crew of the vessel, seeing the number of the enemy, and dreading some further mishap, made sail with all haste, abandoning their luckless comrades to their fate.* * Garcilaso de la Vega, Part i. L. ii. c. 1. Portuguese Narrative, c. 9 Heirera, D. vi. L. vii. c. 10. CAPTIVITY OF JUAN ORTIZ. 63 The captives were conveyed with savage triumph into the village of Hirrihigua ; for the whole had been a stratagem of the cacique, to get some of the white men into his power, upon whom he might wreak his vengeance. He placed his prisoners under a strong guard, until a day of religious festival. They were then stripped naked, led out into the public square of the village, and turned loose, one at a time, to be shot at with arrows. To pro- long their misery and the enjoyment of their tormentors, but one Indian was allowed to shoot at a time. In this way the first three were sacrificed, and the cacique took a vindictive pleasure in beholding them, running in their agony from corner to corner, vainly seeking an asylum in every nook, until after re- peated wounds they were shot to death. Juan Ortiz, a youth, scarce eighteen years of age, of a noble family of Seville, was the fourth victim. As they were leading him forth, his extreme youth touched with compassion the hearts of the wife and daughters of the cacique, who interceded in his favor. The cacique listened to their importunities, and granted for the present the life of Ortiz ; — but a wretched life did he lead. From morning until evening he was employed in bringing wood and water, and was allowed but little sleep and scanty food. Not a day passed that he was not beaten. On festivals he was an object of barbarous amusement to the cacique, who would oblige him to run, from sunrise until sunset, in the public square of the village, where his companions had met their un- timely end ; Indians being stationed with bows and arrows, to shoot him, should he halt one moment. When the day was spent, the unfortunate youth lay stretched on the hard floor of the hut, more dead than alive. At such times the wife and 64 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. daughters of the cacique would come to him privately with food and clothing, and by their kind treatment his life was preserved. At length the cacique, determining to put an end to his victim's existence, ordered that he should be bound down upon a wooden frame, in the form of a huge gridiron, placed in the public square, over a bed of live coals, and roasted alive. The cries and shrieks of the poor youth reached his female protectors, and their entreaties were once more successful with the cacique. They unbound Ortiz, dragged him from the fire, and took him to their dwelling, where they bathed him with the juice of herbs, and tended him with assiduous care. After many days he recovered from his wounds, though marked with many a scar. His employment was now to guard the cemetery of the vil- lage. This was in a lonely field in the bosom of a forest. The bodies of the dead were deposited in wooden boxes, covered with boards, without any fastening except a stone or a log of wood laid upon the top ; so that the bodies were often carried away by wild beasts. In this cemetery was Ortiz stationed, with a bow and arrows, to watch day and night, and was told that should a single body be carried away, he would be burnt alive. He returned thanks to G-od for having freed him from the dreaded presence of the cacique, hoping to lead a better life with the dead than he had done with the living. While watching thus one long wearisome night, sleep over- powered him towards morning. He was awakened by the fall- ing lid of one of the chests, and, running to it, found it empty. It had contained the body of an infant recently deceased, the child of an Indian of great note. ORTIZ KILLS A PANTHER. 65 Ortiz doubted not some animal had dragged it away, and im- mediately set out in pursuit. After wandering for some time, he heard, a short distance within the woods, a noise like that of a dog gnawing bones. Warily drawing near to the spot, he dimly perceived an animal among the bushes, and invoking suc- cor from on high, let fly an arrow at it. The thick and tangled underwood prevented his seeing the effect of his shot, but as the animal did not stir, he flattered himself that it had been fatal : with this hope he waited until the day dawned, when he beheld his victim, a huge animal of the panther kind,* lying dead, the arrow having passed through his entrails and cleft his heart. Gathering together the mangled remains of the infant, and replacing them in the coffin, Ortiz dragged his victim in triumph to the village, with the arrow still in his body. The exploit gained him credit with the old hunters^ and for some time sof- tened even the ferocity of the cacique. The resentment of the latter, however, for the wrongs he had suffered from white men, was too bitter to be appeased. Some time after, his eldest daughter came to Ortiz, and warned him that her father had de- termined to sacrifice him at the next festival, which was just at hand, and that the influence of her mother, her sisters, and herself would no longer avail him. She wished him, therefore, to take refuge with a neighboring cacique named Mucozo, who loved her and sought her in marriage, and who, for her sake, would befriend him. " This very night at midnight," said the kind-hearted maiden, " at the northern extremity of the village you will find a trusty friend who will guide you to a bridge, * The Inca calls this animal a Hon, as the Spanish discoverers were prone to call animals of the tiger or panther kind. 66 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. about two leagues hence ; on arriving there, you must send him back, that he may reach home before the morning dawn, to avoid suspicion — for well he knows that this bold act, in daring to assist you, may bring down destruction upon us both. Six leagues further on, you will come to the village of Mucozo — tell him that I have sent you, and expect him to befriend you in your extremity — I know he will do it — go, and may your G-od protect you !" Ortiz threw himself at the feet of his generous pro- tectress, and poured out his acknowledgments for the kindness she had always shown him. The Indian guide was at the place appointed, and they left the village without alarming the warlike savages. When they came to the bridge, Ortiz sent back the guide, in obedience to the injunction of his mistress, and, con- tinuing his flight, found himself, by break of day, on the banks of a small stream near the village of Mucozo. Looking cautiously around, he espied two Indians fishing. As he was unacquainted with their language, and could not explain the cause of his coming, he was in dread lest they should take him for an enemy and kill him. He, therefore, ran to the place where they had deposited their weapons and seized upon them. The savages fled to the village without heeding his as- surances of friendly intention. The inhabitants sallied out with bows and arrows, as though they would attack him. Ortiz fixed an arrow in his bow, but cried out at the same moment, that he came not as an enemy but as an ambassador from a female cacique to their chief. Fortunately one present understood him, and interpreted his words. On this the Indians unbent their bows, and returning with him to their village, presented him to Mucozo. The latter, a youthful chieftain, of a graceful form and handsome countenance, received Ortiz kindly for the ORTIZ IS PROTECTED BY MUCOZO. 61 sake of her who had sent him ; but, on further acquaintance, be- came attached to him for his own merits, treating him with the affection of a brother. Hirrihigua soon heard where the fugitive had taken refuge, and demanded several times that he should be delivered up ; Mucozo as often declined ; considering himself bound by the laws of honor and hospitality to protect him. Hirrihigua then employed as mediator another cacique, a brother-in-law of Mu- cozo, by the name of Urribarracuxi, who went in person to demand Ortiz. The generous Mucozo, however, refused to deliver up to a cruel enemy, the poor fugitive who had come recommended to his protection, and treated the very request as a stain upon his honor. The two caciques continued their im- portunities, but the high-minded savage remained faithful to his guest, though in maintaining inviolate the sacred rites of hospi- tality, he lost the friendship of his brother-in-law, and forfeited the hand of her he tenderly loved, the beautiful daughter of Hirrihigua. CHAPTER IX. BALTAZAR DE GALLEGOS DISPATCHED IN SEARCH OF JUAN ORTIZ THE CACIQUE MUCOZO, AND AFTERWARDS HIS MOTHER, VISIT THE SPANISH CAMP. 1539. At this juncture tidings reached Mucozo of the arrival of De Soto and his troops at the village of Hirrihigua, and that it was their intention to conquer the country. Alarmed at this intelli- gence, he addressed himself to- Ortiz. " You all know," said he, " what I have done for you ; that I have sheltered you when friendless, and have chosen rather to fall into disgrace with my relations and neighbors, than to deliver you into the hands of your enemies. This I did without thought or hope of reward, but the time has come when you can repay me for my friend- ship. Go to the chieftain of this army of white men — represent to him the asylum I have extended to you, and which, in like case, I would have afforded to any of your countrymen — entreat him, in return, not to lay waste my territory, and assure him that I and mine are ready to devote ourselves to his service." Ortiz gladly departed on the mission, accompanied by fifty chosen warriors. It happened that about the same time Baltazar de Gallegos had been dispatched, as has been already mentioned, on his embassy to Mucozo. RESCUE OF JUAN ORTIZ. 69 As Ortiz and his Indian escort, therefore, were on their way to the village of Hirrihigua, they came in sight of Baltazar, and his hand of lancers, glistening at a distance, in the midst of a verdant plain, skirted by a wood. The Indians would have concealed themselves in the forest, until the Christians could he informed that they were friends ; but Ortiz slighted their advice, insisting that his countrymen would at once recognize him : not reflecting that in appearance he was in nowise different from his savage companions, being like them almost naked, his body browned by exposure to the sun, his arms painted, a quiver at his back, a bow and arrow in his hand, and his head adorned with feathers. No sooner did the Spaniards descry the savages, than they came down upon them at full gallop, heedless of the voice of their captain ; for they were newly raised soldiers, full of spirit, and eager for a brush with the natives. The Indians fled terrified to the wood. One, however, was overtaken and slain. Juan Ortiz was assaulted by Alvaro Nieto, one of the stoutest and boldest troopers in the army. Ortiz parried the thrust of his lance with his bow, running at the same time, and leaping from side to side with great agility to avoid the horse, crying out lustily Xivilla, Xivilla — meaning Seville, Seville ; and making the sign of the cross with his arm and bow, to signify that he was a Christian.* Alvaro Nieto hearing him cry out Xivilla, demanded of him whether he was Juan Ortiz. On his replying in the affirmative, he seized him by the arm, lifted him upon the croup of his saddle, and scoured away to present him to Baltazar de GJ-allegos. The captain received him with great joy, and ordered his troopers * Biedma says he invoked the name of the Virgin. 70 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. to be recalled, who were beating up the woods and hunting the poor Indians like so many deer. Ortiz himself went into the forest and called to the Indians, to come out and fear nothing. Many, however, fled back to their village, to acquaint Mucozo with what had happened. Others joined Ortiz in small parties, upbraiding him with his rashness, but when they found one of their people wounded, they were so exasperated, that they would have laid violent hands upon him had not the Spaniards been present. They were at length pacified. The soldiers bound up the wounds of the Indian, and placed him upon a horse. The troop- ers, having taken up all the Indians behind them, galloped away for the encampment of the governor. Previously to setting off, however, Ortiz dispatched an Indian to Mucozo, with a true account of the late events, lest that cacique should be irritated by the alarming statement brought by the fugitives.* The night was already far advanced when Baltazar de Gallegos and his band reached the camp. When the governor heard the tramp of their horse, he feared some mischance had befallen them, as he had not looked for them before the expiration of three days. His apprehensions were soon turned to rejoicing. He praised Gal- legos and his men for the skill and success of their expedition, and received Ortiz as his own son, sympathizing with his past suffer- ings, and presenting him with a suit of clothes, arms, and a good horse, f The Indians he treated with kindness, and ordered the wounded savage to be carefully attended. He then dispatched two of the natives to Mucozo, thanking him for his past kindness * Portuguese Narrative, c. 8. Herrera, D. vi. L. vii. c. 9. f Portuguese Narrative, c. *7. Garcilaso de la Vega, P. i. L. ii. c. 7. Her- rera, Decad. vi. L. vii. c. 10. ARRIVAL OF THE CACIQUE. 71 to Ortiz, accepting his proffers of friendship, and inviting him to the camp. Not an eye was closed this night, but one and all joined in the revelry which welcomed the liberation of poor Ortiz. On the third day after the envoys had been dispatched, the cacique arrived, accompanied by his warriors. He kissed the hands of the governor with great veneration, saluted each one of the officers, and made a slight obeisance to the privates. De Soto received him with affectionate courtesy, and assured him that his people would be ever grateful to him for all his past kindness- es. " What I have done unto Ortiz," said Mucozo, " is but little indeed ; he came commended to me, and threw himself upon my protection. There is a law of our tribe, which forbids our betray- ing a fugitive who asks an asylum. But his own virtue and courage entitled him to all the respect shown him. That I have pleased your people, I rejoice exceedingly, and by devoting my- self, henceforth, to their service, 1 hope to merit their esteem." These words were uttered with so much grace, his bearing was so noble and lofty, and his manner so full of kindness, that De Soto and his officers were touched, and made presents to him and his warriors. Two days afterwards came the mother of Mucozo, overwhelm- ed with grief because her son was in the power of the Christians. She never would have consented to his visiting the army, but was absent at the time of his departure. She passionately entreated the governor to deliver up her son, and not serve him as Narvaez had served Hirrihigua. " He is young," said she ; " only give him his liberty, and take me, who am a poor old woman, and treat me as you please. I will bear any punishment for both." De Soto en- deavored to reassure her by expressions of gratitude and friend- 72 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. ship for her son and herself; but though she remained three days in the camp, and was treated by every one with respect and kind- ness, she continued anxious and suspicious. She ate at the table of the governor, but would partake of nothing until Ortiz had tasted it ; fearing she might be poisoned. " How is this," said a Spaniard to her, " that you have now so great a fear of death, you who oifered to die for your son V " I have the same love of life as other mortals," replied she, " but most willingly would I lose it to save a son, who is far dearer to me than life itself!" Even when assured of the perfect liberty of Mucozo, and that he only remained for a time with the Spaniards through choice, because they were young braves like himself, she was but poorly comforted, and departed sorrowing for her home. On parting, she took Juan Ortiz aside, and besought him to liberate Mucozo, inasmuch as he had saved him from the vengeful hands of Hir- rihigua. The cacique remained in the army eight days, and during this time became very familiar, and was inspired with perfect confi- dence in the Spaniards. He went home well contented, and fre- quently afterwards revisited the governor, bringing always a num- ber of presents.* * Garcilaso de la Vega. P. i. L. ii. c. 7, 8. CHAPTER X. THE GOVERNOR ENDEAVORS TO GAIN THE FRIENDSHIP OP THE CACIQUE OP HIRRffllGUA GALLEGOS DISPATCHED ON AN EXPEDITION TO THE VILLAGE OP URRIBARRACAXI HE HEARS OP A REGION TO THE WESTWARD ABOUNDING IN GOLD. 1539. While these things were passing in the camp, the provi- sions and munitions were landed from the caravels, and stored away in the village of Hirrihigua. The Adelantado, following the example of Cortes and other renowned captains, dispatched seven of the largest vessels to the Havana, in order that his fol- lowers might lose all hope of leaving the country, retaining only a caravel and two brigantines to keep command of the sea-coast and of the bay.* He appointed Pedro Calderon to the command of this important post. He was a hardy veteran, nursed in a rough school, amid camps and battle scenes, and had served in his youth under the great Captain Gronsalvo de Cordova. De Soto left no means untried to gain the friendship of Hir- rihigua, being aware that the example of this powerful chieftain would have great sway with the neighboring caciques. Accord- ingly, whenever the troopers, in foraging the adjacent country, captured a vassal of this cacique, he instantly sent him home loaded with presents and kind messages, urging Hirrihigua to * Hen-era, Hist. Ind., Decad. vi. L. vii. c. 10. •74 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. accept his proffered amity, and promising every reparation for the wrongs inflicted upon him by Pamphilo de Narvaez. These wrongs, however, were too deep to be easily obliterated from the stern bosom of the chieftain. The only reply he deigned to give was, " The memory of my injuries forbids my sending a kind answer, and a harsh one your courtesy will not allow me to re- turn." Still these constant and unwearied exertions of De Soto in some measure mitigated the deadly rancor of the cacique against the Spaniards. The governor made many inquiries of Ortiz respecting the country, and whether there was any region abounding in gold and silver. Ortiz knew of none, and could yield but little in- formation. When with Hirrihigua he had been closely watched, and not allowed to wander : and although while dwelling with Mucozo he had perfect liberty, yet he dared not venture far, through fear of being waylaid by his enemies. He had heard much, however, of a cacique named Urribarracaxi, whose vil- lage was thirty leagues distant, who was the most powerful chieftain of the country. To him Mucozo, Hirrihigua, and all the other caciques of the coast paid tribute, and his territories were far more fertile and abundant than those nearer the sea.* Upon this the governor dispatched Baltazar de Gallegos on an expedition to the village of this powerful cacique. Gallegos chose the same sixty lances that had accompanied him when in search of Juan Ortiz, and other sixty foot-soldiers, armed with * Portuguese Relation, c. 9. The name of the cacique in the Portuguese Narrative is Paracoxi. In the relation of Luis Hernandez de Biedma, and in De Soto's letter to the magistrates of Santiago, he ia called HurripacuxL We follow the Inca. EXPEDITION OF BALTAZAR DE GALLEGOS. 15 cross-bows and bucklers. He was accompanied by Ortiz, as guide and interpreter. On approaching the village of Mucozo, the cacique came forth to receive them, and entertained them for the night with great hospitality. On the following morning the captain demanded of him a guide to the village of Urribar- racaxi. The cacique at first thought their designs upon the vil- lage were hostile, and shrank with noble spirit from what would have been an act of perfidy against his relative and neighbor. When he found., however, that they were on a friendly errand, and only wanted one of his vassals as a precursor, to go before and inform Urribarracaxi of their amicable intentions, he gladly furnished them with an Indian for the purpose, who had been a fast friend of Juan Ortiz. In their march thus far into the interior they had been oc- casionally impeded by morasses, which, however, became less fre- quent the farther they went from the sea. They observed many trees similar to those of Spain, such as walnut, oak, mulberry, plum, pine, and evergreen oak. There were wild grapes also in abundance. The distance from the village of Mucozo to that of his bro- ther-in-law was about seventeen leagues. They arrived there in four days, but found it deserted, the inhabitants having fled to the woods. They sent their envoy repeatedly to the cacique, with the most friendly messages, but every effort to draw him from his retreat proved fruitless, though he manifested no hos- tility in word or deed. G-allegos made diligent inquiry of the Indians they met with as to any province where gold and silver were to be found. They replied that there was a country to the westward called Ocali, the inhabitants of which were continually 4 tjQ CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. at war with, the people of another province, in which the Spring lasted all the year long, and gold was so plenty that their war- riors wore head-pieces of that precious metal.* * Portuguese Xarrative.. c. 10, CHAPTER XL THE EXPEDITION OF THE VETERAN VASCO PORCALLO IN QUEST OF THE CACIQUE HIRRIHIGUA, AND HOW HE FARED IN A SWAMP. 1539. After Hernando de Soto had dispatched Gallegos on his ex- ploring expedition, he received intelligence that the cacique Hirrihigua was concealed in a forest at no great distance from the camp. He was about to send a captain with an armed force in quest of him, when the enterprise was claimed by the lieutenant-general, Vasco Porcallo de Figueroa. This brave old cavalier had a passion for military exploit, and was, withal, a little vainglorious. He thought this a fitting opportunity to signalize himself, and insisted upon having the honor of captur- ing this fugitive, yet formidable cacique. The enterprise being granted to him, he prepared for it in his usual style; for he was fond of parade, and generous in all his appointments. Having selected a band of horsemen and foot-soldiers, he put himself at their head and sallied forth from the camp, well mounted, and cased in glittering armor, vaunting that he would bring home Hirrihigua either a prisoner or a friend.* * Garcilaso de la Vega, P. i. L. ii c. 9. Herrera, Hist. Ind., Decad. vi L. vii. c. 10. CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. He had not proceeded far, however, when he was met by an Indian messenger, sent by Hirrihigua, who had received intelli- gence by his spies of the armed force marching in quest of him. The messenger entreated Yasco Porcallo on the part of Hirri- higua, not to proceed any further, as the cacique was in so secure a fortress that, with all his exertions, he could not get to him ; whereas he and his troops would be exposed to infinite perils from the rivers, morasses, and tangled forests, which he would have to pass. The cacique added, that he gave this advice, not through any fear for himself, but in consequence of the forbearance mani- fested by the Spaniards, in not injuring his territory, or his subjects. Vasco Porcallo listened to the messenger with incredulity; persuading himself that fear, not gratitude nor courtesy, dictated the message ; so he ordered the trumpet to sound, and marched on. As he advanced, messenger after messenger encountered him, all repeating the warning to return, and they at length be- came so frequent as almost to overtake each other. The more, however, he was warned to return, the more obstinately did the stout-hearted and hot-headed cavalier persist in advancing ; taking every thing by contrary, and judging of the panic of the cacique by the frequency of his messages. His only fear was that the prize might take to flight, and escape him. He spurred on hotly, therefore, with his troops, until they arrived at a vast and dismal morass. Here his men, perceiving the truth of the warnings, remon- strated about the difficulty and danger of attempting this morass. Vasco Porcallo, however, had put himself too much on his. met- tle to be easily daunted. He insisted upon their entering ; but, being an old soldier, he knew the effect, in time of difficulty, of set- ISSUE OF PORCALLO'S EXPEDITION. 79 ting an example ; so, putting spurs to his horse, he dashed for- ward, and his men followed him pell-mell into the morass. Vasco Porcallo had not proceeded far, however, when, coming to a deep miry place, his horse floundered and fell. The peril of the lieu- tenant-general was imminent ; the horse had fallen upon one of his legs so as to pin him down, while the weight of his armor contributed to sink him in the mire. Both horse and rider were in danger of suffocation ; nor could any one come to their aid, being in a perfect quagmire, where all who entered would be ex- posed to like peril. At length, with infinite difficulty, the worthy cavalier extri- cated himself and his steed from this dismal bog, and landed once more on firm ground, covered with mud and mire. All his vainglory was at an end, he was out of humor with himself, and felt mortified in the sight of his soldiers. The savage whom he had come to fight and capture, instead of encountering him with deadly weapons, had conquered him by courteous and friendly messages, and his vainglorious enterprise had ended in a struggle in a quagmire. Ordering his men to face about, he set out on his return to camp, in far different mood from that in which he had sallied forth. Amidst the mortifications of his present plight, he called to mind his pleasant and comfortable home at Cuba, and the easy and luxurious life he had led there. He reflected that he was no longer a boy ; that the vigor of his days was past ; that his present disaster was but a slight foretaste of the toils and troubles that must attend this conquering expedition ; that he was not obliged to encounter them, but had better return to his home, and leave the conquest of Florida for the young hotheads who were embarked in it. 80 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. Revolving these and similar thoughts in his mind, the worthy- old cavalier, all bedabbled and bemired, and totally crest-fallen, rode along in crusty and querulous yet half-whimsical humor, muttering his fancies to himself, and ejaculating, in a broken manner, the hard Indian names, with an occasional curse upon them for their ruggedness. " Hurri-harri ! Hurri-higa ! Burra- coxa ! Hurri-harri — the devil take a country where the great men have such infamous names ! A fine commencement this ! promising omens of future luck ! Glorious middles and ends to be augured from such beginnings ! — Well, let those work for food and fame who are in need of them. For my part, I have riches and honor enough to last for the rest of my life, and to leave behind me." In this moody way the worthy Vasco Porcallo arrived at the camp. All his dreams of conquest were at an end. The martial fire caught from the young sparks of the army, which had blazed up so suddenly in his bosom, was as suddenly extinguished. His only thought now was, how to get rid of his command of lieutenant-general, and to get safe back to his comfortable home in Cuba. With these views he presented himself at once before De Soto, and, stating his reasons with honest force and hearty sincerity, applied for permission to resign. The governor granted it with the same promptness and grace with which he had accepted his offer to join the enterprise, and moreover fur- nished him with the galliot San Anton, to convoy him to the island. The worthy veteran now set to work as eagerly to get out of the expedition as he had done to enter upon it. His train of servants, Spanish, Indian, and negro, were embarked with all speed ; but when the gallant old cavalier came to take leave of PORCALLO SAILS FOR CUBA. 81 his young companions in arms, and the soldiers he had lately aspired to lead so vaingloriously, his magnificent spirit broke forth. He made gifts to the right and left, dividing among the officers and knights all the arms, accoutrements, horses, and camp equipage with which he had come so lavishly and ostenta- tiously provided, and gave for the use of the army all the ample store of provisions and munitions "brought for the use of himself and his retinue. This done, he hade farewell to campaigning, and set sail for Cuba, much to the regret of the army, who lamented that so galliard a spirit should have burnt out so soon. The only one that remained behind of the train of Vasco Porcallo, was his natural son, named Gomez Suarez de Figueroa, whom he had by an Indian woman in Cuba, and with whom he left two horses and arms, and other necessaries. This youth, throughout this expedition, conducted himself as a good knight and soldier, and a worthy son of such a father, serving with great promptitude on all occasions.* * The Inca, P. i. L. ii c. 11. CHAPTER XII. DE SOTO LEAVES PEDRO CALDERON WITH A GARRISON IN HIRRI- HIGUA, AND SETS OUT ON HIS MARCH INTO THE INTERIOR THE DIFFICULTIES HE ENCOUNTERED GONZALO SILVESTRE SENT BACK WITH A MESSAGE TO CALDERON. 1539. On the day after the departure of Yasco Porcallo, a young cava- lier named G-onzalo Silvestre, followed by three other horsemen, rode into the camp, sent by Baltazar de Gallegos. They brought favorable accounts from Gallegos of the country he had explored, and assurances that in the village of Urribarracaxi and its neigh- borhood were provisions enough to sustain the army for several days. One drawback on their favorable intelligence was, that beyond the town of Urrabarracaxi extended a vast and dismal swamp, exceedingly difficult to be traversed. The Spaniards, however, who were all alert for action and adventure, made light of this obstacle, averring that God had given man genius and dex- terity with which to make his way through every difficulty. Satisfied from the relation given by these men that he might readily penetrate into the interior, the governor issued orders for every one to prepare to march on the fourth day. In the mean time he dispatched Gonzalo Silvestre, with twenty horse- CALDERON'S OCCUPATION OF HIRRIHIGUA. 88 men, to notify Baltazar cle Gallegos of his intended march to join him. As there was a great quantity of arms, ammunition, and pro- visions in the village of Hirrihigua, he left a garrison there of forty horsemen and eighty foot-soldiers, with Pedro Calderon as captain ; who had command also of the shipping in the harbor, consisting of a caravel and two brigantines with their crews. They were enjoined to remain quiet, and not to move to any other place without orders from De Soto : they were, moreover, to cultivate peace with the surrounding Indians ; not to make war upon them, even though they were taunted and insulted ; and, above all, to treat Mucozo with marked friendship. Having made all these arrangements, and trusting, as well he might, in Pedro Calderon as a good soldier and discreet captain, De Soto set out on the appointed day, with his main force, from the Bay of Espiritu Santo and the village of Hirrihigua. It was an arduous and difficult task to conduct such a body of troops, encumbered with armor and with all kinds of baggage and supplies, through a wilderness, exposed to hardships and dangers, and a wild kind of warfare, to all which most of them were entirely unaccustomed. As a leading object with the governor, also, was to found a colony, he was encumbered with many things that embarrassed the march of his army. Among these are particularly noted three hundred swine, with which he intended to stock the country when he should settle, having been found the most advantageous stock for the sustenance of new colonies. These animals were placed in charge of a company of horse, to keep them to the line of march, and guard them in traversing the swamps and rivers. Besides the matchlocks and cross-bows with which the infan- 4* 84 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. try were armed, there was one piece of ordnance in the army, the transportation of which must have cost vast labor, while it ap- pears never to have rendered any efficient service. After two days' march, always to the northeast, De Soto, on the morning of the third day, came in sight of the village of Mu- cozo. # The cacique came forth to receive him, expressing great grief at his intended departure from the country, and entreating him to remain that night in his village. The governor, however, excused himself, not wishing to task his hospitality with such a multitude of guests. He again expressed his thanks for the kind- ness shown to Juan Ortiz, and commended to his friendship and good offices the captain and soldiers who remained in garrison in the village of Hirrihigua. The cacique promised to observe to- wards them the strictest amity. He then took leave of the go- vernor and his principal officers and cavaliers, with many em- braces and apparently sincere tears, praying that the sun might shine upon them throughout their journey, and prosper them in all their undertakings. The Spaniards, themselves, were greatly affected at parting with this generous savage, who had in all things proved himself so true and noble a friend. On arriving at the village of Urribarracaxi.f De Soto found Baltazar de G-allegos waiting to receive him. The cacique, how- ever, was still absent, remaining in the fastnesses of the forest, and though the governor sent envoys with offers of peace and amity, nothing could draw him forth from his place of refuge. * Called now Hichipuchsassa. f Mr. Fairbanks thinks this village was in the hamraacks, near the head of the Hillsborough river, and remarks, that the Indians always made their settlements in the vicinity of the hammacks for purposes of cultivation, a? the best lands are always found there. RESISTANCE OP THE INDIANS. 85 A grand obstacle now lay in the way by which the Spaniards were to proceed. About three leagues from the village extended a great morass a league in width, two thirds mire and one third water, and very deep at the borders. Runners were sent forth in three different directions to discover a pass, which they succeeded in doing after several days' search. By this pass the army cross- ed with ease, although it took a whole day to do so. They now arrived on a broad plain, and sent the runners ahead to explore their route. The latter returned the next day, declaring that they could not proceed farther on account of the many bogs made by streams which ran out of the great morass and inundated the country. Upon this the governor determined to seek a road himself. Choosing, therefore, one hundred horse and as many foot-soldiers, he left the rest of the army encamped with the camp master-general, Luis de Moscoso, and recrossing the great swamp, travelled three days along one side of it, sending runners, at different distances, to seek for some outlet. During the three days, Indians incessantly sallied forth from the woods which skirted the swamp, discharging their arrows at the Spaniards and retreating to their thickets. Some, however, were killed and others taken prisoners. The latter were used as guides, but they led the troops into difficult passes, and places where Indians were lurking in ambush. Discovering their per- fidy, the Spaniards let loose the dogs, who killed four of them. Upon this, an Indian, fearing a similar fate, offered to guide them surely, and accordingly, after a wide circuit, brought them to a place free from mire, but where they had to proceed for the dis- tance of a league breast-high in water, until they came to the mid- channel, where, for a hundred yards, it was too deep to be forded. Here the Indians had constructed a rude bridge, by felling two 86 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. large trees into the water; and, where they did not unite, the space was supplied by logs tied to each other, with poles across them. By this same bridge Pamphilo de Narvaez had passed, ten years before, with his unfortunate army. Hernando de Soto, well pleased to have found this bridge, summoned two soldiers, half-breeds of the Island of Cuba, named Pedro Moron and Diego de Oliva, who were expert swimmers, and ordered them to take hatchets and cut away several branches which obstructed the passage of the bridge, and clear away all other impediments. The two soldiers set to work with all diligence, but in the midst of their labor, several canoes with Indians darted forth from among the rushes, and galled the workmen by a flight of arrows. The two half-breeds plunged from the bridge, swam under the water and came up near their comrades. They were but slightly wounded, for being under the surface of the water the force of the arrows was broken, and they did not penetrate deeply. After this sudden onset, the Indians retired. The Spaniards re- paired the bridge without being again molested, and at a short distance above they discovered a very good pass for the horses. Having thus succeeded in the object of his search, the gover- nor called to him Gonzalo Silvestre, one of the most hardy and spirited of his youthful cavaliers, and the best mounted of his troop. " To your lot," said he, " has fallen the best horse in the army, and the more work you will have in consequence, for we have to assign to you the most difficult tasks that occur. Return this night to the camp, and tell Luis de Moscoso to follow us with the army ; and to dispatch you ahead with provisions for our immediate supply. That you may return with more safety than you go, tell him to give you thirty lances as an escort. I SILVESTRE MEETS JUAN LOPEZ CACHO. 87 will wait for you in this same place until to-morrow night. The road may seem long and difficult, and the time short, but I know to whom I intrust the undertaking. That you may not go alone, take with you the companion you like best, and be off at once, for you should pass the swamp before daybreak lest the Indians cap- ture and kill you." The very peril of the mission put the youthful Silvestre upon his mettle. Without answering a word, he left the governor, vaulted in his saddle, and was already on the way when he en- countered another youth, named Juan Lopez Cacho, native of Seville, and page of the governor, who had an excellent horse. " Juan Lopez," cried Silvestre, " the general has ordered that you and I go with a message to be delivered before daybreak at the camp ; follow me, therefore, immediately, for I am already on the road." " Take some other person, I entreat you," said Juan J Lopez, " I am fatigued, and cannot make the journey." " As you please," replied Silvestre, " the governor ordered me to choose a companion, and I have chosen you. If you are so disposed, come and welcome ; if not, remain. Your company will not diminish the danger, nor will my going alone increase the toil." So saying, he continued on his way. Juan Lopez, much as it went against his will, leaped into his saddle and galloped after him. CHAPTER XIII. THE PERILOUS JOURNEY OP GONZALO SILVESTRE, AND HIS FRIEND, JUAN LOPEZ. 1539, The sun was just setting as Gronzalo Silvestre and his comrade departed on their hazardous mission. These youthful cavaliers were well matched in spirit, hardihood, and sprightly valor ; and neither had attained his twenty-first year. They passed rapidly over the first four or five leagues, the road being clear, free from forests, swamps, or streams. In all that distance they did not perceive a single Indian. Having crossed this open tract, their dangers and difiiculties began ; for, being ignorant of the country, they were obliged to trace back, step by step, the track they had made three days previous, through bog and brake, brambles and forest, and across a laby- rinth of streams meandering from the great morass ; guiding themselves by the land-marks noticed on their previous march. In this toilsome twilight journey, they were aided by the instinct of the horses. These sagacious animals, as if possessed of under- standing, traced the road by which they had come, and like spaniels or setter dogs, thrust their noses along the ground to discover the track. Their riders did not at first understand their intention, and checked them with the reins to raise their heads. Did they at any time lose the track, on finding it again DANGERS OF THE EXPEDITION. 89 the steeds would puff and snort, which alarmed their masters, who dreaded being overheard by the savages.* Gonzalo Silvestre, comprehending at length the intention of his horse when he lowered his head to seek the track, gave him his will, without attempting to guide him. Encountering these difficulties, and many others more easily to be imagined than written, these two daring youths travelled all night, without any road, half dead with hunger, worn out with excessive fatigue, and almost overcome by sleep. Their horses were in no better plight, as for three days they had not been unsaddled, the bits being merely taken from their mouths occasionally, that they might graze. At times they passed within sight of huge fires, around which the savages were stretched in wild and fantastic, groups, or capering and singing, and making the forests ring with yells and howlings. These were probably celebrating their feasts with war dances. The deafening din they raised was the safe- guard of the two Spaniards, as it prevented the savages noticing the clamorous barking of their dogs, and hearing the trampling of the horses as they passed. f * The Inca is curiously minute in his account of these horses. The steed of Gonzalo Silvestre, says he, was the most sure in the track, and certain to discover it when lost. However, he adds, we must not be surprised at this excellent quality, and many others that this horse possessed ; for, his marks and color proved him admirably fitted either for peace or war. He was of a dark chestnut of a pitchy shade, with white on one of his left feet, and striped above the nostrils, marks which promise more excellence and gentle- ness than any other. The dark chestnut color, especially when of a pitchy hue, is above all others the most excellent, either for light or heavy labor. The steed of Juan Lopez Cachero was of a light bay, commonly called fox- color, and his extremities were black, excellent marks, but inferior to the dark chestnut color. Garcilaso de la Vega, P. i. L. ii. c. 14. f The Inca, P. i. Lib. h. c. 14. 90 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. Thus they journeyed for more than ten leagues. Juan Lopez was repeatedly so much overpowered by sleep, that he entreated they should halt and repose, but Silvestre resolutely refused. At length poor Lopez could contain himself no longer. " Let me sleep for a short time," said he, " or kill me with your lance on the spot, for I cannot possibly go on any farther, or keep my saddle." " Dismount then, and sleep if you please," said Silvestre. " since you had rather run the risk of being butchered than bear up an hour longer. According to the distance we have come, we must be near the pass of the morass, and cross it we must before dawn ; for if day finds us in this place our death is certain." Juan Lopez made no reply, but let himself fall upon the ground like a lifeless body. His companion took from him his lance, and held his horse by the bridle. Night now rapidly drew on — the clouds poured forth a deluge of rain, but nothing could awaken Juan Lopez from his deep and death- like slumber. As the rain ceased, the clouds dispersed and Silvestre de- clared that he found himself suddenly in broad daylight, without having perceived it dawn ; it is probable that he had been un- consciously sleeping in his saddle. Startled at beholding the day so near, he hastened to call Lopez, but finding that the low tones in which he spoke were insufficient, he made use of his lance, and gave him some hearty blows, calling out, " Look what your sleeping has brought upon us : see, the daylight which we dreaded has overtaken us, and we have now no escape from our enemies !" Juan Lopez, roused at last by this summary process, sprang A PERILOUS LEAGUE. 91 Into his saddle, and they set off at a handgallop. Fortunately for them, the horses were of such bottom, that notwithstanding past fatigue, they were yet in spirit. The light revealed the two cavaliers to the Indians, who set up yells and howlings, that seemed to arise from every part of the morass, accompanied by a frightful din, and clangor of drums, trumpets, conches, and other rude instruments of warlike music. A perilous league remained to be made, over an expanse of water, which the horses would have to ford. Before the Span- iards reached it, they beheld canoes darting forth from among thickets and cane-breaks, until the water seemed covered with them. They saw the imminent danger that awaited them in the water, after passing so many on land ; but, knowing that in courage alone consisted their safety, they dashed into it ; seek- ing to pass it with all speed. Throughout the whole distance, they were beset by Indians, who were discharging arrows at them. Fortunately they were cased in armor, and their horses were nearly covered with the water, so that they both escaped without wounds, though the cavaliers declared that, on reaching land, and looking back, the whole surface of the water seemed strewed with arrows. The Indians continued to pursue them on land, plying their bows, and speeding flights of arrows, when a band of thirty horsemen came galloping to the rescue, headed by Nuiio Tobar, on his famous dapple-gray charger. The wild cries and yells of the Indians having reached the army, had caused a surmise that some Spaniards were in danger, and Nuno Tobar had pro- posed this sally to their rescue ; for that cavalier, now that he was out of favor with his general, seemed, with the pride of a 92 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. noble spirit to pique himself the more on signalizing himself by worthy deeds. At sight of Nuno Tobar and his band, the Indians gave over the pursuit, and retreated into the thickets and morass. CHAPTER HY. THIRTY LANCES SALLY FOE.TH WITH SUPPLIES FOR THE GOVERNOR THE HAUGHTY SPEECH OF THE CACIQUE ACUERA. 1539. The two adventurous troopers reached the army in safety, and were received with acclamations. On learning their errand, Luis de Moscoso, the camp-master-general, immediately or- dered two horses to be laden with supplies for the governor and his troops, and thirty horsemen as an escort. With this band Gonzalo Silvestre set out on his return, without having re- posed an hour in the camp, and having scarcely taken any refreshment. His friend, Juan Lopez, remained behind, excus- ing himself under the plea that the governor had neither ordered him to go nor return. The thirty horse passed the morass without opposition, and travelled all day without seeing an enemy. With all their speed they could not arrive at the place at which the governor had promised to await them, until two hours after nightfall, when, to their great chagrin, they found the late camping-ground deserted. Ignorant of the route taken by the general, the little band made arrangements for passing the night in this perilous situation. Being exposed to the attacks of lurking savages, 94 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. constant vigilance was necessary. They divided their party, therefore, into three bands of ten men each. One, mounted and armed, went the rounds the first third of the night ; another "band kept watch at the encampment, with their horses . saddled and bridled, and ready to be mounted. The third merely took the bridles off their steeds, and, suffering the saddles to remain on, turned the horses loose to graze while they snatched a brief repose. In this manner, going the rounds, watching and sleep- ing by turns, they lightened their toils, and the night passed away without molestation. As soon as the day dawned they sought the track of the general and his troop, and following it, came to the second pass of the morass with the Indian bridge. Here, having to advance for a great distance breast-high in water, they feared an attack, for the Indians might hover about them in canoes, and assail them with nights of arrows : to their great joy, however, they accomplished the whole passage without any assault. This ca- pricious conduct of the savages — one day attacking with blood- thirsty fury, and the next keeping entirely out of sight — occurred repeatedly throughout the whole of this expedition, and has been sometimes attributed to superstitious notions and observ- ances in their warfare. Having travelled six leagues, the convoy came to a beautiful valley, in which were large fields of Indian corn, of such luxu- riant growth as to bear three and four ears upon a stalk. The horsemen leaned down and plucked them as they rode along, eating them raw to appease their hunger. In this valley they found the governor encamped, who received them joyfully, lav- ishing praises upon Silvestre for his courage and hardihood, and promising to reward him for his services. He excused himself THE GOVERNOR IS JOINED BY HIS ARMY. 95 for not having waited at the appointed place, by alleging the in- tolerable hunger of the troops, and their doubts whether Silvestre had not fallen into the hands of the Indians. Within a few days the governor was joined by the residue of the army, conducted by Luis de Moscoso. They had traversed the two passes of the morass with great toil and difficulty, but fortunately without any hostility on the part of the natives. The fertile province in which the army was encamped,* was twenty leagues to the north of that of Urribarracaxi, and was ruled by a cacique named Acuera, who, on the approach of the Spaniards, had fled with his people to the woods. Hernando de Soto sent Indian interpreters to him, representing the power of the Spaniards to do injury or confer benefits ; their disposition to befriend the natives ; and that their only object was, by ami- cable means, to bring the people of this great country into obe- dience to their sovereign, the powerful emperor and king of Castile. He invited the cacique, therefore, to a friendly inter- view. The cacique returned a haughty and vaunting reply. " Others of your accursed race," said he, " have in years past poisoned our peaceful shores. They have taught me what you are. What is your employment ? To wander about like vagabonds from land to land — to rob the poor — to betray the confiding — to mur- der in cold blood the defenceless. No, with such a people I want no peace, no friendship. War — never ending — extermi- nating war, is all the boon I ask. You boast yourselves valiant — and so you may be — but my faithful warriors are not less brave — and this, too, you shall one day prove, for I have sworn * Supposed to be the place known now as the old Indian Palaklikaha. 96 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. to maintain an unsparing conflict while one white man remains in my borders. Not openly in battle — though even thus we fear not to meet you — but by stratagem, and ambush, and midnight surprisal." In reply to the demand that he should yield obedience to the emperor, he replied : " I am king in my own land, and will never become the vassal of a mortal like myself. Vile and pusillanimous is he who will submit to the yoke of another, when he may be free ! As for me and my people, we choose death, yes, a hundred deaths, before the loss of our liberty, and the sub- jugation of our country !" The governor admired the pride and haughtiness of spirit of the savage chieftain, and was more pressing than ever to gain his friendship ; but to all his messages and overtures the answer of the cacique was, that he had already made the only reply he had to offer. . In this province the army remained twenty days, recruiting from the fatigue and privation of the past journey. During this time the governor sent persons in every direction to explore the country, who returned with favorable reports. The Indians, during this time, were not asleep nor idle. To fulfil the bravadoes of their cacique, they lurked in ambush about the camp, so that a Spaniard could not stray a hundred steps from it without being shot down and instantly beheaded ; so that if his companions hastened to his rescue, they found nothing but a headless trunk. The Christians buried the dead bodies of their unfortunate comrades whenever they found them, but the Indians would return the following night, disinter them, cut them up and hang them upon the trees. The heads they carried as trophies to HOSTILITIES OF THE NATIVES. 9? their cacique, according to his orders. Thus fourteen Spaniards perished, and a greater number were wounded. The savages in these skirmishes ran comparatively but little risk, as the Spanish encampment was skirted by a thicket, whither the Indians, after making an assault, could easily escape. In this manner the Spaniards saw effectually verified the threats which had been shouted forth by the Indians who had hung upon the rear during the march. " Keep on, robbers and traitors," cried they, " in Acuera and Apalachee we will treat you as you deserve. Every captive will we quarter and hang up on the highest trees along the road." Notwithstanding their great vigilance during all this time, the Spaniards did not kill more than fifty Indians, for they were most prudent and wary in their waylayings. # * The Inca, P. i. L. ii. c. 16 s Herrera. D. vi. L. vii c. 10. Note. — The conduct and language of the cacique Acuera are completely in the spirit manifested by some of the chiefs of the late war ; the mode of war- fare was also of a similar kind. CHAPTER XV. THE GOVERNOR ARRIVES IN THE PROVINCE OF OCALI OCCUR- RENCES THERE. 1539. The army reposed for twenty days in the province of Acuera, during which time De Soto permitted no injury to be done either to the hamlets and villages, or the fields of grain : they then "broke up their encampment, and set out for another prov- ince, about twenty leagues to the north-eastward, called Ocali,* the same of which G-allegos had heard at the village of Urribar- racaxi. Their way lay across a desert tract, about twelve leagues broad, interspersed with open forests, free from underwood, through which the horsemen could ride at ease. They then tra- versed seven leagues, where dwellings were scattered about the fields and forests. At length they arrived at the principal vil- lage, containing six hundred houses, called after the cacique Ocali. The inhabitants, however, had fled with their effects to the forests. This province, being further from the sea-coast, was less cut up and intersected by the deep creeks and bays, which in other * This name is spelt Cale by the Portuguese Narrator. It is supposed to have been in the neighborhood of Fort King:. CANUTE SAGACITY. 99 parts penetrated an immense distance into this low «.nd level country, causing vast swamps and bogs, difficult and sometimes impossible to be passed. In some of the morasses they had tra- versed the surface would appear like firm land, yet, on stepping upon it. would tremble for twenty or thirty paces around, and on being trodden by horses would give way. and plunge steed and rider into a suffocating quagmire. Besides being more free from morasses, the province of Ocali was more populous and fruitful : and this the Spaniards found to be the case, throughout this country, in proportion as the provinces were remote from the sea. What they chiefly suffered from throughout this whole expedition, was scarcity of animal food, as the natives did not raise domestic cattle ; and, although deer and other game were abundant, the Indians only killed suf- ficient to supply their immediate wants. The Spaniards took up their quarters in the village of Ocali, where they found vast quantities of maize, vegetables, and various kinds of fruits. The governor sent three or four Indian mes- sengers daily to the cacique Ocali, endeavoring, but in vain, to draw that chieftain from his retreat, with proffers of peace and friendship. With one of these messengers, came to the camp four young Indian warriors, gayly decorated with plumes, who manifested an eager curiosity to see the Spaniards, wondering at their dress, their arms, and, above all, their horses. The gover- nor gave them presents, and ordered that a collation should be set before them. They sat down and appeared to be eating very quietly, when, perceiving the Spaniards to be off their guard, they rose sud- denly, and ran full speed to the woods. It was in vain for the Spaniards to pursue them on foot, and there was no horse at hand. 100 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. A hound of uncommon sagacity, however, hearing the cry of the Indians, and seeing them run, pursued them. Overtaking and passing by the first, and second, and third, he sprang upon the shoulders of the foremost and pulled him to the ground ; as the next Indian passed on, the dog, leaving the one already down, sprang upou his successor, and secured him in the same way. In like manner he served the third and fourth ; and then kept running from one to the other, pulling them down as fast as they rose, and barking so furiously, that the Indians were terrified and confounded, and the Spaniards were enabled to overtake and capture them, They were taken back to the camp and examined separately, for, as they were armed, the Spaniards apprehended some treachery ; but it appeared that their sudden flight was only by way of exploit to show their ad- dress and fleetness. This same hound had signalized himself on another occasion before the army reached Ocali. As several Indians and Span- iards were talking in a friendly way on the bank of a river, one of the Indians struck a Spaniard violently with his bow, and threw himself into the water, all his companions following him. The dog immediately sprang in after them, but passed by several of the Indians without molesting them until he came to the one who had committed the assault, when, laying hold of him, he tore him to pieces. CHAPTER m THE FATE OF THE HOUXD. 1539. After repeated solicitations, the cacique Ocali. at the end of six days, ventured from his place of refuge, and visited the army, where he was well treated, although the Spaniards doubted much the sincerity of his professions. Hard by the village ran a wide and deep river, with precipi- tous banks. Notwithstanding it was the summer season, this river was too full of water to be fordable : it was necessary, therefore, to construct a wooden bridge for the army to pass. De Soto hav- ing treated with the cacique for a number of his subjects to aid in its construction, they went forth one day to decide upon the spot where it should be erected. As they were walking along the bank, conferring on the subject, more than five hundred Indians started up from among bushes and thickets, on the opposite bank of the river, crying, - ; You want a bridge, do you ? merciless robbers ! but you will never see it built by our hands !" Thus shouting, they let fly a volley of arrows towards the place where the cacique and governor were standing. De Soto demanded of his savage companion the meaning of this outrage, seeing he had given him pledges of his friendship. 102 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. The cacique replied, that these were of a refractory party of his subjects, who had cast off allegiance to him on account of his at- tachment to the Spaniards, and that he was not therefore answer- able for their acts. It happened that the hound already mentioned was at hand, held in a leash by the governor's page. No sooner did he hear the yells and see the menacing actions of the Indians, than he was furious to get at them. In his struggles he drew the page along, threw him on the ground, and then breaking loose, plunged into the stream. The Spaniards called him back in vain. The Indians, knowing his valor and exploits, and the harm he had done to their countrymen, were glad of an opportu- nity to revenge themselves. They showered their arrows about him as he swam, and with such dexterous aim, that more than fifty struck him about the head and shoulders, which were above the water. Still the courageous animal kept on, and reached the land, but had scarcely left the water when he fell dead. His death was lamented by the governor and the army, as if it had been that of a brave warrior : for he had been of signal service throughout the expedition, a vigilant guardian of the camp by night, and a fierce champion by day. He was one of a rare and renowned race of dogs, several of which were noted for their feats in the course of the Spanish discoveries and conquests. CHAPTER XVII. THE SPANIARDS ENTER THE VAST PROVINCE OF VITACHUCO THEIR RECEPTION THERE. 1539. De Soto saw that the chieftain Ocali was but lightly esteemed by his subjects, who disobeyed his commands with impunity ; and, thinking that the neighboring caciques might suppose he was detained against his will, gave him permission to go to his people, and revisit the camp whenever it pleased him. The cacique gladly availed himself of this offer, but declared he only went in order to bring his subjects into more perfect submission to the governor, which accomplished, he would joyfully rejoin the Spaniards. With these and many similar professions, he de- parted ; but never again showed his face in the camp. Upon the departure of the cacique, the Spaniards commenced constructing a bridge over the river. The work was superin- tended by one Francisco, a Genoese, the only shipwright in the army. He was likewise skilled in every kind of carpentering work, and by his art rendered incalculable services to the Span- iards throughout this expedition. Large planks were thrown upon the water, and these tied together with strong cords, which they had brought with them for such emergencies ; crossing and fastening the planks with immense poles laid on top. It was of 104 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. sufficient strength for the passage of both men and horses. Hav- ing captured thirty Indians to serve as guides, the Spaniards crossed the bridge, and set forward on their march. After travelling about three days, the governor threw himself in the advance of the army, with a hundred horse, and a hundred foot ; and, pushing forward in the night, came by daybreak to the frontiers of a province, fifty leagues in breadth, called Vita- chuco. It was under the dominion of three brothers. The eldest, Yitachuco, bearing the name of the country over which he ruled, had five parts out of ten, the second brother governed three of the remaining five, and the youngest of the family, who was chief of the village of Ochile, and of the same name, possess- ed the residue. This was contrary to the usage of the other provinces through which the Spaniards had passed, in which the eldest son inherited all. It was scarce daybreak on the first day, when the governor and his advanced corps arrived at the village of Ochile. # It con- tained fifty large and strong dwellings, being a frontier post, for- tified against the adjacent provinces, with which it appeared this country was embroiled in warfare. De Soto and his little band rushed into the village, with clamor of drum and trumpet ; seized the Indians, as, terrified and amazed, they came forth from their houses, and surrounded the mansion of the cacique. This was built in form of one large pavilion, upwards of a hundred and twenty paces in length, and forty in breadth, with four doors ; a number of smaller buildings were connected with it like offices. The cacique had with him a guard of his principal warriors, * Williams says, this must have been south of the Allachua prairie. See Williams's Florida. CAPTURE OF OCHILE. 105 and many others had hastened to his defence. He would have sallied forth and made battle, but the Spaniards had possession of the doors, and threatened to fire the house. At length, by sunrise, he was persuaded, through the mediation of Indian pris- oners and interpreters, to yield to the superior power of the Spaniards, and aceept their proffered friendship. The governor received him kindly, but kept him with him, while he set at liberty all the other prisoners, ordering his soldiers to treat them in the most friendly manner. The governor, however, did not feel himself secure. The neighborhood was populous ; the Indians, seeing the small num- ber of his band, might attempt a rescue of their cacique. Taking that chieftain with him, therefore, and a number of warriors who adhered to his fortunes, the governor marched out of the village, and returned in quest of the main body of his troops, whom he found encamped at three leagues distance, full of anxiety on account of his absence. The day following, the army entered Ochile; the foot and horse formed into squadrons, and trumpets, fifes, and drums sounding. The troops being quartered, the governor prevailed upon Ochile to send envoys to his two brothers, inviting them to accept the offer of peace of the Spaniards, and warning them of the disastrous consequences that would attend a refusal. The second brother, who was nearest, readily oomplied, and at the end of three days came accompanied by many of his war- riors gayly decorated. After kissing the hands of the governor, he entered into familiar conversation with the officers and dis- tinguished cavaliers of the army, asking the name of each, and bearing himself with as much ease as if be had been brought up amono' them. 106 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. The elder brother, however, who was much the most powerful of the three, made no reply to the message, but detained the envoys by whom it was sent. The two brothers, by the persua- sion of De Soto, sent again other messengers with still more urgent counsel and entreaties. They represented the invincible power of the Spaniards, who were children of the sun and moon, their gods — that they had come from the remote region, where the sun rises, and withal, that they had with them animals called horses, so fleet, courageous, and powerful, that it was impossible to escape them by flight, or resist them by force. The answer of Vitachuco is given at length by the Inca Garcilaso de la Yega ; though he quotes it from memory, after a lapse of years ; and declares that he cannot vouch for its being arranged exactly in the order in which it was declared, or that it was the whole of what was said ; but he pledges his word that, as far as it goes, it is truly the message of the cacique. He declares that if the whole could be written as recounted by the envoys, none of the knights that the divine Ariosto or his pre- decessor, the illustrious and enamored Count Matheo Maria Boyardo, have introduced in their works, could equal in haughty spirit and extravagant bravado this savage chieftain. Without claiming for it all the praise so liberally awarded by this ancient author, still it shows the fiery spirit of this wild warrior, whose gallant efforts were, alas ! of but little avail against the resistless might of the Spanish invader. CHAPTER XVIII. HAUGHTY MESSAGE OF THE CACIQUE VITACHUCO. 1539. " It is evident enough," observes the cacique, in reply to the embassy of his brothers. '•'- that you are young, and have neither judgment nor experience, or you would never speak as you have done of these hated white men ! You extol them greatly as virtuous men, who injure no one. You say that they are valiant — that they are children of the sun, and merit all our reverence and service. The vile chains which they have hung upon you, and the mean and dastardly spirit which you have acquired during the short period you have been their slaves, have caused you to speak like women, lauding what you should censure and abhor. You remember not that these strangers can be no better than those who formerly committed so many cruel- ties in our country. Are they not of the same nation and sub- ject to the same laws? Do not their manner of life and actions prove them to be children of the Spirit of Evil, and not of the sun and the moon, our gods 1 Go they not from land to land plundering and destroying ; taking the wives and daughters of others instead of bringing their own with them : and, like mere vagabonds, maintaining themselves by the laborious toil and 5* 108 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. sweating brow of others ? Were they virtuous, as you represent, they never would have left their own country, since there they might have practised their virtues, planting and cultivating the earth, maintaining themselves without prejudice to others or in- jury to themselves ; instead of roving about the world committing robberies and murders, having neither the shame of men nor the fear of Grod before them. " Warn them not to enter into my dominions, for I vow that, as valiant as they may be, if they dare to put foot upon my soil, they shall never go out of my land alive — the whole race will I exterminate !"* This was the first reply of Vitachuco ; but he sent many others, insomuch that every day there arrived two or three In- dians, sounding always a trumpet, and bringing greater bravadoes and menaces than the last. The cacique thought to terrify them by the various and hideous supernatural deaths with which he menaced them. At one time he threatened, that the moment they entered his province the earth should open and swallow them ; that the hills by which the Spaniards would have to tra- vel should join together and bury them alive. Again, the trees of the forest through which they had to pass were to be blown down and crush them ; flights of birds were to hover over and pounce upon them, with corroding poison in their beaks. And again, that he would have the waters, herbs, trees, and even the air poisoned in such manner that neither horse nor rider, man nor beast, could escape with life. These extravagancies provoked the laughter of the Spaniards, who considered them the bravadoes of a vaporing spirit ; but the deeds of the cacique afterwards showed that they were the * The Inca, P. i. L. ii. c. 21. THE MISSION TO VITACHUCO, 109 wishes and conceptions of a proud warrior; who, it is probable, was promised all these miracles in his favor by some Indian prophet, These and many other messages arrived during eight days lhat were spent by the governor in travelling about the domains of the two brothers, who did every thing in their power to gratify the Spaniards. At length the two brothers themselves departed on a mission to Vitachueo. The fierce chieftain pre- tended to be at length won by their persuasions, and agreed to enter into friendly intercourse with the -strangers : but he wished first to know how many days they would be in his domains, what quantity of provisions they would require when they departed, and what other things would be necessarv for their journey. The two brothers sent an envoy to De Soto with this mes- sage, who replied, that they would not sojourn in the territory of Yitachuco longer than he desired them to remain, nor did they wish any more provisions than he saw fit to give them, neither had they need of any thing besides his friendship. CHAPTER XIX. THE CACIQUE VITACHUCO DISSEMBLES HIS PLOT TO DESTROY THE SPANIARDS. 1539. Yitachuco pretended to be well contented with the reply of the governor, a day was appointed for their meeting, and the cacique ordered an abundant supply of provisions for the troops and horses to be brought from all parts of his domains, and de- posited in the chief village. On the appointed day he went forth from his village, accom- panied by his two brothers and five hundred Indian warriors^ all graceful men, adorned with plumes of various colors, and armed with bows and arrows of the finest workmanship. At the distance of two leagues they found the governor, encamped with his army in a beautiful valley. Their meeting was cordial, and the cacique endeavored to atone for past threats and menaces, by professions of present amity and promises of future services and allegiance, all which were graciously received by De Soto. Vitachuco was about thirty-five years of age, of very good stature, and strongly formed, as the Indians of Florida generally were, and evinced in his countenance the bravery of his spirit. The ensuing day the Spaniards entered in order of battle, PERFIDIOUS PLOT OF THE CHIEF. Ill into the principal village, bearing the same name as the cacique.* It consisted of two hundred houses, large and strong, besides many others of smaller size in the suburbs. The governor and his body-guards and servants, together with the three brother caciques, lodged in the house of Vitachuco, as it was of ample size to accommodate them all. Two days were passed in feasting and rejoicing. On the third day, the two brothers of Yitachuco obtained leave to re- turn to their respective territories, and departed, well pleased with the good treatment and the many presents they had re- ceived from the Spaniards. After their departure, Yitachuco redoubled his courtesy and kindness to the Spaniards, and seemed as if he thought he could not do enough to serve and gratify them. Five days only had elapsed, however, when Juan Ortiz came to the governor, and informed him of a perfidious plot devised by the cacique, and which had been revealed to him by four of the Indian interpret- ers. He had selected several thousand of his bravest warriors, and ordered them to conceal their weapons in the thicket near the village, and to appear at all times unarmed, so as to throw the Spaniards off their guard. On an appointed day he was to invite the governor to go forth and see a general muster of his subjects, drawn up in battle array, though without weapons, that he might know what a number of Indian allies he had at his command for his future conquests. Trusting that the governor, from the amity existing between * Mr. Fairbanks is inclined to fix the site of Vitachuco on what is now known as the "Wacahautu prairie, winch is partly wet and partly dry, and is about fifteen miles west of Micanopy. He says that in this vicinity are nu- merous lakes and prairies which might be taken as the scene of the battle. 112 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. them, would go forth carelessly and alone, a dozen of the fiercest and most powerful Indians were suddenly to seize him and bear him into the midst of the warriors ; who, seizing their arms, were to attack the Spaniards in their camp. In this way, be- tween the suprise of the sudden assault, and the dismay at the capture of their general, he trusted to have an easy conquest : in which case, he intended to make good his extravagant menaces, and inflict on his prisoners all kinds of cruel and tormenting deaths. The Adelantado having consulted with his captains, it was determined to take Vitachuco in the same way that he intended to take the governor ; so that he would thus fall into his own snare. For that purpose, twelve of the stoutest soldiers were selected, to be near the governor at the time he should go forth to view the Indian army, and at a certain signal were to seize upon the cacique. These things being concerted in secret, the Spaniards watched Vitachuco's movements, but at the same time maintained an air of careless unconcern. The day so much desired having arrived, Vitachuco came to the governor early in the morning, and, with much humility and seeming veneration, begged him to confer a great favor on him- self and all his subjects, by going out of the camp to behold them arranged in order of battle, that he might know the num- ber that were at his service, and might see whether the Indians of this country knew how to form their squadrons as well as other nations who he had heard were skilled in the art of war. The governor replied, with an unsuspicious air, that he would rejoice greatly to see them ; and that, to make the display more striking, and furnish the Indians likewise with a sight, he would order his horse and foot-soldiers to go out and place themselves in THE MOCK FIGHT AGREED TO. 113 squadrons ; and have a mock fight for each other's entertain- ment. The cacique did not much relish this proposition, but agreed to the arrangement ; trusting to the number and valor of his vassals to overthrow the Spaniards, be they ever so well pre- pared. CHAPTER XX. BATTLE WITH VITACHUCO. 1539. All things being arranged, the Spaniards marched forth, horse and foot, in battle array, with glittering arms and fluttering banners. As to the governor, he remained behind, to accom- pany the cacique on foot, the better to appear unsuspicious of the latent treason. He went, however, secretly armed ; and he or- dered two of his finest horses to be led forth caparisoned for ser- vice. One of these is especially mentioned as a beautiful and noble-spirited animal. He was named Aceytuno, after Mateo de Aceytuno, a cavalier who had made him a present to the governor. Near the village was a large plain. It had on one side a dense forest, on the other, two lakes : the one about a league in circumference, clear of trees, but so deep, that three or four feet from the bank no footing could be found. The second, which was at greater distance from the village, was more than half a league in width, and appeared like a vast river, extending as far as the eye could reach. Between the forest and these two lakes, the Indians formed their squadrons, having the lakes on their right flank, and the forest on the left. Their bows and arrows were concealed in the grass, in order that they might appear to be totally unarmed. Their force might be about ten VITACHUCO IS CAPTURED. 115 thousand, chosen warriors, with lofty plumes, which increased their apparent height : and. being drawn out with somewhat of military order, they made a beautiful display. The cacique and Hernando de Soto came forth on foot, each accompanied by twelve of his people, and each burning with the same spirit and determination against the other. The Spanish troops were to the right of the governor : the infantry drawn up near to the forest, and the cavalry advanced into the plain. It was between nine and ten of the morning, when De Soto and Yitachuco arrived at the spot, which the latter had fixed upon for the seizure of the governor. Before the cacique, how- ever, could make his preconcerted signal, a Spanish trumpet- gave a warning blast.* In an instant the twelve Spaniards rushed upon the cacique. His attendant Indians threw them- selves before him. and endeavoured to repel the assailants, but in vain. He was borne off captive. At the same time. De Soto leaped upon his favorite steed Aceytuno. and spurred him upon the thickest of the enemy, with that headlong valor which always distinguished him in battle. The Indians had already seized their weapons. Their first ranks were thrown into confusion by the impetuous charge of De Soto ; but as he pressed forward, a shower of arrows came whistling about him. They were principally aimed at his horse, the Indi- ans always seeking most to kill these animals, knowing their importance in battle. Four of the arrows wounded the generous animal in the knees, four pierced him in the breast, and he fell to the earth dead, as if shot by a piece of artillery, t * Portuguese Narrative, e. 11. f Herrera. De^ad vi L. \ii e. 11. Garcilaso de la Vega, P. i. L. iL c 23. Portuguese Xarrative. ell. 116 CONQUEST OP FLORIDA. In the mean time, the Spanish troops, at the trumpet signal, had assailed the Indian squadrons, and came up at this critical moment to the aid of their general. One of his pages named Viota, a youth of noble birth, sprang from his horse and aided De Soto to mount him. The governor, once more on horse- back, put himself at the head of his cavalry, and spurred among the Indians. The latter had no lances to defend themselves ; and, being assailed by three hundred horse, broke and fled in every direction. A great number of those who were in the rear took refuge among the entangled thickets of the forest ; others threw themselves into the large lake and escaped, while others scattered themselves wildly over the plain, where more than three hundred were killed, and a few taken. The worse fate attended the vanguard, composed of the brav- est warriors ; who are always doomed to fare the worst in battle. After receiving the first charge of the cavalry, they fled ; but, being unable to reach either the forest or the large lake, more than nine hundred threw themselves into the smaller one. Here they were surrounded by the Spaniards, who endeavored by threats and promises, and occasional shots from their cross-bows, and arquebusses, to induce them to surrender. The Indians replied only by flights of arrows. As the lake was too deep to give them footing, three or four would cling together, and sup- port each other by swimming, while one would mount upon their backs, and ply his bow and arrows. In this way an incessant skirmishing was kept up all day long ; numbers of the Indians were slain, all their arms were exhausted, yet no one gave signs of surrendering. When night came, the Spaniards posted themselves round the lake, the horse by two and two, the foot in parties of six, i SURRENDER OF THE INDIAN'S. Ill near to each other, lest the Indians should escape in the dark. Some of the latter endeavored to save themselves, by covering their heads with the leaves of water-lilies, and swimming noise- lessly to the shore ; but the watchful troopers, perceiving the turmoil and bubbling in the water, would spur their horses to the bank, and drive the Indians again into the channel,* in hopes of tiring them out. and thus forcing them to capitulate ; for, while the Spaniards threatened them with death if they did not yield, they offered them peace and friendship if they would surrender. So obstinate were they, however, that midnight arrived before one of them submitted, although they had passed fourteen hours in the water. At length, the intercessions of Juan Ortiz, and the four Indian interpreters, began to have effect. The most weary would render themselves, one and two at a time, but so slowly, that by the dawn of day not more than fifty had surren- dered. The residue seeing that these were kindly treated, and being admonished by them, now gave themselves up in greater numbers, but still slowly and reluctantly. Some when near the bank would return to the middle of the lake, until the love of life compelled them to yield. At length, at ten o'clock, two hundred came to shore at the same time, and surrendered them- selves, after having been swimming four and twenty hours. They were in wretched condition, swollen with the water they had swallowed, and overcome with fatigue, hunger, and the want of sleep. There still remained seven Indians in the lake, men of such unconquerable spirit that neither the prayers of the interpreters, the promises of the governor, nor the example of their comrades, who had surrendered, had any effect upon them.f * Portuguese Narrative, c. 11. f Ibid. 118 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. They treated all promises with scorn, and defied both menaces and death. In this way they remained until three in the after- noon, and would have remained there until they died. The go- vernor, however, was struck with admiration of their courage and magnanimity, and thought it would be inhuman to allow such brave men to perish. He ordered twelve Spaniards therefore, expert swimmers, to go into the lake with their swords in their mouths, and draw these warriors forth. The Indians were too much exhausted to resist ; the Spaniards seized them by the legs, the arms, and hair, drew them to land, and threw them upon the bank, where they lay extended upon the sand, more dead than alive f having, according to the Spanish narrator, been for thirty hours in the water, apparently without putting foot to the ground or receiving any other relief: an exploit, adds the Inca historian, almost incredible, and which I would not dare to write, if it were not for the authority of so many cavaliers and nobles, who, in the Indies, and in Spain, assured me of the truth of it, besides the authority of him who related this history to me, and who, in all things, is worthy of belief. The reader, however, without questioning the veracity of the cavaliers, will be prone to surmise that the Indians were enabled, from time to time, to snatch a few moments of repose, on shallows near the banks of the lake. The heroic obstinacy of the seven Indians had extorted the admiration of the Spaniards. Moved to compassion by their pre- sent deplorable state, they bore them to the encampment, and * The Portuguese Narrative adds, that they were immediately put into irons. The Inca's account, however, of the treatment of the Spaniards towards these brave warriors, is more in unison with the generous nature of De Soto. J HEROISM OF THE SAVAGES. 119 used such assiduous means, that they were restored to animation in the course of the night. The next morning, the governor summoned them before him, and pretending to be angry, demanded the reason of their des- perate resistance, and why they had not surrendered themselves as their companions had done. Four of them, who were in the prime of manhood, replied, that they were leaders, or captains, chosen as such by their cacique, from his confidence in their courage and constancy. Their ac- tions were to justify his choice. They were bound to set an ex- ample to their children, to their brother warriors, and above all to such as should thenceforth be appointed as leaders. They felt as if, being alive, they had failed in fulfilling their duty and vin- dicating their honor ; and, while they acknowledged the kindness of the governor, regretted only that he had not left them to perish in the lake. " If you want to add to your favors," said they, " take our lives. After surviving the defeat and capture of our chieftain, we are not worthy to appear before him, or to live in the world."* The governor listened with admiration to the heroic words of these savage warriors ; and when they had finished, he turned to their three companions, who had remained silent. These were young men not more than eighteen years of age, sons and heirs to caciques of the adjacent provinces. The governor demanded of them their reason for persisting so desperately in their defence, as they were not leaders, nor bound by the same obligations as their companions. They replied, that they had been incited to hostility, not * Garcilaso de la Vega, P. i. L. ii. c. 25. Herrera, Decad. vi. L. vii. c. 11. 120 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. through a desire for gain, or through any implacable spirit against the Spaniards, but merely from a thirst for glory. That although they were not chiefs, yet as the sons of caciques, and destined one day to be caciques themselves, they felt bound more than all others to signalize themselves by bravery in action, and by a con- tempt for suffering and death. " These, offspring of the sun !" said they, " are the reasons for our obstinate hostility : if they are sufficient in your eyes, pardon us ; if not, we are at your mercy. Strike us dead, for nothing is prohibited to the con- queror." The noble spirit and heroic words of these youths charmed the Spaniards, and their hearts were touched at seeing them ex- posed so young to such adversity. The governor, likewise, who was of a compassionate nature, was moved to pity. He embraced them as if they were his own sons ; commending their valor and heroism, which he considered as proofs of noble blood, and illus- trious descent. For two days he detained them in the camp, feasting them at his table, and treating them with every distinction ; at the end of which time, he dismissed them with presents of linen, cloths, silks, mirrors, and other articles of Spanish manufacture. He also sent by them presents to their fathers and other rela- tions, with proffers of his friendship. The young caciques took leave of him with many expressions of gratitude, and departed joyfully for their homes, accompanied by a number of their coun- trymen whom he had liberated. As to the four captive leaders, they were retained as prison- ers, and on the following day were summoned before the gov- ernor, with their cacique Vitachuco. De Soto reproached them with the treacherous and murderous plot devised against him I DISPOSAL OF THE CAPTIVES. 121 and his soldiers, at a time when they were professing the kindest amity. Such treason, he observed, merited death : yet he wished to giye the natives an evidence of his clemency : he pardoned them, therefore, and restored them to his friendship ; warning them, however, to beware how they again deceived him, or trespassed against the safety and welfare of Spaniards, lest they should bring down upon themselves dire and terrible revenge. The Indians who had come out of the lake and surrendered themselves, were distributed among the Spaniards to serve them as menials, during their sojourn in the province. This was partly as a punishment to them for their participation in the late treason, and partly as an example to warn the neighboring Indians from like aggressions. If CHAPTER XXL DEATH OF VITACHUCO AND HIS WARRIORS. 1539. Vitachuco now remained in some sort a prisoner in his own house, but was treated with great kindness and respect, and dined at the governor's table. Rage and hatred, however, rankled in his heart ; and he soon conceived another scheme of vengeance. Nine hundred of his most noble, valiant, and well- tried warriors, were dispersed among the Spaniards ; equalling the latter in number, and, as he thought, in personal prowess. They attended their new masters as slaves at meal times, when the Spaniards would be seated, off their guard, and many of them without weapons. At such a moment, he conceived it would be easy, by a preconcerted movement, to strike a signal blow, and rid themselves at once of their oppressions. Scarcely had Vitachuco conceived this rash scheme, than he hastened to put it into operation. He had four young Indians to attend him as pages. These he sent to the principal prison- ers, revealing his plan, with orders that they should pass it secretly and adroitly from one to another, and hold themselves in readiness, at the appointed time, to carry it into effect. The dinner hour of the third day was the time fixed upon for striking HASH SCHEME OF THE CACIQUE 123 the blow. Yitachuco would be dining with the governor, and the Indians in general attending upon their respective masters. The cacique was to watch his opportunity, spring upon the governor and kill him • giving, at the moment of assault, a war- whoop that should resound throughout the village. The war- whoop was to be the signal for every Indian to grapple with his master, or with any other Spaniard at hand, and dispatch him on the spot. Many of the Indians saw the madness of this second project ; but, accustomed to yield implicit obedience to their chiefs, prom- ised to carry it through or perish in the attempt. On the day appointed, Vitachuco dined as usual at the table of the governor. When the repast was concluded, he straight- ened himself upon the bench upon which he was seated, and twisting his body from side to side, stretched first one arm, then the other, to the full extent, with clenched fists, then drew them up so that his fists rested on his shoulders, then jerked them out two or three times, until every joint cracked like a snapped reed. In this way the Indians of Florida used to rally their strength when about to undertake any extraordinary feat. After this preparation he sprang upon his feet, closed in- stantly with the governor, seized him with the left hand by the collar, and with the other fist dealt him such a blow in the face as to level him with the ground, the blood gushing out of eyes, nose, and mouth. The cacique threw himself upon his victim to finish his work, giving, at the same time, the signal war-whoop. All this was the work of an instant, and before the officers present had time to recover from their astonishment, the gov- ernor lay senseless beneath the tiger grasp of Vitachuco, One 124 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. more How from the savage would have been fatal ; hut before he could give it, a dozen swords and lances were thrust through his body, and he fell dead. The war-whoop had resounded throughout the village. At hearing the fated signal, the Indians attending upon their mas- ters, assailed them with whatever weapon or missile they could command : some seized upon pikes and swords ; others snatched up the pots in which meat was stewing at the fire, and, beating the Spaniards about the head, bruised and scalded them at the same time ; some caught up plates, pitchers, jars, and the pestles wherewith they pounded the maize ; others the bones remaining from the repast ; and others seized upon stools, benches, and tables, striking with impotent fury when their weapons had not the power to harm ; others snatched up burning firebrands, and rushed like very devils into the affray. Many of the Spaniards were terribly burnt, bruised, and scalded ; some had their arms broken ; others were maimed by sticks and stones. One was knocked down by his slave with a firebrand, and beset by three other Indians, who dashed out his brains. Another was assailed with blows, his teeth knocked out, and he was on the point of falling a sacrifice, when some Spaniards came to his assistance. The savage assailant fled and mounted a hand-ladder into a granary opening upon a court-yard, taking with him a lance which he found leaning against the wall. The Spaniards attempted to ascend after him, but he planted himself in the door-way, and defended the entrance so bravely with the lance, that no one dared to approach him* At length, Diego de Soto, a relative of the governor, arrived in the court-yard, * Portuguese Narrative, c. 11. DEATH OF VITACHUCO. 125 armed with a cross-bow. He presented it and took aim. The Indian never attempted to draw back or screen himself; his object was, not to save his life, but to sell it as dearly as possi- ble. At the instant that De Soto drew the bow he threw the lance. The steeled point grazed the right shoulder of the Span- iard, and the shaft knocked him down upon his knees, pass- ing half a length beyond, and remaining quivering in the ground. The aim of De Soto was more certain. His shaft pierced the Indian through the breast, and killed him on the spot. It was fortunate for the Spaniards that most of the Indians were in chains, and none of them were regularly armed, other- wise their assault would have been attended with great carnage. As it was, many of the Spaniards were maimed and mangled, and four were slain before the savages could be overpowered. Some of the Spaniards were so exasperated at the wounds they had received, and at the intelligence of the maltreatment of the governor, that they wreaked their fury upon every Indian in their power. Others, who were cavaliers, thought it beneath their dignity to take away the lives of slaves. They brought their prisoners, therefore, to the grand square of the vil- lage, and delivered them into the hands of the archers of the gen- eral's guard, who dispatched them with their halberts. Among the cavaliers who thus brought their captive slaves to be executed, was one of a small and delicate form, named Fran- cisco de Saldafia. He entered the square, leading after him a powerful Indian, by a cord tied round his neck. No sooner, however, did the savage perceive what was passing, and the fate that awaited him, than he closed upon Saldafia as he walked before him, seized him with one hand by the neck and with the 126 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. other by the thigh, raised him like a child, turned him topsy- turvy with his head downwards, and dashed him to the ground with a violence that stunned him. Jumping then upon his body he would have dispatched him in an instant had not a number of Spaniards rushed with drawn swords to his rescue. The Indian seized Saldafia's sword, and received them so bravely, that though there were more than fifty, he kept them all at bay. Grasping the sword with both hands, he threw himself into the midst of them, whirling himself round like a wheel, and dealing about blows so rapidly and madly that no one dare oppose him, and they wore obliged to shoot him down with their firearms.* These, and many similar scenes of desperate valor, occurred in this wild affray. That the interpreters and the Indian allies who had accompanied the army from the other provinces might be embroiled with the natives of the neighborhood, so that they would not dare thenceforward to abandon the Spaniards, they were compelled to aid in the destruction of the prisoners, many of whom were tied to stakes in the public square, and shot down with their arrows. f In these battles, and the subsequent massacres, fell Vita- chuco and thirteen hundred of his warriors, the flower of his nation, among whom were the four brave leaders who had sur- vived from the lake. * Portuguese Narrative, c. 11. f Idem. The Portuguese narrator calls the village where this affray took place Napataca. CHAPTER XXII. THE ARMY PASS THROUGH THE PROVINCE OF OSACHILE COME TO A VAST MORASS SEVERE SKIRMISHING WITH THE SAVAGE.S PREPARATIONS TO CROSS THE GREAT MORASS. 1539. The blow which Hernando de Soto received from Vitachuco had been so violent that it was half an hour before he recovered his senses. His whole face was bruised and disfigured, and several of his teeth were broken, so that for twenty days he could par- take of no solid food. It was necessary to remain four days in the village, before he and his wounded soldiers were sufficiently recovered to bear a journey. On the fifth day he resumed his march, departing in search of another province, called Osachile.* The first day they journeyed four leagues, and encamped on the bank of a large and deep river, which divides the two prov- inces, and over which it was necessary to throw a bridge. t They had scarcely begun their preparations, however, when they beheld the Indians on the opposite side in hostile array. Abandoning the construction of the bridge, they hastily formed six rafts, on which a hundred men passed over, cross-bow men and arquebu- * This name is spelled UzachiL by the Portuguese narrator, f Believed to be the Suwanee. 128 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. siers, and fifty horsemen, carrying with them the saddles for their horses. As soon as these reached the land, their horses were driven into the water, and made to swim across. Their owners received them on the shore, saddled and mounted them immediately, and galloped out into the plain. At sight of them the Indians took to flight ; and the Spaniards worked without molestation at the bridge, which was finished in a day and a half. The army passed the river, and after travelling two leagues through a country free from woods, came to large fields of maize, beans, and pumpkins, with scattered habitations. While they were dispersed about the field a number of Indians, lurking in ambush among the grain, assailed them with flights of arrows, by which many of them were wounded. The Spaniards started in pur- suit of them lance in hand. There was some sharp skirmishing ; many natives were wounded, and a few taken prisoners. The latter had chains put about their necks, and were distributed among the soldiers : and made to carry the baggage, pound the maize, and fulfil other servile employments.* The Spaniards arrived at Osachile, a village about ten leagues from that of Vitachuco. It contained two hundred houses, which were deserted, the cacique and his people having fled to the woods, terrified by the rumors of the sanguinary massacre of Vitachuco. f The governor sent proffers of peace and friendship to him by the Indian prisoners. He made no reply, however, neither did any of the envoys return. The village of Osachile:}; resembled most of the Indian vil- * Portuguese Narrative, c. 12. f Idem. \ Williams thinks this is the Tallahasoche of the Seminoles, near Mico, in Hamilton county ; but we are inclined to believe, with Mr. Fairbanks, that ARTIFICIAL MOUNDS. 129 lages of Florida. The natives always endeavored to build upon high ground, or at least to erect the houses of the cacique or chief upon an eminence. As the country was very level, and high places seldom to be found, they constructed artificial mounds of earth, the top of each being capable of containing from ten to twenty houses. Here resided the cacique, his family, and attendants. At the foot of this hill was a square, according to the size of the village, around which were the houses of the leaders and most distinguished inhabitants. The rest of the people erected their wigwams as near to the dwelling of their chief as possible. An ascent in a straight line, from fifteen to twenty feet wide, led to the top of the hillock, and was flanked on each side by trunks of trees, joined one to another, and thrust deep into the earth : other trunks of trees formed a kind of stairway. All the other sides of the mound were steep and inaccessible. Many of the artificial mounds noticed by the traveller at the present day, and about which there has been so much curious and learned speculation, were doubtless artificial structures thrown up by the natives for the purposes here given. These mounds of earth seem to be for similar purposes with those of stone, on which are erected the ancient edifices found in Central America. While in the village of Osachile, the Spaniards learnt that that they were not far from the province of Apalachee, the country of the Apalachians. Of this province they had heard much as to its great extent and fertility, and the bravery and this was Suwanee Old Town, which he says has good hammack land about it, and is a very old Indian town. The river OscUla may take its name from this old Indian village and province. 130 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. ferocity of its inhabitants. Througout their march the Indians had predicted that the warriors of Apalachee would transfix them with their lances, hew them in pieces, or consume them with fire. De Soto was little moyed by their menaces ; his great desire was to see this boasted province ; and, if it were as fertile and abundant as represented, to winter there. He remained, therefore, but two days in Osachiie, at the end of which he re- sumed his march. The Spaniards were three days traversing an uninhabited desert, twelve leagues in extent, which lay between the two pro- vinces, and about noon on the fourth day arrived at a great morass.* It was bordered by forests of huge and lofty trees, with a dense underwood of thorns and brambles, and clambering vines, so interwoven and matted together as to form a perfect barrier. Through this the Indians had made a narrow path, scarce wide enough for two persons to walk abreast. In the centre of the morass was a sheet of water half a league in width, and as far as the eye could reach in extent. * This is supposed by Mr. M'Culloch and others to hare been the great Swamp of Okefenokee, lying in lat. 31° North, on the frontiers of Georgia and Florida ; but we are inclined to agree with Mr. Fairbanks, that it was the swamp at the head of the Estauhatchee, a river emptying into the Gulf He remarks that it could not have been the Okefenokee, as that is 150 miles nearly from Apalache, and is altogether unlike the morass, and no Indian highway goes through it ; its diameter being 12 or 15 miles. Almost any wet Florida swamp at the head of a river would answer the description given of the morass crossed by De Soto. He adds, that from Iris personal knowledge of the country, he feels quite confident that the course we have thus far marked out must be nearly, if not exactly the one taken ; and the fact that the Seminoles kept the whole army of the United States at bay for seven years, and now require to be bought out, is itself an evidence of the nature of the country. Vide Kerr's Voyages and Travels, Vol. v. p. 466. M'Culloch's Researches, p. 524. Darby's Florida, p. 19, 20. ENCOUNTER WITH THE INDIANS. 131 De Soto encamped at an early hour on a fine plain on the skirts of the forest, and ordered out a hundred cross-bowmen, archers, and pikemen, with thirty horse and twelve expert swimmers, to explore the passage of the morass, ascertain the depth of the water, and search for a ford, against the following day. They had penetrated but a little distance, when they were opposed by Indian warriors. The passage, however, was so nar- row, and so completely walled on each side by thorny and im- pervious forest, that not more than the two foremost of each vanguard could come to blows. The Spaniards, therefore, or- dered two of the stoutest to the front, armed with sword and buckler, followed by two cross-bowmen and archers. In this way they drove the Indians before them until they came to the water. Here, as both parties could scatter themselves, and had room for action, there was some hard fighting. 3Iany good shots were given, and several were killed and wounded on both sides. Finding it impossible, under such heavy fire, to examine the depth of the water, the Spaniards sent word to the governor, who came to their aid, with the best soldiers of the army. The enemy likewise received a reinforcement, and the battle became more fierce and bloody. Both fought to their waists in the water, stumbling about among thorns and brambles, and twisted roots, and the sunken trunks of fallen trees. As the Spaniards were aware that it would not do to return without discovering the pass, they continued to charge the enemy with great impetu- osity, and succeeded in driving them out of the water. They found that the narrow pass through the forest continued through the water, being cleared of thorns and roots and sunken trees. 6* 132 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. so that the Indians could wade up to their middles, excepting about forty paces of the mid-channel, where it was too deep to be forded. This they passed by a bridge of two trees fastened together. The opposite side of the morass was bordered by the same kind of impervious forest as the other, and, like it, tra- ver§*d by a narrow Indian path. The distance through the two forests, and across the morass, was about a league and a half. The governor, having well reconnoitered the pass, returned with his men to the encampment. Here he held a council of war, in which the difficulties and dangers of the case were dis- cussed, and the mode of meeting them determined upon. It was arranged that two hundred picked men should be thrown in the advance to secure the pass, and prepare the way for the passage of the main body. One hundred of these were to be horsemen, and one hundred foot-soldiers. The former being better armed than the infantry, and protected by bucklers, always received less injury from the arrows of the enemy ; they were, therefore, to take the lead on foot, as horses would only be an embarrassment in such a narrow pass. In this way they would, as it were, form a shield to the hundred foot-soldiers, consisting of arquebusiers and archers. They were all to be provided with bills, hatchets, and other implements for clearing an encamping place in the opposite for- est, on the side of the morass ; for, as the Spaniards would have to pass the narrow ford one by one, in the face of a ferocious enemy, it would be impossible for the whole army to traverse the morass and both borders of woodland in one day. It ap- peared advisable, therefore, to make a lodgment in the opposite forest.* * Garcilaso de la Vega, P. ii L. ii. c. 1. CHAPTER XXIII. OF THE PERILOUS PASSAGE OP THE GREAT MORASS. 1539. All the requisite preparations being made, two hundred picked men sallied out of the encampment, each carrying in his bosom his day's allowance, consisting of a little boiled or toasted maize. Two hours before dawn they traversed the defile of the forest, as silently as possible, until they reached the water. They soon found the ford where the stones and roots and sunken logs had been cleared away ; keeping along this they came to the bridge of fallen trees and logs, across the deepest part of the channel. This they passed without molestation from the Indi- ans, who had left the whole pass unguarded, not imagining that the Spaniards would dare to penetrate the dense forest, or ford the deep and perilous passage of the morass by night. When they perceived at daybreak, however, that they had passed the bridge, they rushed with cries and howls to dispute the passage of the morass yet to be traversed, which was about a quarter of a league. The Spaniards received their attack man- fully : both parties fought up to the middle in water. The In- dians were soon repulsed and driven into the defile of the oppo- site forest, into which they could only enter one at a time. This defile being so narrow, and walled in by an impervious forest, it 134 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA, was easy to blockade the passage and keep the enemy from sally- ing forth. Forty men were ordered to do so, while the remain- ing hundred and fifty went to work to cut down trees and clear a place for the army to encamp. In this manner they remained all the day, the Indians in the bosom of the forest shouting and yelling, as if to frighten with their noise those whom they would not engage with their arms ; some of the Spaniards watching, the others felling trees and burning the fallen timber. When night came, each one remained where he chanced to be. Disturbed by the yells of the Indians, and obliged to maintain a constant vigil, the Spaniards passed a sleepless night. The next morning the troops undertook the passage, and al- though they met with no opposition, found many difficulties in the ford, and, being obliged to pass one by one, were the whole day in crossing. By night they were all encamped on the cleared ground, where, however, they enjoyed but little sleep, in consequence of the yells and attacks of the enemy. At break of day they pressed forward through the defile of the second forest, driving the Indians slowly before them, who retreated step by step, plying their bows incessantly, so that every inch of the way had to be won at the edge of the sword. At length, after fighting onward for half a league, they emerged from this dense and thorny forest into more open wood- land. Here, however, the Indians, foreseeing more scope for the horses, had taken precautions accordingly. It was in a part of this very morass, though not in this im- mediate neighborhood, that Pamphilo de Narvaez had been de- DESPERATE ATTACK OF THE INDIANS. 135 feated about ten or eleven years before ; and the Indians, profit- ing by the experience then gained, and encouraged by the recol- lection of that triumph, trusted for like success in the present instance. To render the much dreaded horses ineffective, they had blocked up and traversed the open places of the forest with great logs, and branches tied from tree to tree ; and in the close and matted parts had made narrow passages by which they might dart forth, make an assault, and vanish again in an instant. As soon, therefore, as the Spaniards entered this more open woodland, they were assailed by showers of arrows from every side. The Indians, scattered about among the thickets, sallied forth, plied their bows with intense rapidity, and plunged again into the forest, The horses were of no avail ; the arquebusiers and archers seemed no longer a terror ; for in the time a Span- iard could make one discharge and reload his musket, or place another bolt in his cross-bow. an Indian would launch six or seven arrows : scarce had one arrow taken flight before another was in the bow. In their hampered situation, the Spaniards found it impossi- ble to assault the enemy ; their only alternative was to defend themselves and press forward. All the while, too, that they were exposed to this galling fire, they were insulted by the taunts and threats of the enemy, who reminded them of their victory over Pamphilo de Narvaez, and menaced them with a like defeat. For two long leagues did the Spaniards toil and fight their way forward through this forest : irritated and mortified by these galling attacks, vexatious taunts, and the impossibility of 136 OONQUhST OK FLORIDA. retaliating; at length they ornorged into an open and level country. J fere, overjoyed at being freed from this forest prison, they gave reins to their horses and i'rcjt vent to their smothered rage, and scoured the plain, lancing and cutting down every Indian they encountered, out of revenge of their own annoyances, and of the past defeat of Narvaez. But few of the enemy were taken prisoners ; many were put to the sword ; and thus did they suffer severely for the presumptuous confidence inspired by their former triumph over- Spaniards.* * GarcUaso de la Vc^i, l\ ii. L. iL c. 2. Herrera, Hist. Lid., Decad. vl L. vii. C. 12. CHAPTER XXIV. THE INDIANS MAKE A DESPERATE STAND AT A DEEP STREAM — THE SPANIARDS GAIN THE PASS AND ARRIVE AT THE INDIAN VILLAGE or ANHAYEA, IN THE PROVINCE OP APALACHEE, 1539. The .Spaniard.-; had now arrived at the commencement of a fertile region, covered with those villages and fields of grain for which the province of Apalaehee was famous throughout the country. Wearied with their toilsome march and incessant fighting, they encamped for the night in the open plain, near a small village. Still they were deprived of the repose so necessary to them. All night they were disturbed by yells and bowlings, by repeated assaults, and flights of arrows discharged into the earn p. At daybreak they resumed their march through e; fields of maize, beans, pumpkins, and other vegetables, extending on each side of the road as far as the eye could reach, in- terspersed with srnail cabins, showing a numerous but scattered population. The inhabitants justified their ferocious and warlike reputa- tion, for they kept up incessant attacks, sallying forth from their dwellings, or starting up from corn-fields where they had lain in ambush : and though the Spaniards wreaked upon them a bloody 138 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. revenge, slaughtering them without mercy, yet nothing could check the fury of the survivors. After contending for two leagues through the fields of corn, the Spaniards came to a deep stream, bordered by forests •* where the Indians had erected palisades and barriers, to impede the passing of the horse, as well as to protect themselves. As this was one of the strongest and most important passes, and in a manner their last hope, they had prepared themselves to defend it vigorously. Having reconnoitered the pass, the Spaniards made arrange- ments accordingly. The best armed horsemen alighted, and buckling on their shields, advanced with swords and hatchets in hand, gained the pass, and broke down the palisades and barriers. The Indians fought desperately to defend them ; several Span- iards were killed and many wounded, but they succeeded in forcing their way with less difficulty than they had apprehended. The stream forded, they marched two more leagues without opposition, through the same kind of fertile and cultivated coun- try ; then choosing a place clear from forests, encamped for the night. After four days and three nights of watching, toiling, and fighting, they needed repose, and had hoped, in this open place, where the horses had free career, that they should be able to en- joy it without molestation. The darkness of the night, however, encouraged the assaults of their restless and daring foes, and obliged them to keep up a constant vigil with their weapons in their hands. Even the Indians who were captured evinced the implacable and unconquerable spirit for which the Apalachian tribe was fa- mous. Though in the power of their enemies, they continued to * Mr. M'Culloch supposes this to be the river Uche. ARRIVAL AT ANHAYEA. 139 carry an air of haughtiness and defiance ; boasting of their origin, vaunting the valor of their nation, and telling the Spaniards that they would soon arrive at the village of their cacique, where he and a host of warriors were waiting to destroy them. The name of this cacique was Capafi ; the first they had heard of, whose name differed from that of his village. Learning that this for- midable village was actually but about two leagues distant, Her- nando de Soto, on the following morning, which was the fifth since crossing the morass, put himself in the advance, with two hundred horse and a hundred foot. On their way they put all the Indians they met with to the sword. On reaching the village they found it recently deserted by the cacique and his men. They pursued them for some distance, killed some of the Indians, and captured others : but the cacique made his escape. They then took up their quarters in the village, which was named Anhayea,* and contained two hundred and fifty large and commodious houses : the Adelantado took possession of the dwelling of the cacique, which stood at one end of the vil- lage, and was superior to the rest.f In addition to this principal village, they understood that there were many others in the province, containing from fifty to a hundred houses, more or less, besides a multitude of dwellings scattered about the country. The province throughout was re- puted to be pleasant, the soil fertile, producing maize, cucumbers, beans, and wild plums ; the rivers abounded in fish, which the natives caught in vast quantities throughout the year, and dried for use.| * Portuguese Narrative, c. 12. f This village is supposed to be in the neighborhood of the modern town of Tallahassee. Colonel Pickett says, Indian traditions confirm this opinion. \ Garcilaso de la Vega, P. ii. L. ii. c. 4. Portuguese Narrative, c. 12. CHAPTER XXV. JUAN DE ANASCO SETS OUT IN SEARCH OF THE OCEAN THE ADVEN- TURES HE MET WITH BY THE WAY. 1539. The army remained in the village of Anhayea for several days, recruiting from its past toils, although the enemy did not fail to continue their attacks by night and day. The governor now sent out bands of horse and foot to explore the surrounding country for fifteen or twenty leagues. Two captains, the one named Arias Tinoco, the other, Andreas de Vasconcelos, were sent in different directions to the northward. They returned, the one in eight, and the other in nine days, having met with no adventures wor- thy of relation. Both reported that they had found many popu- lous villages, and that the country was fertile and free from morasses or extensive forests. A third captain had been sent about the same time to the southward : this was Juan de Anasco, the Contador of the army. He was one whom De Soto often chose for undertakings that required a stout heart and active spirit, though he was sometimes prone to be a little hasty in tem- per and positive in command. He had under his command forty horse and fifty foot, and was accompanied by G-onzalo Silvestre and Gomez Arias. The latter was a relation of the governor's wife, and a hardy soldier, seasoned in all kinds of perils and SUSPECTED TREACHERY. 141 vicissitudes by land and water, as most Spanish adventurers were in those days. He had seen rough times in Moorish warfare : had been a slave in Barbary : and, to his adventurous valor, add- ed sage experience in council. Thus accompanied. Juan de Anasco set off towards the south in quest of the ocean, which was said to be less than thirty leagues distant from Anhayea. He was guided in his expedition by an Indian, who professed great fidelity and attachment to the Spaniards. For two days they travelled over an excellent road, wide and level, passing two small rivers which were easily forded. Here they came to the village of Aute, which was abandoned by the in- habitants, but well stocked with provisions. Taking with them a supply for four days, they continued on by the same commodious road. At length the Indian diverged from it. and led the way into dense and thorny forests without any path. The ground was in many places rough and broken, and covered with fallen trees. In other places were deep bogs covered with grass, that presented the appearance of firm land, but into which horse and foot sunk and floundered, and were almost smothered. In this wilderness they wandered about for five days, fre- quently crossing their former track, until their stock of pro- visions was nearly exhausted. Three times they came, as they thought, within sound of the distant surges of the sea. and each time the Indian struck in an opposite direction. In their vexa- tion and perplexity they began to suspect his fidelity, and that he had a design to make them perish with hunger in this inextri- cable forest. eTen though he should share the same fate. These suspicions, however, they kept to themselves, for they had no other guide. 142 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. They now determined to return to Aute, get a fresh supply of provisions, and renew their search. Their return was the more toilsome, as they had to retrace their footsteps through fear of losing the road, and the mire of the bogs was so much trampled that they sank deeper in it than before. Four days did they keep on in this painful way, and their suspicions of their Indian guide revived. They grew peevish in their conduct towards him ; quarrels ensued between him and the soldiers ; he was beaten, and would have been slain on the spot, had not Anasco interfered. Exasperated to revenge, he watched an opportunity at night while the soldiers slept, and snatching a brand from the fire, struck those who had maltreated him. This only brought on him severer punishment. A chain was then put round his neck and the other end given to a soldier, to keep close watch over him. The next morning, in the course of their rugged march, the guide, as he followed the soldier who had him in charge, sprang suddenly upon him, threw him to the ground, and began to trample upon him. Upon this the Spaniards fell upon the Indian with sword and pike : even Juan de Anasco, losing all temper, raised himself in his stirrups, and with both hands, dealt him a terrible thrust with his lance ; after which, as he lay for dead, a hound was turned loose to tear him to pieces. Their guide being slain, and their anger being thus cruelly appeased, they began to think which way they should direct their steps. In this dilemma they turned to an Indian whom they had captured on their return to Aute. From him they gathered by signs, and a few words which they understood, that it would be impossible to go to the sea by their present route, on RETURN TO AUTE. 143 account of the swamps and forests ; but that if they would return to Aute he would take them by a direct road to the coast, and to the very place where Pamphilo de Narvaez had built his vessels and embarked. They had no alternative but to trust to this new guide, hop- ing that the fate of his predecessor would have a salutary effect on him. They returned, therefore, to the village of Aute, after fifteen days of toilsome and fruitless wandering. As Gomez Arias and Gronzalo Silvestre were riding in the advance, they took two Indian prisoners, near to the village. On questioning them about the sea-coast, and the proper route to find it, they confirmed all that had been said by the present guide. The Spaniards comforted themselves with the hope, therefore, that they would now be able to accomplish the object of their journey ; and with this persuasion, slept soundly and contentedly that night, after all their toils. CHAPTER XXVI. JUAN DE ANASCO ARRIVES AT THE BAY, WHERE HE FINDS TRACES OF PAMPHILO DE NARVAEZ. 1539. On the following day Juan de Anasco and his followers set out once more from the village of Aute, under the guidance of the three Indians, by the new route they pointed out. The road was wide and open, free from any bad passages, excepting one narrow marsh, in which the horses did not sink over their fet- locks. They had not journeyed more than two leagues when they arrived at a spacious bay,* and, proceeding along its shores, came at last, to their great joy, to the very place where the un- fortunate Pamphilo de Narvaez and his people had sojourned. Here were the remains of a rude forge, where the iron work for the vessels had been wrought ; and around it lay scattered char- coal and cinders. There were large trunks of trees, also, hol- lowed out into troughs, in which the horses had been fed ; and not far oif lay the bones of the horses that had been killed. The Spaniards gazed with melancholy interest on these relics of a disastrous expedition, and eagerly sought to glean from their savage guides further particulars respecting Narvaez and * Evidently the Bay of St. Marks, or Apalachee. See Charlevoix Jour- nal Historique, Let. xxxiv. RETURN TO DE SOTO. 145 his men. The Indians had picked up some Spanish phrases during the time that Narvaez sojourned here ; with these, aided by signs, and by words of their own language, partly understood by their hearers, they contrived to give some account of the transactions at the bay. They led the Spaniards, step by step, over the scenes visited by Narvaez : showed the place where ten of his men had been surprised and slain : and pointed out every spot where things of note had happened to that ill-starred com- mander. Anasco and his companions searched in every direction to find if any letter had been left in the hollow of a tree, or any inscription on the bark, as was the common practice with discov- erers, but found nothing of the kind. They then ranged along the shores of the bay to the sea, which was three leagues distant. Here, finding some old canoes cast upon the beach, ten or twelve expert swimmers embarked in them and sounded the bay, in the mid-channel of which they found sufficient depth for large ships. After this, they placed signals in the highest trees, so as to be apparent to any one sailing along the coast ; and took down, in writing, a minute account of the place and its bearings, for the information of any one who might henceforth seek it. Having taken these precautions, they made the best of their way back to the army. De Soto was rejoiced to see them, for their long absence had caused him great uneasiness. He was highly satis- fied, also, to learn that they had discovered so excellent a harbor, and the very one from which Pamphilo de Narvaez had set sail with his ill-fated barks. CHAPTER XXVII. THE EXPEDITION OF JUAN DE ANA SCO AND HIS BAND OP THIRTY TE,OOPERS. 1539. As the season was far advanced, De Soto resolved to proceed no farther for the present, hut to winter in this ahundant province of Apalachee. He caused the village of Anhayea, therefore, to be strongly fortified, additional buildings to be erected for bar- racks, and the surrounding country to be foraged for a stock of provisions. In the mean time, friendly messages and presents were repeatedly sent to the cacique Capafi. He, however, rejected all overtures, and buried himself in a dense forest, surrounded by morasses and perilous defiles. As De Soto saw no use in keeping up a garrison at Hirri- higua, in the bay of Espiritu Santo, he determined to send orders to Pedro Calderon to break up his encampment there, dispatch the vessels which lay in the harbor, and march with the forces under his command to rejoin the army in their winter quarters. How to get these orders to Pedro Calderon was now the question ; for whoever bore the message would have to retrace the wilderness through which the army had marched, to re-cross the deep and rapid rivers, thread the gloomy forests and miry swamps, and, as it were, run the gauntlet through tribes of PEDRO MORONS EXPEDITION. 147 warlike and cruel savages, smarting from late conflicts, and thirst- ing for revenge. After mature consideration, lie resolved to intrust the peril- ous enterprise to a band of troopers, sufficient in number to make head against a considerable force of savages, yet not too numerous to move with secrecy and expedition. No sooner did he propose the daring errand than there was a competition among the young cavaliers of the arraj to be sent upon it ; for the very danger excited their ardor. De Soto chose from among them thirty prime lances, and appointed as their leader the stout-hearted and well-tried Juan de Aftasco. Along with him went the shrewd and hardy Gomez Arias, his comrade in the late expedition to the bay of Aute. Among the lances was one Pedro Moron, a mestizo, or half- blood, between Spaniard and mulatto, a native of the island of Cuba. This soldier, beside being an admirable swimmer, was gifted with a scent almost equal to that of a dog : so that he had often, in the island of Cuba, winded and traced a fugitive Indian into the thickets and caves in which he had hid himself. He also could scent fire at the distance of a league, though no light or smoke was to be perceived.* In company with him went another mestizo, his friend and countryman, likewise a native of Cuba. It was on the 20th of Novemberf (1539) that this small and intrepid band set out on their hazardous errand. As celerity of movement was all important, each horseman was lightly equipped with a casque, a coat of mail under his doublet, and a lance : a pair of alforjas or wallets were slung across the saddle-bow, in which, beside a small supply of food for himself, and corn for his steed, he had two or three spare horseshoes, and a few nails. * Garcilaso de la Vega, P. ii L. ii. o, 7. f Portuguese Relation. 7 148 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. Long before the day dawned the gallant troopers were on the road.* Pressing forward, they scoured along at full speed, when practicable, fearing lest the rumor of their coming might precede them, and give the Indians time to assemble and dispute the passes. Overtaking two of the natives, they put them to death, to prevent their giving the alarm to their comrades scattered about the fields. They traversed the extensive morass and vast forests of Apalachee, without opposition, and halted in an open plain on its skirts ; ten of their number keeping watch while the remainder slept. Ere it was light they were again in their saddles, and made the best of their way over that desert tract of country lying be- tween the morass of Apalachee and the village of Osachile. Ap- prehensive that the Indians might have heard of their approach, and would make stout resistance in the village, Anasco ordered a halt. As night closed in, they pushed onward with great caution, and came in sight of the village about midnight. Not stopping to reconnoitre, they loosened their reins, clapped spurs to their horses, and dashed through at full speed. Having galloped about a league further, they struck off their course for a short distance, and halted for the remainder of the night ; having travelled this day more than thirteen leagves. At daybreak they resumed their journey, putting their horses to their speed, as numbers of the natives were scattered about the fields, and might give the alarm. Thus, they went five leagues on a scamper to the river Osachile, at the risk of their horses ; but these were, luckily, so high mettled that they suffer- ed but little. * The account of this romantic and perilous expedition of the thirty troopers, is entirely from the Inca Garcilaso de la Vega. The Portuguese Narrative makes very brief mention of it. VITACHUCO BURNT BY THE NATIVES. 149 On approaching the river, (xonzalo Silvestre, who had pushed his horse more than his companions, was in advance. He was fearful lest the river should have swollen since the army crossed it. Fortunately, however, the water had fallen. He was so overjoyed that he plunged in with his horse, swam the stream, and mounted the bank on the opposite side. When his com- panions came up they were rejoiced to see him on the opposite bank, for they had entertained the same fear, that the river might have increased : they all dashed in, gained the other side without accident, and, with light hearts, dismounted and made their breakfast on the green-sward. They were soon again on horse, and at a moderate pace ap- proached the village of Vitachuco. Thinking to have found the place as they had left it, they looked forward to some severe fight- ing with the inhabitants, and expected to pass through it at the point of the sword. A consultation was held, and it was resolved, that none should stop to fight, but at full gallop cut their way through the enemy ; for the death of one of their number, or of a horse, would be a serious loss, and increase the perils of the ex- pedition. Thus determined, they spurred on, and were soon re- lieved from their apprehensions. They found the village a scene of utter desolation ; the houses burnt, the walls thrown to the ground, and the bodies of the Indians who had fallen on the day of battle, heaped up into a mound, and left unsepulchred. The Spaniards afterwards learnt that the natives had destroyed and deserted this village, from an idea that it had been built on an evil and ill-fated site ; and they had left the corses of their peo- ple unburied, food for carrion birds and wild beasts, because, ac- cording to their superstitious belief, the unfortunate and defeat- ed in battle were infamous and accursed. CHAPTER XXVIII. CONTINUATION OF THE BOLD AND PERILOUS EXPEDITION OF JUAN DE ANASCO, AND HIS THIRTY LANCES. 1539. The Spaniards checked their steeds, and wonnd slowly through the ruins of the village, wondering at the desolation around them. They had left it but a short distance behind them, when they en- countered two Indian warriors, on a hunting expedition, who took refuge under a large walnut tree. One of them, however, quit- ting the tree, made an attempt to reach the woods on the oppo- site side of the road, but two horsemen dashed after him, and be- fore he attained this asylum, transfixed him with their lances. The other Indian, of more courageous spirit, kept his station under the tree ; and, as fortune usually favors the daring, he met with a better fate. Fixing an arrow in his bow, he fearlessly faced the Spaniards, who came galloping one behind the other, and threatened to shoot, should they approach him. Some of the cavaliers, piqued at his defiance, would fain have dismounted to attack him lance in hand. Anasco, however, represented to them that there was neither valor nor prudence in attacking a desperate man ; especially at a time when the death, even of a horse, would be deeply felt : and NARROW ESCAPE OF THE SPANIARDS. 151 when they were badly provided with medicines to heal the wound- ed. He then wheeled his horse, and they made a large circuit from the road, lest the Indian should shoot any of the horses as they passed : for this they dreaded most. He allowed them all to pass, and finding that, instead of attacking him, they had turn- ed on one side, he started after them, taunting them for flying from a single foe. At this moment a shrill and wild outcry rose from every part of the surrounding fields and forests. Savages started up on all sides, and called upon each other to barricade the road. But the Spaniards gave their horses the reins and spur, and soon left the enemy behind them. This night, the third of their wayfaring, they halted in a level and beautiful plain, having tra- velled seventeen leagues since morning ; the last eight through the province of Yitachuco. On the fourth day they journeyed other seventeen leagues through the same province. The natives, thirsting for revenge, on account of their late defeat, were on the alert ; and seeing the Spaniards passing through their country with so small a force, determined to massacre them. They sent seven Indian runners ahead to spread the alarm of the coming of the white men, that their warriors might assemble at some narrow pass and dispute the way. The Christians, however, suspecting their designs, pushed on so close upon the runners, that they took them all prisoners. At nightfall they encamped as usual in an open plain. A little past midnight they roused themselves from their slumbers, and by sunrise had already travelled five leagues, and arrived at the river Ochali, where, on a former occasion, the Indians had killed the hound with their arrows. They hoped to find the river with less water than when they had crossed it, but, 152 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. on the contrary, it had overflowed its banks, and was now a deep, turbid stream, boiling and foaming with whirlpools, fearful even to look upon, and dangerous to traverse. The Spaniards held an earnest consultation for a few mo- ments : the first object was to secure the opposite bank before the Indians should arrive there. It was determined, therefore, that twelve of the best swimmers, stripping themselves of every thing except their casques and coats of mail, and disencumbering their horses of saddles and saddle-bags, and taking only their lances in their hands, should swim their steeds to the opposite bank, and take post there, to protect the crossing of their com- panions with the baggage. At the same time, fourteen were, with all speed, to construct a raft of drift-wood, to transport the baggage, and such of the party as could not swim ; while four were to mount guard at their present post, until all should be effected. All this was no sooner agreed upon than it was put into execution. The twelve swimmers threw off all superfluous clothes, and, taking lance in hand, urged their horses into the raging stream. Eleven of them landed in safety at a large opening on the opposite bank: the twelfth was Juan Lopez Cacho, page to the governor — the same youth who once accom- panied G-onzalo Silvestre on his perilous errand to the camp. In attempting to cross, he drifted with his horse somewhat below the opening. Finding he could not stem the current up to the place where his companions landed, he let his horse swim lower down the river, and sought some other landing-place. He at- tempted several times to scramble up the bank, but it was like a wall, and there was no foothold for the horse. He was com- pelled, therefore, to return to the opposite shore, but before he RESCUE OF JUAN" LOPEZ CACHO. 153 reached it, his horse began to falter through fatigue. He called out for succor to his companions who were felling wood for the raft. Four of them threw themselves into the water, and dragged him and his horse to shore. By the time they reached it, the poor youth was so chilled and exhausted that he was more like a corpse than a living being. Leaving the cavaliers to complete the crossing of the river, we will cast a look back to the camp, to notice the proceedings of its careful commander. CHAPTER XXIX. DE SOTO'S ENTERPRISE AGAINST THE CACIQUE OF CAPAFI. 1539. Having dispatched Juan de Anasco and his thirty lances on their expedition, the next thought of De Soto was for the securi- ty and comfort of his army. Ever since he had been quartered in the village of Anhayea, the Indians had kept up a series of harassing attacks and alarms, by day and night. The whole neighborhood was beset by them, lurking about in ambush, so that a soldier could not stray a bow-shot from the camp without being waylaid and assaulted. Knowing the devotion of the Indians to their chieftains, it occurred to De Soto, that if he could once get Capafi, the cacique of Apalachee, in his power, his subjects would cease from their stratagems and attacks. It was a long time, however, before he could get upon the traces of the cacique, or discover where he had concealed himself, for he did not take the field with his war- riors like the other chieftains. In fact, Capafi, though redoubt- able from his sovereign power, was so enormously fat and un- wieldy, that he could not walk, nor even stand. He went about in his dwelling on his hands and knees, and, on moving from DE SOTO AT THE INDIAN CITADEL. 155 place to place, was borne in a litter on the shoulders of his subjects. At length De Soto received intelligence that the cacique had posted himself in the midst of a dense and extensive forest, about eight leagues from the camp, surrounded by tangled thick- ets and treacherous morasses, so as to be almost inaccessible. It was, moreover, fortified in their strongest manner, and garri- soned by the choicest Apalachian warriors, so as to be deemed by them perfectly impregnable. As an enterprise against this stronghold was one of peculiar peril, De Soto, with his accustomed intrepidity, took it upon him- self, and, at the head of a body of horse and foot, made his way in three days, with great difficulty, to the Indian citadel, the construction of which deserves particular mention. In the heart of this close and impervious forest, a piece of ground was cleared and fortified for the residence of the cacique and his warriors. The only entrance or outlet was by a narrow path, cut through the forest. At every hundred paces this path was barricaded by palisades and trunks of trees, at each of which was posted a guard of the bravest warriors. Thus the fat cacique was ensconced in the midst of the forest, like a spider in the midst of his web, and his devoted subjects were ready to de- fend him to the last gasp. When the governor arrived at the entrance of the perilous defile, he found the enemy well prepared for its defence. The Spaniards pressed forward, but the path was so narrow that the two foremost only could engage in the combat. They gained the first and second palisade at the point of the sword. Here it was necessary to cut the osiers and other bands with which the Indians had fastened the beams. While thus occupied, they 7* 156 CO I 01 FLORIDA. were exposed fco a galling fire, and received many wounds. Not- withstanding all these obstacles, they r want of defensive armor, fought on unequal terms, and were most of them cut down. The cacique called out to the survivors to surrender. The hitter, having done all that good soldiers could do, and M" ;ill their warlike efforts in rain, threw themselves t' theivtlovers Tuscaloosa, on arriving at the village with the /Ldelantado, had hold a council of w:ir with his prinoipal warriors, wherein it w.in debated whether fchej should attach the vanguard whieh h.-i »l arrived, or wail until they had the whole within their power It is probable that the heat and impatienoe of the [ndian general caused the plot to explode before the appointed time n has been shown, that in the burning of the village the Spaniards Lost all their baggage and private effects What gave them tin 1 greatest oonoern, however, was the loss of .*i little por tion of wine and wheaten flour, winch they had oarefullj treasured up tor the performance o\' mass All tin 1 saoerdotal dresses, also the ohalioes, and other articles o( worship, were destroyed j but the loss of the wheaten flour was irreparable Consultations were held between the ecclesiastics and the laymen, whether bread made of matte might not be adopted, in ease of extremity . l>nt il \>as decided, thai the use Of ft^ thing but wheat was contrary iy^ the canons o( the church From thenceforward, therefore, on Sundays and Saints' days, they prepared an altar, and the priest officiated, arrayed in robes of dressed deer skin, fashioned in imitation of his saoerdotal dresses) and they preformed all parts of the oeremony, except in;: the consecration of the bread and wine This constituted what the Spaniards called K f dry mass" CHAPTER LVIIL DB SOTO BECOMES aim ALTERED man, and why 1540, Wnii. i: at the village of Mauvila, overwhelmed with oare and axis ioty, the governor was unexpectedly cheered by tidings, that ships with white men in them bad arrived on the sea-coast, towards which he was shaping his course, A rumor of this U i 1 1 * I he had heard before the battle, and it was confirmed by some of the prisoners taken in the village H<' further learnt from them that the port ■• Pensaoola, where he had di reoted Gomez Arias and Diego Maldonado to rendezvous with their ships, was uot more than seven days' journey distant.* ll< doubted not, therefore, that the ships in question were command ed by those officers, and brought reinforcements and supplies from Spain, for 1 1 i ^ projected settlement \l< now considered himself <»n the eve of accomplishing all his wishes , of founding that colony which would assure the possession <»r the country he had explored, .uid enable dim iuk trees, The weather was nov severe with sooti ftnd toe, and the troops suffered extremeh tn their encampments. The governor, therefore determined to take np his winter Quarter* t*1 Ohioa a For this purpose he ordered wood and stra^ to be brought from the neighboring hamlets, wherewith to oonstruot houses j For notwithstanding there were two hundred tn the village, thej were boo im ill to shelter the army, n. -ni\ two months the Spaniards remained in this encamp raent, enjoying some quietude and repose The cavalry dailj ared the Belds, and eaptured the [ndians, whom the governor sent to the oaolaue with presents and offers of peaoe and friend ship The cacique made favorable replies, promising, from daj to day, to visit the camp, but as often exousing his delay, and sending pre ( fruit, fish, and venison De Soto ve the neipal warriors of (his chieftain a feast, at whiehwas served up souk- \ which the [ndians had never before tasted, and stable and delicious did they find it, that from this time thej would prowl about the encampment everj night, to steal and ■ v Considering the of the ivuntrv tluvugh whu'h thoj v. b the modem iivwumis «f that region, the direction of the march, .•.tiu\ aiul the ^Ustaiuv, it is v . j . x ,u>iu that this was tho ivuutrv of the Chick - athenppwpart of th< ) pillage HTOhahty sUvd W OjC w oatem bank of the Ya/AK\ a braiu'h of the V to the norttwweat of Mobih*. Charlevoix remarks, \ . tMtu'aohas Jans sv>n Histo.no (fa la Oo»(|1 ot tl tea place a p< ctroit, oil ils aont e» ■.-. \ ide Charlevoix, Joar. Hist, i oi sods p - s JWUroap'Si \ : do ^ \ tad Utst. of i 1 '. N »ppi ViH 1 r I i-i-,.«:i;i. 01 THE <:iM./ii.;/.i, . I. ill III* ■..,-/ 1 in; TWO I ikIi.-iii I, wlio W i ' ' tUgllt m I.Ik-, ;i.i:I,. w . -,. ibot fco di atb, by ordi i oi thi go n i noi , and a third bad bl i band out off, and was sent to his eoeique at an e ampL and vara lug to the otbi i I ndian i 4 bout tin- i. ii.k foui oidii i >■ paired to the dwelling oi tbe que, about a I' ague from the camp, without the pei mi ision oi m.<- governor, and carried on l*;/ force tome skins and mantle*, win- 1. '-I ill* 1 1 1 « J i ... 1 1 . ; that k.,.1./ oi them abandoned i.Ik ii homes vvIikh Dc Soto beard ol this rioienee, be bad them all arrested; comdemned tbe two ringleader*, Franci co ( > orio and one Puentez, to death, and confiscated tbe goods oi all the foui ouipi it 'I'll, priests and officers of tbi army supplicated tbegeneral to mitigate tbe sentence, and begged the life ol Prancisco Osorio h<; Soto, however, was innexibli Tbe unfortunate criminals were led forth into, tbe public square to be beheaded. Ai. this moment a party of [ndians arrived, being sent by tbe cacique, to make his complaints Thi i event, which leemed calculated to hasten tbe death of tbe Spaniards, vas tbe means oi tbeii sal ration. Juan Ortiz, the interpreter, instigated by Baltazai de Ga-llegos, and otbei ofnoei oi rank, cunningly gave a false in terpretation of the complaints of tbe indignant chieftain He told tbe governoi that the cacique bad sent these [ndians to lay, that tbe soldiers were not guilty, and had in ■ offended him, and that be would consider it as i gn i£ favoi if tb< y w&h .■■ doned and set at liberty Upon this tbe governoi pardoned tbe criminals,* On the otbei band, Ortiz d tbe Indians, that tbe soldiers who bad injured them were in prison, and that tbe rnoi would punish them in such an exemplary manner, as to 1 1 ,<<■ .. .-,,, < ample fco all otln i 1 PortU) i ration, t 20 OONQl i.-i OF i'i GRID \ \u the nwuu (uuc, (In 1 SUOJeOtS of thlfl >.i'U|ii>' kept Up OOQ atant alarms :>< nlglit, as if about te assail the ?iiiagej but the moment the soldiers sallied out, the\ would take to flight The governoi suspct >tcd, however, that these were but sham attacks, in tended te tender his sentinels careless and off their guard when :i i.-.ii attack should be made He e&hortedhis eatnn»master, Luis de Mfo e, te be unceasing in his rigilanoe, and to maintain wateh upon theoampat night Kia suspi oiona and expectations wore correct, though unfortunately thej were but \\u\c heeded CHAPTER LXL Tin: i>i;;ii:i; \ i i: Q \ rn.i: OF CHICAZA, 11,11 A dark and cloudy night, when .1. north wind vvhh Mowing imioiiM ly. \v:i;! ollOHGn l»Y bho OaoiQUC I"' :« "i;iihI aSNauit ii|»«mi bh(3 vil i:i"<' Dividing his foroos into bhroc bands, t nice tin i attaoli ;ii three several places, ho led <>ii bho centre i in person, and ap proaohod in the dead of 'lie night, with suoh silence, as bo ai pivo willini ;i 1 1 1 1 1 m I r< m I |>:i,rcM of I, lie Hniltinoll \\ 1 1 In hi I, being |"i oeived Having learnt by nil loouts, that the bwo other bandi were equally advanoed, he gave bhe signal <>r attack l mmediatel v bhe .hi resounded with the blasts of oonoh shells, the rumbling of wooden drums, and the yells and war whoops of bhe savages, who rushed like demons to the assault Many had lighted matches, like oords made «»i a vegetable substanoe, which whirled In the air, would blaze up Into a Eamoj othors '••"i at rows blpped with the same These they hurled upon bhe houses, w 1 1 1 < 1 1 being <>r reeds and straw, Instantly booli &re, and, the wind blowing strongly, were i wrapped is flames." * Aci'iinlin/jf i,n r.i< •< in in , iin- imiiiMii having lonmnc] whoru bho HpiuiUh .(•niiiifi'i wore | ►■ ■•(.•« i . hi . i . . i two by two an unguarclud purfc <»' bho village; mnl wiih Mid flro, which they oonoosled In imalJ pots, noon not bhe place In • blaio, justai Hi" war w\ p of anothoi band aroie I i wit] '< ...,,-, CONQUEST OF FLORIDA The Spaniards, although surprised hy this sudden and furious assault, rushed out to defend themselves. De Soto, who always slept in ins doublet and hose, that he might be prepared for such emergencies, olasped od his oasque, drew on s surooat o( quilted cotton, three lingers in thiekness, the host defence against the ar rows of the savages, and seising buokler and ianoe, mounted his horse, and dashed fearlessly into the midst of the enemy, Ten or twelve horsemen followed him, though not immediately The soldiers in every direction started ap, with thru- wonted spirit^ to battle with the Indians \ but they labored under great disadvantages The strong wind, which blow the flames and smoke direotbj in their feces, greatly disconcerted them, Some were obliged to crawl out of their quarters on all tours, to escape the Lng flames . some, bewildered, fled from house to house . others rushed out into the plain] and some flew io rescue the sick and the wounded, who were in a dwelling apart Before succor ar rived, however,many of them had perished in the flames The cavalry had not time to arm themselves, or saddle their steeds Some led theirs forth, and hurried themfrom the flames; others, who had fastened up their horses with iron chains, on ac- count of their being restiff from high feeding, could not cast them Loose in the hurry, and had io Leave them io their fete, and tU lor their own Lives, k few who were enabled io mount gal Lcped to the assistance of the governor, who, with his scanty num- ber of followers, had been battling tor a Long time with the ene- mj The other two bauds of [ndians entered the village and at tacked the Spaniards on each flank; and, aided by the tiro and smoke, made great lu\ oc Win or flftj of the soldiers who were .-it the eastern end of the village, where the flames and the battle raged most fiercely, DS SOTO in DANGER Mi Bed info the lolds Nnno Tobar rushed after them, sword Is hand, his coat of mail loft unbuckled in the hurry "Turn, so] , M \v hi Mm r :ii c yOU H yni" ' I l< i< i,: ncil licr Cordova ■ Seville to give you refuge STour safety Lies In vour courage, and in the vigor of your arms; not in light M this moment I liirty soldiers, from a part of I he village which the Barnes had not peached, came up bo intercept the fugitives Thej taunt ed the recreant Spaniards with their shameful flight, and inducing them to join forces, they hastened together to renew the combat, \i this time, Andres de 1 asconcelos, with twenty four ohosen cavaliers of his company, ill Portuguese hidalgos, most of whom had served as horsemen Id the wars on the African frontier, oharg ed on the main body of the enemy He was accompanied by Nu no Tobar, on foot The fury of their attaolt forced the savages bo retire, This timely reinforcement gave new o 'age bo the handful of Spaniards, who, headed by the governor, were lighting in that quarter, De Soto had marked an Endian warrior, who had fought with great fury and success Closing in with him, he gave hina a thrust of the lance; and charging upon him, and Leaning withal] his force upon the right stirrup to repeat the blow, the saddle, which had been left iingirt In the confusion of the assault, slipped off, and De Soto fell with It in tl idst of the enemy i The Spaniards, seeing his peril, dashed In, horse and foot, to his rescue, and kept the [ndians at bay, until he wai extricated and his steed saddled, when, vaulting upon his back, he pricked again into the light The [ndians, at length completely vanquished, led from the field of battle Do Soto, with liis troopers, pursued them as Long Li they oould be distinguished by the Light of the bui oing tillage 298 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. then ordering the recall to be sounded, he returned to ascertain his loss. He found it greater than he had imagined. Forty Span- iards had fallen in the combat. Among the dead was a Spanish woman, the wife of a worthy soldier, and the only female who had accompanied the army. Her husband had left her behind when he rushed forth to fight. She had escaped from the house, but returned to save some pearls ; the flames cut off her second re- treat, and she was found afterwards burned to death. Fifty horses, also, had perished, and many more were wounded- Above twenty of them had been either burnt or shot down with arrows, in the houses where their masters had been obliged to leave them tied up. The darts had been skilfully aimed at the most vital parts. One horse had two shafts through the heart, shot from opposite directions. Another horse, and one of the broadest and heaviest in the army, was shot by such a vigorous arm, that the arrow had passed through both shoulders, and four fingers' breadth beyond. Another loss, which grieved the Spaniards, was that of the swine which they had brought with them, to stock their projected settlement. These had been shut up in an inclosure roofed with straw, and nearly all perished in the flames. In examining the bodies of the Indians killed in the battle, the Spaniards found three cords wound round several of them. These, it is said, they had brought to secure their anticipated spoils ; one being intended to bind a Spanish captive, another to lead off a horse, and the third to tie up a hog. The story, however, savors strongly of camp gossip. This disastrous battle, following on the ruinous one of Mau- vila, increased the gloom and exasperation of spirit of De Soto. He made strict inquiry into the night attack, and the circum- FATAL SURPRISE. 299 stances which had enabled the enemy to approach, undiscovered, and surprise them so fatally. All this he attributed to gross negligence, on the part of Luis de Moscoso, in respect to placing sentinels and going the rounds. He had probably been already provoked by the tardy arrival of Moscoso on the fatal battle-field of Mauvila ; and now, in this additional cause of vexation, forgot his feelings of friendship to his old brother in arms. In his in- dignation he deposed Moscoso from his post of master of the camp, and appointed in his place the bold Baltazar de Grallegos.* * Garcilaso de la Vega, Lib. iii. c. 36, 37. Portuguese Narrative, c. 20. Biedma in Recueil de Pieces sur la Floride, par H. Ternaux-Compans. 13* CHAPTER LXIL THE SPANIARDS REMOVE TO CHICACILLA OCCURRENCES THERE THE EXPLOIT OF JUAN DE GUZMAN THE INVENTION OF ONE OF THE SOLDIERS AS A PROTECTION AGAINST THE COLD. 1541. Three days after the battle, the Spaniards shifted their encamp- ment to a more advantageous position, about a league distant, which they called Chicacilla.* Here they set np a forge, and busied themselves in newly tempering their swords, injured by the fire, and in making saddles, and shields, and lances, to replace those which had been consumed. In this village they sojourned the remainder of the winter, suffering grievously from the extreme cold. They were in wretch- ed plight, having saved no clothing from the late battle, except what they chanced to have on their backs. When the savages learnt the extent of the havoc they had made, their fierce spirits were aroused anew, and they hovered every night round the camp, making repeated assaults, and sounding frequent alarms. The Spaniards, lest the Indians should fire the houses, as they had done those of Chicaza, remained all the night long without the village, arrayed in four different squadrons, with sentries posted. " :; " That is, a Little Chicaza. DESPERATE ENCOUNTER. 301 They were obliged to maintain a vigilant watch, for the savages burst upon them at all hours. In these nocturnal skirmishes, many were killed and wounded on both sides. Every morning De Soto dispatched four or five parties of horse, in different directions, to scour the country. They cut down every Indian they encountered, and always returned at sun- set, with the assurance that there was not an Indian breathing within four leagues. In four or five hours afterwards, however, hordes of Indians would attack them. It seemed almost incredi- ble that the savages could have assembled in so short a time. One night a band of Indians approached warily the place where Captain Juan de Gkiznian, with his company, were posted. De Gruzman, perceiving them by the light of the blazing fagots, sprang upon his horse, and, followed by five horsemen and a few foot, charged down upon them. De G-uzman, who was a cavalier of unflinching spirit, though of a delicate form, singled out an In- dian in the vanguard, who carried a banner, and made a lunge at him with his lance. The Indian, avoiding the blow, caught the lance with his right hand, wrested it from De Guzman, then seized him by the collar, and giving him a violent jerk, hurled him from the saddle to his feet ; all this while holding the banner in his left hand. The soldiers, witnessing the imminent danger of their leader, rushed in, cut the Indian to pieces, and put the whole band of savages to rout. The troopers dashed after them in hot pursuit. The ground favored the movements of the horse, and the Span- iards would have signally avenged their late disaster, had not their career been suddenly arrested by the cry of i: To the camp ! to the camp !" At this startling summons, they wheeled about and galloped back to the encampment, and thus the fugitives escaped. 302 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. The alarm was raised by one of the monks, who was fearful that the troopers, in their vengeful pursuit, might fall into some ambush of the enemy. Forty Indians fell in this affray. The Spaniards lost two of their steeds, and two were wounded. The army remained in this encampment until the end of March. Besides being unceasingly harassed by the enemy, they suffered bitterly from the cold, which was rigorous in the extreme ; especially to men who had to pass every night under arms, with scarce any clothing. In this extremity, however, they were relieved by the ingenui- ty of one of the common soldiers. He succeeded in making a matting, four fingers in thickness, of a long and soft kind of grass, or dried ivy, one half of which served as a mattress, and the other half was turned over as a blanket. He likewise made many others for his companions, who all assisted him in the manufac- ture. These rustic beds were brought every night to the main guard, and, with their aid, those who were on duty were enabled to en- dun; the severe oohl of the winter nights. The army also found abundant provisions of maize and dried fruits in the neighbor- hood.* * Garcilaso de la Vega, Lib. iii. o. 39. Portuguese Narrative, c. 21. CHAPTER LXIII. JUAN DE ANASCO, AND A DETACHMENT OP HORSE AND FOOT, HAVE A BRUSH WITH THE NATIVES ; AND HOW HE WAS TAUNTED UY THEM STORMING OF THE FORTRESS OF ALIBAMO CHALLENGE OF AN INDIAN WARRIOR, AND HOW HE FARED IN CONSEQUENCE. 1541. On the first of April, the army broke up their encampment. They journeyed four leagues the first day. through a champaign country thickly studded with small hamlets, and halted in a plain beyond the territory of Ohicaza; vainly fancying that the In- dians, now that they had left their province, would no longer mo- lest them. A strong party of horse and foot, commanded by Juan de Anasco, which was foraging for provision:-, came in sight of an Indian fortress, garrisoned by a great body of savages, who Look- ed like devils rather than men. Their bodies were painted in stripes, white, black, and red. as if clothed with fantastic garments. Their faces were blackened, and they had red circles round their eyes, which gave them a ferocious aspect : while some wore feath- er-; upon their heads, and others horns. On seeing the .Spaniards they sallied forth, shouting and yelling, and beating wooden dm De Anaseo retreated to an open field within a cross-bow shot 304 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. of the fortress, and drew up his cross-bow men with their buck- lers before the horses, to protect them. In this way he received the light skirmishing assaults of the Indians. The latter, seeing the inferiority of the Spaniards, taunted them from a distance, by a singular piece of mummery. Having kindled a great fire in front of their fort, they pretended to knock one of their compan- ions on the head with a club, and then swung him by the feet and shoulders, as if they would throw him into the flames: thereby giving the Spaniards to understand the treatment they were to expect. Juan de Anasco was of too irritable a temperament to bear such taunts patiently, but felt the insufficiency of his force to attack the fortress. He dispatched, therefore, three troopers to the governor, to entreat assistance. Leaving one third of the infantry and cavalry to guard the camp, De Soto immediately marched out with the remainder, to the assault of the fort, which was called Alibamo.* This fortress was built in the form of a quadrangle, of strong palisades. The four sides were each four hundred paces in length. Within, the fort was traversed from side to side by two other palisades, dividing it into separate parts. In the outer wall were three portals, so low and narrow that a man could not enter them mounted on horse. Passing through these, appeared the other wall, with three entrances, and behind that a third ; so that if the outer wall were gained, the garrison could retreat to the second, and so on. In the last wall were three portals, opening upon a narrow and deep river, that flowed in the rear of the fort.f So high were * We give the name according to the Inca. Biedma calls it Alibanio, and the Portuguese narrator Alimamu. Mr. Meek says, this is no doubt the original of the word Alabama, — which signifies, in the Muscoghee tongue, ' Here we rest! f Supposed to be the Yazoo river, in the county of Tallahatchie. In the ATTACK OF INDIAN FORTS. 305 the banks of this stream, that it was exceedingly difficult to clam- ber up them on foot, and they were inaccessible for horse. A few rude and dilapidated bridges were thrown across the river, afford- ing a difficult passage. The Indians had constructed their fort in this manner, that the Spaniards might not avail themselves of their horses, but be obliged to battle with them foot to foot, when they fancied they were not only equal but even superior to their enemies. De Soto, having carefully reconnoitred the fortress, ordered a hundred of the best armed horsemen to dismount, and, forming three squadrons, advance, three abreast, and commence the attack; whilst the foot, who were less completely cased in defensive ar- mor, should support their rear ; and, together, they should strive to seize the three entrances. The slight formed but brave Juan de Guzman led on one of the squadrons ; Alonso Homo de Car- denosa, another; and the stout G-onzalo Silvestre, the third. The Indians, who had until this moment remained shut up in their fortress, perceiving the preparations of the Spaniards for valuable work of Squier and Davis, published by the Smithsonian In- stitute, there is a description, furnished by the Rev. R. Morris, of some works in this region, which he is disposed to ascribe to De Soto, but which are probably the remains of this or a similar fortification thrown up by the natives, and so frequently noticed in every account of De Soto's expedition. It is very judiciously observed by these gentlemen, that " had Hernando de Soto erected one tenth of the works which have been ascribed to him, in the States bordering the Gulf, in Tennessee, and even in Kentucky, he must have found ample demands on his time and exertions. It is most likely, however, that the intervals between his tedious and toilsome marches were occupied more profitably, if not less laboriously, than in the erection of vast earth structures of this description, which, when finished, could not possibly have served him any useful purpose. His handful of weary followers probably found in a small stockade of logs a better defence, and one more obviously within then capabilities of construction." 306 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. the assault, sallied out to battle, a hundred men from each portal. At the first discharge, Diego de Castro, Luis Bravo, and Francis- co de Figueroa, were brought to the ground, mortally wounded. All three were pierced in the thigh, with arrows barbed with flint ; for the savages, having gained some experience during their war- fare with the Spaniards, always aimed at the thigh, which was never guarded. The Spaniards, seeing their companions fall, shouted to one another to rush in, and leave the Indians no time to gall them with their arrows. They charged furiously, and drove the enemy before them, to the very portals of the fortress. "While Juan de Anasco and Andres de Yasconcelos attacked the savages on the flank, De Soto, with twenty horse, charged upon the other. As the governor was spurring onward, an arrow struck him upon his casque with such force that it rebounded a pike's length in the air, and De Soto confessed afterwards that it made his eyes flash fire. Pressed by the united shock of horse and foot, the Indians made for the entrances of the fort, but these were so narrow that a great number were slaughtered with- out the walls. The Spaniards rushed in, pell-mell, with them. The carnage within the fortress was dreadful. The Indians were crowded together, and the Spaniards, remembering the in- juries they had received from them during the past winter, gave loose to their rage, and massacred them without mercy. As they wore no defensive, armor, they were easily dispatched. Many, trusting to their agility, leaped the wall into the plains, and, fall- ing into the hands of the soldiers, were instantly slain. Many escaped, by the portals in the rear, to the bridges ; but in their haste to cross, several were jostled into the river, which flowed at a great distance beneath. Others, pressed by the enemy, threw themselves from the banks and swam across. In a short time. PROWESS OF SALINAS. 301 the fortress was abandoned and in the power of the Spaniards; while those Indians who reached the opposite bank placed them- selves in battle array. One of the savages who had escaped, desirous of showing his skill with the bow and arrow, separated himself from his compan- ions, and shouted to the Spaniards, giving them to understand, by signs and words, that he challenged any archer to come out and have a shot with him, to prove which man was the better marksman. Upon this, Juan de Salinas, a brave Austrian hidal- go, who with some companions had sheltered himself among trees from the arrows, stepped forth, and walking down to the bank of the river, took his stand opposite to the Indian. One of his com- panions called to him to wait until he should come to guard him with his shield ; but Salinas refused to take any advantage of his enemy. He placed an arrow in his cross-bow, while the Indian also selected one from his quiver, and both drew at the same mo- ment. The dart of Juan de Salinas took effect, and pierced the Indian's breast. He would have fallen, but was received in the arms of his companions, who bore him away, more dead than alive. The Indian's arrow pierced the Spaniard in the nape of the neck, and remained crossed in the wound. Salinas returned with it in this state to his comrades, well pleased with his success. The comrades of the fallen Indian allowed him to dejoart without molestation, as the challenge had been man to man. The Adelantado, deterrninetl to punish the impudence and daring of these Indians, called on the cavalry to follow him ; and, crossing the river by an easy ford above the fort, galloped out upon the plain ; then, charging upon the savages, he pursued them for more than a league, with great slaughter; and had 308 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. night not interposed, not one would have survived to tell the tale. As it was, the carnage was very great. When the Spaniards gave up the pursuit, they returned to their encampment, and halted there four days until the wounded were restored. Fifteen subsequently died. Of these were the three cavaliers who had fallen at the commencement of the battle. They were greatly lamented by their companions, for they were noble, young, and valiant ; not one of them had reached his twenty-fifth year.* * G-arcilaso de la Vega, Lib. iii. c. 35. Portuguese Narrative, c. 20. Biedma in Recueil de Pieces sur la Floride, par H. Ternaux-Compans. CHAPTER LXIV. THE SPANIARDS COME IN SIGHT OF THE MISSISSIPPI THE CACIQUE CHISCA HIS HOSTILE MOVEMENTS. 1541. After four days the Spaniards departed from the encampment of Alibamo, still marching towards the north, to avoid the sea. For seven days they traversed an uninhabited country, full of forests and swamps, where they had sometimes to swim their horses.* At length they came in sight of a village, called Chisca. It was seated near a wide and rapid river, and as it was the largest they had discovered in Florida, they called it Rio Grande. This was the "Father of Waters," the mighty Mississippi.! De Soto was the first European who looked out upon the turbid waters of this magnificent river, and that event has more surely enrolled his name among those who will ever live in American history, than if he had discovered mines of gold and silver. The * Portuguese Relation, c. 22. f The Inca, on the authority of Juan Coles, one of the followers of De Soto, says, that the Indian name of the river was Chucagua. The Portu- guese narrator says, that in one place it was called Tumaliseu ; in another Tapata ; in another Mico ; and at that part where it enters into the sea, Ri. It is probable it had different names among the different Indian tribes. The village of Chisca is called Quizquiz, by the Portuguese narrator. 310 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. Indians of this province, owing to their unceasing warfare with the natives of Chicaza, and the country lying between them being unpeopled, knew nothing of the approach of the strangers. The moment the Spaniards descried the village, they rushed into it in a disorderly manner, took many prisoners, of both sexes and of all ages, and pillaged the houses. On a high artificial mound, on one side of the village, stood the dwelling of the cacique, which served as a fortress. The only ascent to it was by two ladders Many of the Indians took re- fuge there, whilst others fled to a dense wood, that arose between the village and the river. Chisca, the chieftain of the province, was very old, and lying ill in his bed. Hearing the tumult and shouts, however, he raised himself and went forth ; and as he beheld the sacking of his village and the capture of his vassals, he seized a tomahawk and began to descend in a furious rage, threatening vengeance and extermination to all who had dared to enter his domains without permission. With all these bravadoes the cacique, besides being infirm and exceedingly old, was pitiful in his dimensions ; the most miserable little Indian that the Spaniards had seen in all their marchings. He was animated, however, by the remembrance of the deeds and exploits of his youth, for he had been a doughty warrior, and ruled over a vast province. The women and attendants of the cacique surrounded him, and with tears and entreaties prevailed upon him not to descend ; a,t the same time, those who came up from the village informed him that the enemy were men such as they had never before be- held or heard of, and that they came upon strange animals of great size and wonderful agility. u If you desire to battle with them," said they, li to avenge this injury, it will be better to sum- INDIAN" COUNCIL. 311 mon together the warriors of the neighborhood and await a more fitting opportunity. In the mean time let us put on the semblance of friendship, and not, by any inconsiderate rashness, provoke our destruction." With these, and similar arguments, the women and attendants of the cacique prevented his sallying forth to battle. He continued, however, in great wrath, and when the governor sent him a message, offering peace, he returned an answer, refus- ing all amity, and breathing fiery vengeance. De Soto and his followers, wearied out with the harassing warfare of the past winter, were very desirous of peace. Having pillaged the village and offended the cacique, they were in some- thing of a dilemma ; accordingly, they sent him many gentle and most soothing messages. Added to their disinclination for war, they observed, that during the three hours they had halted in the village, nearly four thousand well armed warriors had rallied round the cacique, and they feared, that if such a multitude could assemble in such a short time, there must be large reinforcements in reserve. They perceived, moreover, that the situation of the village was very advantageous for the Indians, and very unfavor- able to them ; for the plains around were covered with trees and intersected by numerous streams, which would impede the move- ments of the cavalry. But more than all this, they had learned from sad experience, that these incessant conflicts did not in the least profit them : day after day man and horse were slain, and in the midst of a hostile country, and far from home or hope of succor, their number was gradually dwindling away. The Indians held a council to discuss the messages of the strangers. Many were for war ; they were enraged with the im- prisonment of their wives and children, and the pillage of their property ; to recover which, according to their fierce notions, the 312 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. only recourse was arms. Others, who had not lost any thing, yet desired hostilities, from a natural inclination for fighting. They wished to exhibit their valor and prowess, and to try what kind of men these were, who carried such strange arms. The more pacific savages, however, advised that the proffered peace should be accepted, as the surest means of recovering their wives and chil- dren and effects; they added, that the enemy might burn their villages and lay waste their fields, at a time when their grain was almost ripening, and thus add to their calamities. The valor of these strangers, said they, is sufficiently evident : for men who have passed through so many enemies, cannot be otherwise than brave. This latter counsel prevailed. The cacique, dissembling his anger, replied to the envoy, that since the Spaniards entreated for peace, he would grant it, and allow them to halt in the village, and give them food, on condition that they would immediately free his subjects and restore their effects ; not keeping a single article. He also stipulated that they should not mount to see him. If these terms were accepted, he said, he would be friend- ly ; if not, he defied them to the combat. The Spaniards readily agreed to these conditions ; the prison- ers and plunder were restored, and the Indians departed from the village, leaving food in the dwellings for the Spaniards, who so- journed here six days to tend the sick. On the last day, with the permission of the cacique, De Soto visited him, and thanked him for his friendship and hospitality, and on the subsequent day they resumed their march. CHAPTER LXV. THE SPANIARDS PREPARE TO CROSS THE MISSISSIPPI A CACIQUE, WITH A LARGE FLEET OF CANOES, COMES TO VISIT THE GOVER- NOR : THE RESULT OF THEIR INTERVIEW PASSAGE OF THE MIS- SISSIPPI ARRIVAL AMONG THE KASKASKIAS INDIANS. 1541. Departing from Chisca, the army travelled by slow journeys of three leagues a day, on account of the wounded and sick. They followed up the windings of the river until the fourth day, when they came to an opening in the thickets. Heretofore, they had been threading a vast and dense forest, bordering the stream, whose banks were so high on both sides, that they could neither descend nor clamber up them. De Soto found it necessary to halt in this plain twenty days, to build boats or piraguas to cross the river ; for on the opposite bank a great multitude of Indian warriors were assembled, well armed, and with a fleet of canoes to defend the passage. The morning after the governor had encamped, some of the natives visited him. Advancing, without speaking a word, and turning their faces to the east, they made a profound genuflection to the sun ; then facing to the west, they made the same obeisance to the moon, and concluded with a similar, but less humble rever- 314 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. ence to De Soto. They said that they came in the name of the cacique of the province, and in the name of all his subjects, to bid them welcome, and to offer their friendship and services ; and added, that they were desirous of seeing what kind of men these strangers were, as there was a tradition handed down from their ancestors, that a white people would come and conquer their coun- try.* The Adelantado said many kind things in reply, and dis- missed them, well pleased with their courteous reception. The cacique sent him repeated messages of kindness, but never visited the encampment; excusing himself on account of ill health. His subjects aided the Spaniards with much cheerful- ness ; while the Indians from the opposite side of the river har- assed them continually ; crossing over in their canoes, and launch- ing arrows at them, while at work. The archers and cross-bow men, however, as on a former occasion, concealed themselves in pits, until the enemy drew nigh, then suddenly rising and firing upon them, they scattered them with great slaughter. One day, while at work, they perceived a fleet of two hundred canoes, descending the river. They were filled with armed In- dians, painted after their wild fashion, adorned with feathers of every color, and carrying shields in their hands, made of the buf- falo hide, wherewith some sheltered the rowers, while others stood in the prow and poop of the canoe with their bows and arrows. The canoes of the cacique and chief warriors were decorated with fanciful awnings, under which they sat and gave their orders to those who rowed. " It was a pleasing sight," says the Portuguese narrator, " to behold these wild savages in their canoes, which were neatly made and of great size, and, with their awnings, color- ed feathers and waving standards, appeared like a fleet of galleys." * Portug-uese Narrative, c. 22. PASSAGE OF THE MISSISSIPPI. 315 They paddled to within a stone's throw of the shore, where the governor was standing, surrounded by his officers. The ca- cique addressed him, and professed that he came to offer his ser- vices and assure him of his obedience, as he had been informed that he was the most powerful prince of the whole earth. De Soto returned him thanks, and begged him to land, that they might converse more, conveniently. The cacique returned no an- swer, but sent three canoes on shore with presents of fruity and bread made of the pulp of a certain kind of plum.* The gover- nor again importuned the savage to land, but perceiving him to hesitate, and suspecting a treacherous and hostile intent, marshal- led his men in order of battle. Upon this, the Indians turned their prows and fled. The cross-bow men sent a flight of arrows after them, and killed five or six of their number. They retreat- ed in good order, covering the rowers with their shields. Several times after this, they landed to attack the soldiers, as was sup- posed, but the moment the Spaniards charged upon them, they fled to their canoes. At the end of twenty days, four piraguas were built and launched. About three hours before the dawn of day, De Soto ordered them to be manned, and four troopers of tried courage to go in each. The rowers pulled strongly, and when they were within a stone's throw of the shore, the troopers dashed into the water, and meeting with no opposition from the enemy, they easily effected a landing, and made themselves masters of the pass. Two hours before the sun went down, the whole army had passed over the Mississippi. * The Persimmon. Loaves are still made of this wild fruit among the Indians and settlers of the West. 14 316 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. The river in this place, says the Portuguese historian, was as half league from one shore to the other, so that a man standing still could scarce be discerned from the opposite shore. It was of great depth, of wonderful rapidity, and very muddy ; and was always filled with floating trees and timber, carried down by the force of the current.* Breaking up the boats as before, to preserve the nails, they proceeded onward four days, through a wilderness, intersected in many places by morasses which they were obliged to ford ; and, on the fifth day, from the summit of a high ridge, they descried a large village, containing about four hundred dwellings. It was seated on the banks of a river, the borders of which, as far as the eye could reach, were covered with luxuriant fields of maze, inter- spersed with groves of fruit trees. f The natives, who had al- ready received notice of their approach, thronged out in crowds to receive them, freely offering their houses and effects for their use. Two Indian chiefs arrived in a short time, with a train of war- riors, bearing a welcome from their cacique, and an offer of his services. The governor received them very courteously., and treated them with much kindness, so that they went away well pleased. The Spaniards finding abundance of food for man and horse, halted for six days in the village, which bore the name of Cas- quin or Casqui, as did the whole province and its cacique. ^ * Portuguese Narrative, c. 22. This place, where De Soto and his army crossed the Mississippi, was probably the lowest Chickasaw Bluff, one of the ancient crossing places, between the thirty-fourth and thirty-fifth parallel of latitude. f Probably the river St. Francis. X Supposed to be the same as the Kaskaskias Indians, who, at that time, peopled a province southwest of the Missouri. Vide Nuttall's Arkansas, p, 85, 250, 251. Charlevoix, Journal Historique, Vol. iii. let. 28. MEETING- WITH THE CACIQUE. 31? Resuming their journey, they marched through a populous and champaign country, where the land was more elevated and the soil less alluvial than any they had yet seen on the borders of the Mississippi. The fields were overflowingly fruitful ; the pecan nut, the red and gray plum, and mulberry trees, grew there in abundance.* In two days they came to the chief town, where the cacique resided. It was seated on the same side of the river, about seven leagues above, and in a very fertile and populous country. Here they were all received by the cacique, who made him a present of mantles,! skins, and fish ; and invited De Soto to lodge in his habitation. It stood on a high artificial hill one side of the village, and consisted of twelve or thirteen large houses for the accommodation of his numerous family of women and attendants. The governor declined the invitation, for fear of incommoding him. A part of the army quartered in the houses, the remainder lodged in bowers, which the Indians quick- ly built of green branches, in groves close by. It was now the month of May, and as the weather was becoming oppressively warm, the tenants of these rustic bowers found them truly de- lightful. * Portuguese Narrative, c. 23. Supposed to be the country of the Little Prairie and that chain of high land extending to New Madrid ; in the vicinity of which are to be seen many aboriginal remains. Vide Nuttall's Arkansas, p. 251. f These mantles were fabricated from coarse threads of the bark of trees and nettles. CHAPTER LXVI. A RELIGIOUS CEREMONY ON THE BANKS OF THE MISSISSIPPI. 1541. The army remained tranquil in this village during three days, with much good feeling on both sides. On the morning of the fourth the cacique, accompanied by all his principal subjects, came into the presence of De Soto, and making a profound obeis- ance, " Sefior," said he, " as you are superior to us in prowess, and surpass us in arms, we likewise believe that your God is better than our God ! These you behold before you, are the chief war- riors of my dominions. We supplicate you to pray to your God to send us rain, for our fields are parched for the want of water !"* De Soto replied, that although he and all his followers were but sinners, yet they would supplicate God, the father of mercies, to show mercy unto them. In the presence of the cacique, he then ordered his chief carpenter, Francisco the Genoese, to hew down the highest and largest pine tree in the vicinity, and con- struct of it a cross. * The Portuguese narrator says, that the cacique besought him to restore to sight two blind men he had brought with him, and Biedma that the Indian chief begged him to leave behind him a cross, by supplicating which he might obtain help in his numerous wars. RELIGIOUS PROCESSION". 319 They immediately felled one, of such immense size, that a hun- dred men could not raise it from the ground. They formed of it a perfect cross, and erected it on a high hill, on the banks of the river, which served the' Indians as a watchtower, overlooking every eminence in the vicinity. Every thing was prepared in two days, and the governor ordered that the next morning all should join in a solemn procession to it, except an armed squad- ron of horse and foot, who should be on the alert, to protect the army. The cacique walked beside the governor, and many of the savage warriors mingled among the Spaniards. Before them went a choir of priests and friars, chanting the litany, while the soldiers responded. The procession, in which were more than a thousand persons, both Spaniards and Indians, wound slowly and solemnly along, until it arrived before the cross, where all sank upon their knees. Two or three prayers were now offered up ; they then arose, and, two by two, approached the holy emblem, bent the knee before it, and worshipped and kissed it. # On the opposite shore of the river were collected fifteen or twenty thousand savages, of both sexes, and all ages, to witness this singular but imposing ceremony. With their arms extended, and their hands raised, they watched the movements of the Span- iards. Ever and anon they raised their eyes to heaven, and made signs with their faces and hands, as if asking of Grod to listen to the Christian prayer. Then would they raise a low and wailing cry, like people in excessive grief, echoed by the plaintive mur- murings of their children's voices. De Soto and his followers were moved to tenderness, to behold, in a strange and heathen * Biedma adds, that the Indians brought with them a ' quantity of reeds and walled the cross around. 320 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. land, a savage people, worshipping, with such deep humility and tears, the emblem of our redemption. Observing the same or- der, the procession returned ; the priests chanted forth Te Deum laicdamus, and with it closed the solemnities of the day. God, in his mercy, says the Spanish chronicler, willing to show these heathens, that he listeneth unto those who call upon him in truth, sent down, in the middle of the ensuing night, a plenteous rain, to the great joy of the Indians.* The cacique, with his warriors, astonished and overjoyed at this unhoped for blessing, formed a procession, in imitation of the Christians, and repaired to De Soto to express his gratitude for the kindness his God had shown them through his" intercession. The governor answered them, that they must give thanks to God who created the heavens and earth, and was the bestower of these and other far greater mercies. It is a reflection, replete with interest, that nearly three cen- turies ago, the cross, the type of our beautiful religion, was plant- ed on the banks of the Mississippi, and its silent forests were awakened by the Christian's hymn of gratitude and praise. The effect was vivid but transitory. The " voice cried in the wilder- ness," and reached and was answered by every heart, but it died away, and was forgotten, and was not to be heard again in that savage region, for many generations. It was as if a lightning gleam had broken for a moment upon a benighted world, startling it with sudden effulgence, only to leave it in tenfold gloom. The real dawning was yet afar off from the benighted valley of the Mississippi. * Las Casas, Lib. iy. c. 6. CHAPTER LXVIL EXPEDITION AGAINST THE CACIQUE CAPAHA HIS VILLAGE IS SACKED FORTIFIES HIMSELF IN AN ISLAND, WHERE HE IS AGAIN ASSAIL- ED THE SPANIARDS DESERTED BY THEIR. ALLIES, THE CASQUINS. 1541. As the army had been already quartered nine or ten days in this village, De Soto gave orders for them to prepare to march the following morning. The cacique, who was about fifty years of age, obtained permission of the governor to go with him, with a train of his warriors and domestics ; the one to escort the army, the other to carry his supplies, as they had to traverse a wilder- ness, and also to clear the road, gather wood for the encampment, and fodder for the horses. The true object of the cacique, how- ever, was to avail himself of the presence of the Spaniards to wreak vengeanee on a neighboring chieftain called Capaha. * A war had existed between the tribes for several generations ; but the present cacique of Capaha had gained the ascendency, and kept Casquin in continual awe and subjection, by the superiority of his forces. In the morning, the eaeique Casquin took the field, to escort the governor. He had three thousand Indians laden with sup- * In the Portuguese Narration, and in Biedma, the name of this cacique is spelt Pacaha, 322 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. plies, and with the baggage of the army, who were all armed with bows and arrows. But beside these, he had five thousand of his choicest warriors, well armed, fiercely painted, and decorated with their war plumes. With these he secretly meditated a signal ravage. With permission of the governor, he toot the lead, under pre- tence of clearing the road of any lurking foe, and preparing every- thing for the encampment of the Spaniards. He divided his men into squadrons, and marched, in good military array, a quarter of a league in advance. By night he posted sentinels in the same manner as the Spaniards. In this way they travelled for three days, at the end of which they came to a great swamp, miry on the borders, with a lake m the centre, too deep to be forded, and which formed a kind of gulf on the Mississippi, into which it emptied itself* Across this piece of water the Indians of Casquin constructed a rude bridge, of trunks of trees laid upon posts driven into the bottom of the lake, with a row of stakes above the bridge, for those who crossed to hold by. The horses were obliged to swim, and were got across with great difficulty, on account of the deep mire. This swamp separated the two hostile provinces of Casquin and Capaha. The Spaniards were nearly the whole day in crossing it, and encamped in beautiful meadows about half a league beyond. After travelling two days more, they came early on the third day to some elevated ridges, from whence they descried the principal town of Capaha, the frontier post and defence of the province, f It contained five hundred large houses, and was situated oq * Inca, Lib. iv. c. 7. Portuguese Relation, c. 23. f Tliis was the northernmost point reached hy De Soto on the Mississippi. FRESH REVERSES. 323 a high ground which commanded the surrounding country. It was nearly encircled by a deep moat, fifty paces in breadth ; and where the moat did not extend, was defended by a strong wall of timber and plaster, such as has already been described. The moat was filled with water by a canal, cut from the Mississippi, which was three leagues distant. The canal was deep, and suffi- ciently wide for two canoes to pass abreast, without touching each other's paddles. This canal and moat were filled with fish, so as to supply all the wants of the village and army, without any apparent diminution of their number. Capaha had received intelligence by his scouts of the formi- dable allies who accompanied his old antagonist, Casquin. His own warriors were dispersed, and not sufficient in number to resist such additional force. As soon, therefore, as he saw the enemy approaching, he sprang into a canoe in the moat, and pass- ing along the canal into the Grand River, took refuge in a strong island. Such of his people as had canoes followed him, others fled into the neighboring woods, while some lingered in the village. Casquin, marching, as usual, in the advance, arrived with his warriors at the village some time before the Spaniards. Meeting with no resistance, he entered it warily, suspecting some ambush. This gave time for many of the loiterers to escape. As soon as Casquin ascertained that the village lay at his mercy, he gave full vent to his hatred and vengeance. His war- riors scoured the place, killed and scalped all the men they met, to the number of a hundred and fifty ; sacked and plundered the houses, and made captives of many boys, women, and children. Among the captives were two of the numerous wives of Capaha ; they were young and beautiful, and had been prevented from 14* 324 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. embarking with the cacique, by the confusion and alarm occa- sioned by the approach of the enemy. The hostility of Casquin and his warriors was not confined to the living, but extended to the dead. They broke into the grand sepulchre or mausoleum, in the public square, which the Indians hold so sacred. Here were deposited the remains of the ances- tors of the cacique, and of the great men of his tribe, and here were treasured up the trophies gained over the people of Casquin in many a past battle. These trophies they tore clown from the walls, and stripped the sepulchre of all its ornaments and treas- ures. They then threw down the wooden coffins, in which were the remains of the dead, trampled upon the bodies, scattered about the bones, and wreaked upon them all kinds of insults and indignities, in revenge for past injuries, which the deceased had inflicted upon their tribe. At the entrance of the sepulchre were the heads of many of their warriors, who had been slain in former battles 7 and which were here stuck on the ends of pikes as warlike trophies. These they took down, and bore away with them, re- placing them with the heads of the enemies they had massacred. They would have completed their triumph by setting fire to the sepulchre and the whole village, but were restrained by a fear of offending the governor. All these outrages were perpetrated before the Spaniards had reached the place. De Soto was much concerned at this ravage of his allies. He immediately sent envoys to Capaha, to the island on which he had fortified himself, with proffers of friendship. They were indignantly rejected ; and the governor learnt that the cacique was summoning all his warriors, and breathing vengeance. Finding every effort to conciliate the chieftain fruitless, the governor determined to attack him in his stronghold. Casquin RETREAT OF THE SPANIARDS. 325 provided above seventy canoes for the purpose ; and an invasion of the island was made by two hundred Spaniards and three thousand Indians, The island was covered with a dense forest of trees and underwood, and the cacique had fortified himself strongly with barricades. The Spaniards effected a landing with great diffi- culty ; gained the first barrier by hard fighting, and pressed on 'to the second, within which the women and children were shel- tered. Here the warriors of Capaha fought with redoubled fury, and struck such dismay into the people of Casquin, that they abandoned their Spanish allies and fled to their canoes ; nay, they would have carried off the canoes of the Spaniards also, had there not been a couple of soldiers in each, to guard them. The Spaniards, thus deserted by their pusillanimous allies, and being overpowered by numbers, began to retreat in good order to their canoes. They would all, however, have been cut off, had not Capaha restrained the fury of his warriors, and suf- fered them to regain the shore and embark unmolested. This unexpected forbearance on the part of the savage chief- tain surprised the Adelantado. On the following day four prin- cipal warriors arrived on an embassy from Capaha. They came with great ceremony ; bowed to the sun, the moon,, and the gov- ernor ; but took no notice of Casquin, who was present, treating him with utter contempt and disdain. In the name of their cacique, they prayed oblivion of the past, and amity for the future, and declared that their chieftain was ready to come in person and do homage. The general received them with the utmost affability, assured them of his friendship, and sent them away well pleased with their reception. Casquin was vexed at this negotiation, and would fain have :;•;,-. 0OJTQUBST OF FLORIDA. prolonged tlu^ hostilities between tho Spaniards and his ancient enemies ; but tho governor was as miu'h charmed with tho frank noss and magnanimity of ono eaoh|iie, as ho had boon displeased with tho craft and cruelty of tho othor. He issued Orders, forbidding any ono (o injure tho natives of tho province or their possessions In order to appease the governor for tho dastardly Sight of his warriors, Oasquin niado him presents of tisli. together with mantles and skins of various kinds; and, moreover, brought him one of his daughters as a handmaid. IV Soto, howovor. was not thoroughly io bo reconciled Wc permitted the cacique to remain with him, and to retain about him a sufficient number of vassals tor his personal service, but obliged him to send homo all his warriors * * n GkuroUaso do La Yoga, l ib iv. o, 7. s. \\ IVrtuguese Narrative, o %4 CHAPTER LXVIII. INTERVIEW BETWEEN THE CACIQUE CAPAHA and DE SOTO. — ins two BEAUTIFUL WIVES, and THEIR PATE. 1541. On the following morning Capaha came to the governor, at the tillage, attended by a train of a hundred warriors, decorated with beautiful plumes, and with mantles of all kinds of skins. He was about twenty-six years old, of noble person and fine demean- or. On entering the village, his first can;, before waiting do the governor, was fco nsit the sepulchre of his ancestors. The indig nities that bad been offered to their remains are such as an [ndian feds most acutely. The cacique, however, concealed the grief .•Mid rage that burnt within bis bosom. Gathering up the scatter- ed hones in silence, he kissed them, and returned them reverently to the coffins ; and having arranged the sepulchre, as well as oir cumstances would permit, proceeded to the quarters of the ww- ernor. De Soto came forth to receive him, accompanied by Casquin. The cacique paid his bomage to tin; governor, offering himself as his vassal ; but he took no more notice of his old adversary, Cas- quin, than if lie had not been present. The governor embraced Capaha as a friend, and lie was honorably treated by -'ill the of fleers. The cacique answered to numerous questions concerning CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. his territories, with great clearness and intelligence. When the governor had ceased his interrogatories, and there was a pause, Capaha could no longer restrain his smothered indignation. Turning suddenly to his rival cacique, c: Doubtless, Casquin," said he, " you exult in having revenged your past defeats ; a thing you could never have hoped or effected through your own forces. You may thank these strangers for it. They will go, but we shall remain in our own country as we were before. Pray to the sun and moon to send us good weather, then !" The governor interposed, and endeavored to produce a thorough reconciliation between the caciques. In deference to him, Capaha repressed his wrath, and embraced his adversary ; but there were occasional glances between them that portended a future storm, and the proud Capaha was constantly on the alert on all points of ceremony and precedence, and made Casquin give way to his superior pretensions. The governor and the two caciques partook of a repast to- gether, after which the two young and beautiful wives of Capaha, who had been captured, were brought to be restored to him. He received them with many acknowledgments of the generosity thus shown towards him, and then offered them as presents to the governor. On De Soto's declining them, he begged him to accept them and give them to some of his officers or soldiers, or to whom he pleased, as they could not be admitted again into his household, nor remain in his territories. The governor, seeing that he con- temned them, and considered them as dishonored, was persuaded to receive them under his protection ; knowing the laws and cus- toms of these savages to be. cruel in the extreme, when the chas- tity of their wives was concerned.* * The Portuguese historian says, that these beautiful females were the ABUNDANCE OF FISH. 329 In the town of Capaha, the Spaniards found a great variety of skins of deer, panthers, bears, and wild cats. Of these they made garments, of which they stood in great need, many of them being nearly naked. They made moccasons of deer-skins, and used the bear-skins as cloaks. They found Indian bucklers formed of buffalo hides, which the troops took possession of. While quartered in the village, they were abundantly supplied with fish, taken from the adjacent moat, which formed a kind of wier, into which incredible numbers entered from the Mississippi. Among these was a kind called bagres, the head of which was one-third of its bulk, and about its fins and along its sides, it had bones as sharp as needles. Some of these caught in the Missis- sippi weighed from a hundred to a hundred and fifty pounds weight.* There was another fish, also, of a curious shape, hav- ing a snout a cubit in length, the upper lip like a spade or peel :f neither of these two species of fish had scales. The Indians likewise brought a fish occasionally, as large as a hog, which had several rows of teeth above and below. sisters of the cacique Capaha, and that he begged De Soto to accept them and marry them, as pledges of his affection. The one, he added, was called Macanoche, and the other Mochifa ; both handsome and well shaped ; espe dally the former, whose features were beautiful, her countenance pleasing, and her air majestic. We have followed the account of the Inca Garcilaso de la Vega. * The cat-fish. f This spade or palat-fish is at present so rare as scarcely to be met with ; but seems to have been peculiar to this region. — Vide Flint's Geo- graphy of the Mississippi, Vol. i. p. 128 and 129 ; Nuttall's Arkansas, p. 254. CHAPTER LXIX. TWO SOLDIERS DISPATCHED IN SEARCH OF SALT AND GOLD, AND THE ACCOUNT THEY BROUGHT BACK THE SPANIARDS ARRIVE AT QUI- GUATE JUAN GAYTAN REFUSES TO PERFORM HIS DUTY, AND WHAT DE SOTO DID THEREUPON. 1541. While in the territory of Capaha, the governor gathered intelli- gence from the Indians, that at about forty leagues distance, among certain ranges of hills, there was much salt and also much of a yellowish metal. As the army was suffering for the want of salt, and still retained their eagerness for gold, De Soto dispatched two trusty and intelligent men, named Hernando de Silvera and Pe- dro Moreno, accompanied by Indian guides, to visit this region. At the end of eleven days they returned, quite spent and half famished, having eaten nothing but green plums and green maize, which they found in some squalid wigwams ; six of their Indian companions were laden with rock-salt in natural crystals, and one with copper. The country through which they had passed was sterile and thinly peopled, and the Indians informed the governor that still further to the north, the country was almost uninhabited on account of the cold. The buffalo roamed there in such num- bers that the natives could not cultivate fields of maize ; they FRESH SYMPTOMS OF MUTINY. 331 subsisted, therefore, by the chase, and principally on the flesh of these wild animals.* Hearing this unfavorable account of the country, and that there was no gold in that direction, De Soto returned with his army to the village of Casquin, to strike from thence westward ; for hitherto, ever since leaving Mauvila, he had kept northward, to avoid the sea.f After sojourning five days in the village of Casquin, he proceeded four days down along the bank of the river, through a fertile and populous country, until he came to the pro- vince of Quiguate. where he was well received. Keeping down the river for five days longer, he came, on the fourth of August, to the chief village of the province, called by the same name. Here he took up his quarters during six days, in the house of the cacique. One night while lodged here, the governor was informed at midnight, that the treasurer, Juan Graytan, who was allotted to the patrol at four in the morning, refused to perforin his duty, giving his official station as an excuse, De Soto waxed wroth at this ; for this cavalier was one of those who had murmured at Mauvila, and had said that he would return to Spain or Mexico, as soon as they reached the ships. Leaving his bed, and sallying forth on the terrace before the house of the cacique, which overlooked the village, the governor raised his voice until it resounded through the place. " What is this, soldiers and captains?" cried he. "Do the mutineers still live, who, when in Mauvila, talked of returning to Spain or Mex- ico ? and do they now, with the excuse of being officers of the royal revenue, refuse to patrol the four hours that fall to their * Portuguese Relation, c. 24. f Garcilaso de la Vega, Lib. iv. c. 11. 332 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. share ? Why do yon desire to return to Spain 1 — have yon left any hereditary estates that yon wish to enjoy % Why do yon wish to go to Mexico ? — to prove the baseness and pusillanimity of your spirits ? That, having it in your power to become chieftains in a vast and noble country you had discovered, you preferred living dependents in a stranger's house, and guests at a stranger's table, rather than maintain house and table of your own ! What honor will this confer upon you 1 Shame — shame on you ! blush for your- selves, and recollect that, officers of the royal treasury or not, you must all serve your sovereign ! Presume not upon any rank you may possess ; for, be he who he may, I will take off the head of that man who refuses to do his duty. And, to undeceive you, know that whilst I live, no one shall leave this country until we have conquered and settled it. These words, uttered in a great rage, showed the cause of that moody melancholy which the governor had manifested ever since he left Mauvila. This outbreak had a visible effect upon the sol- diery. They saw that their general was not to be trifled with, and they thenceforth obeyed his orders without murmuring. CHAPTER LXX. THE SPANIARDS ARRIVE AT COLIGOA PASS THROUGH THE PROV- INCE OF PALISEMA, INTO THE COUNTRY OF THE TUNICAS THE MANNER IN WHICH THE NATIVES MADE SALT ENTER THE PROVINCE OF TULA ATTACK UPON AN INDIAN VILLAGE STRUGGLE BETWEEN A SOLDIER AND FIVE WOMEN. 1541. From Quiguate, De Soto shaped his course to the northwest, in search of a province called Coligoa, lying at the foot of mountains, beyond which he thought there might be a gold region. He was guided by a single Indian, who led the army for several days through dreary forests and frequent marshes, until they came to the village of Coligoa, on the margin of a small river. The natives, not being apprized of the coming of the Spaniards, threw themselves into the river on their approach, and fled. The troopers pursued them, and took a number of prisoners of both sexes. In a few days the cacique came to wait upon De Soto, bringing him a present of mantles, deer-skins, and hides of the bison or buffalo, and informed him that about six leagues to the northward, was a thinly peopled country, where vast herds of these wild buffalo ranged ;* but that to the southward, there was a populous and plentiful province, called Cayas. * This province is supposed to have been situated towards the sources of the St. Francis, or the hills of White River. — Vide Nuttall's Arkansas, p. 256. 334 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. The cacique of Coligoa furnishing the Spaniards with a guide, they resumed their march, striking towards the south, and after a journey of five days, entered the province of Palisema. The cacique had fled, but had left his dwelling furnished and arranged in order for De Soto. The walls were hung with deer-skins, so admirably dyed and dressed, that they appeared to the eye like beautiful tapestry. The floor was likewise covered with similar fine skins.* They made but a short halt in this province, as the supply of maize was scanty, and, pushing onward rapidly, in four days crossed the frontiers of the province of Cayas, and encamped on the banks of a river near a village called Tanico.f The waters of this river, and of an adjacent lake, were impregnated with salt ; so much so, as to leave a deposit in the blue sand which bordered their shores. The Indians were accustomed to collect this sand in baskets, wide above and nar- row below, which were suspended in the air on a pole. Water was then poured upon the sand, and draining through it, fell into a vessel beneath, carrying with it the saline particles. The water was then evaporated by boiling, so as to leave the crystal- lized salt in the bottom of the pot. This the Indians used as an article of traflic, exchanging it with their neighbors for skins and mantles. The Spaniards were overjoyed at finding an article of which they were so much in need ; they remained eight days making salt, and several who had suffered excessively for the want of it, indulged in it so immoderately as to bring on maladies, and in some instances death. * Portuguese Relation, c. 25. f Supposed to have belonged to the tribe of the Tunicas. — Vide NuttalTs Arkansas, p. 257. INDIAN AMAZONS. 335 Having laid in a large supply of salt, they pursued their journey, and arriving at the province of Tula, marched four days through a wilderness, when they halted about midday in a beau- tiful plain, within half a league of the principal village. In the afternoon, the governor set out with a strong party of horse and foot, to reconnoitre the village. It was seated in a plain betwixt two streams. On their approach, the inhabitants seized their arms and sallied bravely forth, the women rushing to combat as fiercely as the men. The Spaniards soon drove them back, and entered the village fighting. The savages fought from house top to house top, dis- daining to ask for quarter, and struggling desperately to the death. During the conflict, a soldier entered one of the houses and escaped to an upper chamber, which was used as a granary, where he found five women hid in one corner. He made signs to them not to be alarmed, as he did not wish to injure them : his caution was unnecessary, for they flew on him like so many mastiffs upon a bull. In his struggle to shake them off, he thrust his leg, unto the very thigh, through the slight floor of reeds, so that he remained seated on the floor, at the mercy of those furies, who, with biting and blows, were in a fair way of killing him. Notwithstanding the strait he was in, the sturdy soldier was ashamed to call for succor, because his antagonists were women. At this moment, another soldier happened to enter below, and seeing a naked leg dangling through the ceiling, at first thought it the limb of an Indian, and raised his sword to give it a sweeping blow, when, observing it more narrowly, and hearing the clamor over head, he suspected the truth of the matter, and calling two of his companions, they ascended to the rescue of 336 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. their comrade ; so fierce, however, was the fury of the women, that not one of them would quit her hold upon the soldier, until they were all slain. At a late hour the governor drew off his men from the village, and returned to the camp ; vexed at having been drawn into so unprofitable a battle, wherein so many of his followers were badly wounded.* * Portuguese Relation, c. 25, 26. Garcilaso de la Vega, Lib. iv. c. 12. CHAPTER LXXL WHAT THE SPANIARDS POUND IN THE VILLAGE OP TULA THE TRIBE OF TULA DIFFERED FROM ANY INDIANS THEY HAD SEEN THEY FALL SUDDENLY UPON THE ENCAMPMENT AT NIGHT THE PROWESS OF AN INDIAN, AND HIS FATE. 1541. On the following day, the army entered the village, and found it abandoned. In the after part of the day, bands of horse scoured the country in every direction. They met several of the natives, but it was impossible to bring them in alive, or obtain any infor- mation from them. They threw themselves upon the ground, crying " Kill me or leave me !" nor could the death of some con- quer the obstinacy of the rest. In this village, the Spaniards found the flesh of buffaloes and numerous skins of the same animal ; some in their raw state, others dressed for robes and blankets. They sought in vain, however, to meet with the buffalo alive, but still learnt that they existed in great herds to the northward. The natives of the pro- vince of Tula differed from all the Indians they had yet seen. The others were handsome and well-formed, but these, both men and women, were extremely ill-favored Their heads were in- credibly large, and narrow at the top ; a shape produced by being 888 CONQUEST OP KhoiMDA. compressed by bandages, from their birth until they were, nine or ben years of age. Their faces, particularly their lips, inside and out, were hideously tattooed , and their dispositions were in uni Hon witJi their dreadful aspects. On the fourth night that the Spaniards wen- in the tillage, the [ndians came in great numbers, and so silently, that before the sentinels perceived them, they burst upon the encampment in three different parts Loud wn<> the shouts, and great the con fusion; for, in the obscurity of the night, it was impossible to distinguish friends from foes. The Spaniards shouted the names of the Virgin and Santiago, to prevent their wounding one another. The savages, likewise, shouted the nameof Tula. Many of them, instead of I><»wh and arrows, had staves like pikes, two or three yards In length, which wore new to the soldiers, and with which they gave very severe Mows. Thus stubbornly they fought for more than an hour, and they did not retreat fco the woods until day began to dawn. The Span- iards <>i soldiers and i, wo on horseback were thus employed, when one of the former saw -'in [ndian raise Ins head from among the bushes and imme diately oonoeal it again. He gave theory of [ndians \ [ndians 1 The two men on horseback, thinking some of the enemy were coming in force, galloped oil' in different directions to meet them. In Mi.' mean rime, the foot soldier who had discovered the [ndian among the bushes, ran up to ivill him. PIERCE UNGLE <:oyii:at. 'I hi eeing he could not escape, stepped forth manful fy to the encounter, armed with a Spanish battle-axe, which be had gained that morning in fche tillage Taking if- in both hand i, he struck the shield of fche soldier, severed it in fcwo, and badly wounded his arm r n><- pain ot fche wound was so great and fche blow so riolent, that fche Spaniard bad not strength fco attacl his foe. The Indian then rushed upon fche other soldier who coming up, struct his shield id fche same manner, broke it in fcwain, wounded him likewise in fche arm, and disabled biin One of those on horse seeing his companions so roughly bandied, charged upon the [ndian, who took shelter under an o&k fcree The Spaniard, not being able fco ride undei fche fcree, drew near, and made several powerful fchrusts at fche [ndian, but could not reach fiim. The savage rushed out, brandished fche battle with both hands, struck fche horse acros fche shoulder, and laid it. open from fche withers fco the I o as fco deprive bim of fche power of moving At, this moment, Gonzalo Silvestre, who was on foot, came up He had been in no baste, deeming fcwo foot soldiers and three horsemen sufficient fco manage one [ndian The latter, elated by hi i luceees, advanced fco receive him with great boldness Grasp ing fche battle-axe in both hands, he gave ■> blow similar fco fche two first; but 8 e was more guarded fchan his companions The weapon glanced over fche shield and stuck in fche ground restre, having fche ' advantage, gave bim a diagonal blow with in.: sword, which laid open his face and breast- and en tering b nearly severed fche wrist. The infidel, seizing fche amp and bis other hand, with ade perate leap, made an attempt fco wound fche Spaniard in the faeej but Sil Id 340 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. tre, again warding off the blow with his shield, gave him a sweep- ing cut across the waist, that passed through his naked body, and he fell dead, cut completely asunder.* * The Inca says that the blow was so powerful, and the sword so keen, that the Indian remained for a few seconds standing on his feet, and saying to the Spaniard, " Peace be with you," (quedate en pas,) fell dead iu two halves ! The feat, as told in the text, is sufficiently strong for belief. CHAPTER LXXII. THE ARMY ARRIVES AT UTIANGUE THE GOVERNOR DETERMINES TO WINTER THERE PREPARATIONS ACCORDINGLY DEATH OF JUAN ORTIZ, THE INTERPRETER. 1541. The Spaniards sojourned in the village of Tula twenty days, curing the wounded. During this time, they made many incur- sions in different parts of the province. They found it very popu- lous ; but, although they captured many of the inhabitants, it was impossible, either by presents or menaces, to acquire their friend- ship, or to bring them into obedience. So extreme was the fero- city of this tribe, that they were the dread of all their neighbors, who used the name of Tula as an object of nursery terror to their unruly children. The army continued their march in quest of the province called Utiangue, or Autiamque ; about ten days' journey, or eighty leagues from Tula ; near which, the Indians said, there was a large lake, which the Spaniards hoped might prove an arm of the sea. Five days of their journey was over a rough, mountainous coun- try, closely wooded, where they found a village called Quipana ;* but could take none of the inhabitants, the forests impeding the speed of their horses. * Supposed to be in the country of the Kappaws, or Quapaws. 342 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. After a further march of a few days they entered the province of Utiangue. It was very fertile, with a scattered but warlike population. They were harassed incessantly by ambuscades and skirmishes, but kept steadfastly on, until they reached the village of Utiangue, from which the province took its name. It contain- ed numerous well built houses, and was situated in a fine plain, watered by a wide running river, the same that passed through the province of Cayas.* It was bordered by meadows that afford- ed excellent pasturage for the horses. The town was abandoned by its inhabitants, excepting a few lingerers whom they made prisoners. The houses were well stocked with maize, small beans, nuts, and plums. As the season was far advanced, De Soto determined to win- ter here. He encamped in the centre of the village, but apart from the houses, lest the Indians should set fire to them in the night. He then set to work to fortify the place. The ground that was to be inclosed was measured out, and a portion assigned to each, according to the number of slaves he owned. Thus every one had his task, and worked with emulation, the Indians bring- ing the wood ; and in three days the village was surrounded by strong palisades, driven deep into the ground, and fastened by thwart pieces. In addition to the ample supply of provisions found in the village, the Spaniards foraged the surrounding country, which was very fertile, and brought in abundance of maize, dried fruits, and various kinds of grain. They were extremely successful, also, in the chase ; killing great quantities of venison. The province, moreover, abounded, to an unusual degree, with rabbits, of which they found two species ; one of the usual size, the other as large * Supposed to be the Arkansas. SEVERE WINTER. 343 and strong as a hare, and much fatter. These the Indians were accustomed to snare with running nooses. The cacique of the province sent messengers from time to time, with presents, and promises of friendly service, but never made his appearance. His messengers, also, always came at night ; and, after delivering their message loitered about the camp, noticing the men, horses, and weapons, until it became evident they only came as spies. The governor, therefore, gave orders that no Indian messenger should be admitted at night ; and one, persisting to enter, was killed by a sentinel ; which put an end to all embassies of the kind. The Spaniards, however, were often waylaid and assaulted, when out on foraging or hunting parties, but gave good account of their assailants. The winter was severe, with great falls of snow. At one time the Spaniards were blocked up for upwards of a month, until at last firewood began to fail them. Upon this, De Soto turned out with all the horse, and, by riding backward and forward, made a track from the camp to a forest, about two bow-shots dis- tant. This enabled the men to go thither and cut fuel.* Upon the whole, though the weather was severe, yet, having good quarters, and fuel and food in abundance, the Spaniards passed the pleasantest winter they had experienced in the course of their expedition ; and enjoyed their present ease, and comfort, and abundance, with the greater zest, from the frightful hard- ships and disasters they had experienced. During their residence in this village, Juan Ortiz, the inter- preter, died. His death was a severe loss to the service ; as he had, throughout the expedition, served as the main organ of * Portuguese Narrative, e. 27. LX>NQ1 i m OF FLORIDA •.mnnieation between the Spaniards and the natiws I: is true, that, e\on with his assistaneo, those oommnnieations were , \ vmek imported, :uul snbjoot to m;r. 3 and misinter- pretations Juan Ot\ 9 MS ... .niainted merely with the lan- A the Indians in the neighborhood u S, in the niareh et* t' the\ were , ov.tinnalh pass .agh new pro\ nuvs. with &l -artioular tongue [t W*S ft, to ha\o an Inviian tYom aim. > qw w intevi . ,h rendered their mode et* eommnnieation ..w vw.-.vl in the o\trom. In tre.. ..e, the w raw to Juao Or! was :'rom month to month et' perha-. or ten Indians, of dirt'erent tr. as, u\l the person ; and the ropk was transmitted in the same te- ■d to the - *»"| >:ant plaeo, had. : SIMM manner > - ... •..-...'..■.>:•.....•...< in the Hea< e :ive>, ...... - a S . - *s to the s inhabitants, i bewildered them in Vtless led to r i the v..-.: iyos « ... U i a other . Ort ..-....'.-...- . - ten- - - - but the M He, aon >ut an imperuvt kr.. -^ .. . . . N - and M in tin - ; - varied \ . . nu Oh CHAPTEB I. Will. QHANGE i\ rur \ir\vs \\m \-\ \\s op or SOTO nr n i; \s ins STEPS TOWARDS rur MISSISSIPPI I SOLBIfiB DROWNED IN IT TEMPTING [O CROSS a i \ur rur SPANIARDS PASS rHROUOH rur PROVINOE OP ANILC0 HOSTILE BEARING or rur CACIQUE — aki;i\ \i vr OUAOHOl \ The feelings and views of Hernando De Soto had rooontij an dergone a ohange, The anger whioh bad induced him so sud denlj to alter his plans at Mauvila, ami (urn bis baols abruptly on the son, bad gradually subsided, His hopes of finding r i^oKitMi region were fast Riding away, He had lust nearly half of liis tioops i>\ fighting ami hx sickness, and bj hardships of \ari ous kinds , the greater part of his horses boo, had been slam or luul perished ; o( the residue, mam were lame, and all had been without shoes fur above a year, for want of iron, He was dailj more ami more sensible, also, of the Loss in 1 bad sustained in the death of Juan Ortii, The young [ndian of Gofaohiqui, who suo oeeded him as interpreter, made oontinual blunders its t>> the m counts of the country, the rivers, routes, and distanoes, and there was danger, through his misinformation, that the army might h% led into difficulties, ami become perplexed ami lost in the v;ist ami traokless wilderness thej had to traverse MO OONQ1 EST OF l-l GRID A .v'vlv now did De Soto repent his having abandoned his ,n:\l plan of joining his ships, and founding :> settlement in the lvn of kohusi n>' was too far from the set to attempt reaohing it now bj i direot march; but he resolved to give over ins wandering in the interior, and make the best of his waj to the Mississippi Here he would choose some suitable \ w on its banks Ebr a fortified post . establish himself there j build two brigantines, in which some of his m< frdential followers might descend the ^ earrj tidings of b \ to his * . and friends in Cuba, and procure reinforcements of men and horses, etlicv with docks, herds, seeds, and ever) tbing else necessary to i ' and secure the possession of f bo v.-ist and fertile ■mv\ he had overrun * As soon ;>s the spring was sufficient^ advanced theref De Bote broke ap his ? t at Ut out ins on for the Rio Grande 01 Mississippi He had d intelligenoe ol \ I) ge called \ '. •. situated on :v i n i • • M ad to? ards that village he shaped '•• \ tngue^he Lyas - village situated on the same river wbieh . d b^ C yas and I In this tim< struoted, in^ they all passed the rivei but were detai four days on its banks l\\ snoi and bad w journey* rs throu| i ■ .■ \ . ... ap bj ™- nd perplexed with swamps tt « ling \ s to 1 - ' S op* - i ■ PASSAGE OF THE K1YF.K Ml the stirrup, sometimes to the knees, in water, and now and then they were obliged to swim their horses At a town called Tultelpina. they were cheeked in their march by a lake, which emptied itself into a river. The waters were high and turbulent. De Soto ordered one of his captains to em bark in a oanoo with live men. and cross the lake. The impetuous Current overturned the frail bark : some men clung to it. others to the trees that were standing in the water; but one. Francisco Bastian, a Spaniard of rank, was unfortunately drowned. Pe Soto then sought to find a route along the borders of the lake, but in vain. At length, at the suggestion of two Indians of Tul- telpina, he caused light rafts palachee On the approach of the Spaniards, the inhabitants made some show o( resistance, and skirmished slightly ; but it was only to cover the retreat o\' their wives and children across the river, on rafts and canoes. Some few were taken before they could embark * Portuguese Relatione 28 15* 348 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. Many more were found in the village, who had not been able to escape. Soon after the governor had taken up his quarters in the vil- lage, an Indian of distinction, attended by a few others, came to him, in the name of the cacique, with a present of a mantle of martin skins and a string of large pearls. De Soto gave the prin- cipal Indian of the embassy a collar of mother of pearl, and some other trinkets, with which he went away apparently well satisfied. The negotiation, which opened thus favorably, ended in nothing ; and the ambassadors proved to have been mere spies, sent to observe the force of the strangers. The cacique could not be induced to enter into friendly intercourse, treating all messengers sent to him with great haughtiness, and giving various signs of determined hostility. The river that ran by the village of Anilco was the same that passed by Cayas and Utiangue ; and De Soto was informed, that at no great distance it emptied itself into the Mississippi.* Near to the confluence of the two streams, he was told, there was sit- uated on the banks of the Mississippi a large village, called Gruachoya, the capital of a populous and fruitful province of the same name, the cacique of which was continually at war with the chief of Anilco. De Soto determined to proceed to this province, in hopes that the sea might lie at no great distance from it. At any rate, the village of Gruachoya might prove an advantageous site for the building of his brigantines, and the cantonment of his troops. As soon, therefore, as canoes could be procured, and rafts con- structed, to cross the river opposite the village of Anilco, the army resumed its march, over a hilly, uninhabited country, and in four * The river is supposed to be the Arkansas. FLIGHT OF THE INDIAN'S. 349 days arrived at the village of Guachoya. It contained about three hundred houses, and was situated about a bow-shot from the Mis- sissippi, on two contiguous hills, with a small intervening plain, that served as a public square. The whole was fortified by pali- sades. The inhabitants had fled across the Mississippi in their canoes, taking with them most of their effects ; but Juan de Anasco foraged the neighborhood, and brought in a great supply of maize, beans, dried fruits, and cakes made of pressed plums, or persimmons. OH vrrn; i \\n 5 S ' \ \ S S I w v.- p v.: v \ • , , \ x c\i '■ \ ■ LT P - '• "jo i\({\\ IP- i nv .» hunvP. I 9*1 ami , : W & R$h ami d - hits into t :u»U ••.-.>; Pv-.u ovular ^witho-. ,^.- •nont amowg lh(ll,"l SlgllS .'I \ . ' II ," I 1 I 1 1 M 1 , '•.lllll,",l tllC >M.'l,pl«" Wll ll \. Ill, Ml'. |>lll .1'.,' ■ ,'i ( ll,' :..ll)l,' puip.ni M.l\ ill," '1111 •",," Willi \,M1 lll.l\ ill." .1111 shine up, mi you defend \>'u pi,'.p,-i you "»,l il>'' like , Oftoh .Ult" lllii'l,",! ill," pIll.l'V (ll;ll .Mill." til - - 1 ((> 111111,1, .111.1 I.M ;l .'.ll.Ml time there was n universal murmuring ol these compliments " rii." Spaniards wore -.in pi i:.,',i to observe .itui'ii." ill,'.,' iH.i.' '■l\.l",'. ill," :. .1111," kill, I >>l ,V1 ,MI1,M1I.|I:. wlll.-ll \\.l>' ll:. >'.l >M1 Jill:. simple occasion 1>\ the most polished natives ol Kuropo mid the gO\ >'l 11, M I 11 Ml 111.' (,' hi'. ,'lll, VI :.. :..ll,l. : .11 1 I 1 I 1 1 •" 1 \ . \ ,MI ...'," ill," \\ . > I 1 . 1 r >"\ .m\ whore < he sumo " The uHoioue ate at the governor's table His Indians remain r.l in :i( (,'11,1.111,,' .iu,l WOVlld U0t gO bO tlioil OWll i.'pi ; < Ulltll llO li.i.l finished .ill hough ropoatodh invited The} thou dined ii» tin' quarters, where u general repast whs provided The cacique lodged In n part of his owu dwelling with ft few ol hisown attend .nits , his warriors, at sunset crossing to the opposite ilde of ihc river and returning in fii* 1 morning This tho\ continued to do while <1k n Spaniards remained In the village One of ili<" first questions thai Do Soto had asked of the oa oiquo was, whethei he know mn thing ol the sen Uuaohoya, hov over, pi Hi. '•.'. rd utter ignorance «■! .ui\ such great bod\ < ( i watei , in., knowledge of the country down to the river^ did not extend beyond ••< great province called Quigualtanqul . tho cacique whore o\\ he said was the greatest ohioftain in all these parti The governor suspected his ignorance to be feigned, and ao oordingly dispatched Juan dc ^fiasco, with eight troopers, tc explore tho course of the river) and aioertain whether the sea was near I*- 1 /Vnasoo returned after eight days' ibsenoe, in all which ( ; ii , il i ... ,1,- l.i \ ,'...i, p i I ill i . ] OONQT 31 OF ;LPA. time, ho had not been able to ad e fifteen leagues, 011 ant of the . (rf the river, and the swamps and torrents with which it was bordered .* This information determined l\ 8 .-..• to build two bri. ttd to found his projected settlement I :hat •.d Anilco, in a fertile cour. - 3 . . . dement it was his intention to romaiu, until the . should return with re . - .ad supplier :o pursue these plans without mo', s imp Rw him to conciliate the friendship trf the cacique Anil- ad who would be enabled to render him mucd - ace, if an ally, and great anuovance, if an enemy. The cacique Guaohoy a, finding out something ol the gover inclinations d Ml him to return to the proviuce of Anilco, of - . .'ompany and aid him with his people. A> . .mid haw — . :hat ran by the viV. thiv :' into U . v . 5S sstppa, the eaoiqm s yply ,1 uumerous small . oes . -. . - uld - - along the M lSS 5S to the mouth of the v.- . V \ up which they would - the win .. -..nee be &wa Mean- time the governor and cacique, with their fov..< « .aid piw bv lane -. - posite the vi". ae with the cam . 8 Arrangements were made according'.) A> seou as th. we v. ir thousand Indian warriors embarked iu them, - with these, the . - a de •nan and his compauv, to have command ol the . A.TTAOK on AMI ,00. keep the Indians in order, Three days were allowed them for the voyage. At the same time that the oanoes departed, the governor set out by Land with his troops, accompanied b\ the oaoique, at the bead of two thousand warriors, beside those who earried provi sions The two expeditions arrived safely at the time appointed, opposite the village The oaoique oi' Aniloo was absent, but the inhabitants oi' the place made a stand at the pass oi' the river Nuflo Tobar toll furiously upon tluau with a part \ ofhorse Eager for the fight, tho\ oharged so heedlessly, that eaoh trooper found himself surrounded bj a baud of Indians. The poor savages, how ever, were so panic strioken, that thej turned their barks upon the village, and Bed in wild disorder to the forests, amid the shouts o( the pursuers, and tho shrieks and ories of the women and ohildren.* Quaohoya now gave full sway to his thirst for vengeance; for, in his whole allianoe with the Spaniards, and his advice to the general to revisit this provinoe, he had been aotu ated, like Gasquin, by a seoret desire to revenge himself upon an ancient enem j The provinoe of Anileo and that of Ghiaohoya were in continual hostility; but the former had, for some time, had the advantgo, and had brought oil' many I rephies gained in ambush, surprises, and midnight marauds; the mode in whioh the savages oarried on their warfare. On entering the oonquered village, the first thought oi' the warriors of Ghiaohoya, was t<> attaoh tho sepulchres of tin- oa oiques. Thej displaoed the heads of their oountrymen stuok up round the gate, replacing them with those oi' the eueut\ They stripped tin 1 Sepulchre oi' all tho trophies, of sealps, and banners, Portuguese Narrative, o, 29, 354 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. taken from the nation in battle ; carried off' all the relics and or- naments of the dead, threw down their coffins, and scattered about their bones, as had been done on a former occasion. Then, rang- ing through the village, they massacred all they met, being chiefly old men, women and children, inflicting the most horrible bar- barities. In all this they acted in such fury and haste, that the mis- chief was effected almost before De Soto was aware of it. He put an end to the carnage as speedily as possible ; reprimanded the cacique severely, forbade any one to set fire to a house, or in- jure an Indian, under pain of death, and hastened to leave the village ; taking care that the Indian allies should be the first to pass the river, and none remain behind to do mischief. His precautions were all ineffectual. He had scarce dis- embarked and marched a league, when, on looking back, he saw a great smoke arising from the village, and found that several of the houses were in flames. In fact, the warriors of Gruachoya, being deterred from open hostility, had secretly placed coals among the straw roofs of the houses. These, being parched with the summer heat, easily took fire, and sprang into a blaze. The governor would have returned to extinguish the flames, but at this instant he saw many Indians of the neighborhood run- ning towards the village ; so, leaving it to their care, he continued his march, deeply annoyed at having his friendly intentions to- wards Anilco thus defeated, but concealing his anger, lest he should likewise make an enemy of his crafty ally.* * Garcilaso de la Vega, P. i. Lib. v. c. 6. Herrera, Decad vii. Lib. vii. c. 3. CHAPTER LXXV. DIFFICULTIES WITH THE CACIQUE OF QUIGUALTANQUI ILLNESS AND DEATH OF DE SOTO. On taking up his quarters again in the village of Guachoya, the governor set to work, with his usual energy and perseverance, to construct the two brigantines. He ordered the necessary timber to be cut ; collected all the ropes and cordage that he could find in the village or the neighborhood, to serve for rigging ; employed the Indians to gather for him rosin and gums from pines and other trees ; and caused all the spikes and nails saved from the old piraguas, put in order, and an additional quantity made. He had already, in his own mind, selected from among his most faith- ful and trusty followers, the officers and men who were to embark in the expedition ; with the residue of his army, amounting to about five hundred men and fifty horses, he intended to await their return. While, therefore, he urged the building of the brig- antines, he cast his eyes about in search of some plentiful region, where he could be sure of subsistence for his army, during the absence of the envoys. Having heard much concerning the fertility of the great pro- vince already mentioned, named Quigualtanqui, which lay on the opposite side of the Mississippi, he sent a party of horse and foot to explore it. The river here was about a mile in width, seven- 356 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. teen fathoms deep, and very rapid ; having both shores thickly inhabited.* Collecting all the canoes of the village, and fasten- ing the larger ones two and two together, he caused the horses to be passed over in them, while the infantry crossed on the others. They scoured the province of Quigualtanqui, and visited many hamlets, and especially the principal one, immediately opposite to Gruachoya, containing five hundred houses. Every where, how- ever, the habitations were deserted ; the inhabitants having fled, or hid themselves. The scouting party, therefore, returned, with- out having effected any thing, but with glowing accounts of the fertility and evident populousness of the province. These favorable reports determined De Soto to cross the river with his troops, as soon as the brigantines should be dispatched, and to establish his head-quarters in the chief town of Quigual- tanqui ; there to pass the summer and winter that must intervene before the return of his envoys. To his infinite chagrin, however, a violent hostility was mani- fested on the part of the cacique Quigualtanqui. That chieftain, who was of a haughty character and of great power, was extremely tenacious of his territorial sway. He was incensed at the inroad of the Spanish scouting party, and sent messengers to De Soto, swearing by the sun and moon, to wage a war of extermination on him and his people, should any of them dare again to put foot within his boundaries.! At an earlier date a message of this kind would have been answered by De Soto by an inroad into the cacique's dominions ; but his spirits were gradually failing him. He had brooded over his past error, in abandoning the sea-coast, until he was sick at * Portuguese Relation, c. 29. | Alonzo de Carmona. — Garcilaso de la Vega.. P. i. Lib. v. c. 6. REPLY OF THE CACIQUE. 357 heart ; and as he saw the perils of his situation increasing, new and powerful enemies continually springing up around him, while his scanty force was daily diminishing, he became anxious for the preservation of the residue of his followers, and to avoid all further warfare. He sent an Indian messenger, therefore, to the chieftain, inviting him to friendship. He availed himself of an Indian superstition with respect to himself, and informed the chieftain that he was the son of the sun ; the luminary which the natives professed to worship. That, as such, he had received the homage of the caciques of all the provinces through which he had passed. He invited Quigualtanqui to come and pay him like reverence ; promising to take him into especial favor, and to reward him with inestimable gifts. In the mean time, the melancholy which had long preyed upon the spirits of De Soto, the incessant anxiety of mind and fatigue of body, added perhaps to the influence of climate, brought on a slow fever, which at length confined him to his bed. In the midst of his illness, he received a reply, by his own messenger, from Quigualtanqui. That haughty cacique observed that if what he pretended were true, and he was really the son of the sun, he might prove the fact, by drying up the great river ; in which case he should be ready to come over and pay him ho- mage. If he could not do so, he must know that Quigualtanqui, being the greatest chieftain in the land, visited nobody ; but re- ceived visits and tributes from all. If, therefore, he wished to see him, he must cross the river to his country. If he came as a friend, he should be received as such ; if as an enemy, he would find him and his men ready for battle, and resolved never to yield an inch of ground.* * Portuguese Relation, c. 29. 358 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. This taunting reply vexed the spirit of De Soto, and aug- mented his malady. It was still more irritated by the information that the cacique was endeavoring to form a league of all the neighboring chieftains against him ; and he dreaded that some new disasters might occur to delay if not defeat his plans. From his sick bed, however, he maintained his usual vigilance for the safety of his army. The sentinels were doubled, and a rigid watch maintained. Each night the cavalry mounted guard in the suburbs of the village, with bridle in hand, ready for action ; while two troopers were constantly upon the patrol, alternately visiting the outposts, and detachments of cross-bow men kept watch upon the river in canoes.* The schemes and labors and anxieties of De Soto, however, were rapidly drawing to a close ; day by day his malady increased upon him, and his fever rose to such a height, that he felt con- vinced his last hour was at hand. He prepared for death with the steadfastness of a soldier, and all accounts agree, with the piety of a devout Catholic. He made his will almost in cipher, for want of sufficient paper : then calling together the officers and soldiers of most note, he nominated, as his successor to the titles and commands of governor and captain general of the kingdom and provinces of Florida, Luis de Moscoso de Alvarado : the same, whom, in the province of Chicaza. he had deposed from the office of master of the camp ; and he charged them, on the part of the emperor, and in consideration of the qualities and virtues of Luis cle Moscoso, to obey him in the above capacities, until other orders should be received from government. To all this he required them to take an oath with due form and solemnity. * Portuguese Relation, c. 29. DEATH OF DE SOTO. 359 When this was done, the dying chieftain called to him, by two and two, and three and three, the most noble of his army, and after them he ordered that the soldiery should enter, twenty and twenty, and thirty and thirty, and of all of them he took his last farewell, with great tenderness on his own part, and many tears on theirs. He charged them to convert the natives to the Catholic faith, and to augment the power of the crown of Spain, being him- self cut off by death from the accomplishment of these great aims. He thanked them for the affection and fidelity which they had evinced, in fearlessly following his fortunes through such great trials, and expressed his deep regret that it was not in his power to show his gratitude, by rewards such as they merited. He begged the forgiveness of all whom he had offended, and finally, entreated them, in the most affectionate manner, to be peaceful and loving to one another. His fever raged violently, and continued to in- crease until the seventh day, when, having confessed his sins with much humility and contrition, he expired.* Thus died Hernando De Soto ; one of the boldest and the bravest of the many brave leaders who figured in the first dis- coveries, and distinguished themselves in the wild warfare of the Western World. How proud and promising had been the com- mencement of his career ! how humble and hapless its close ! Cut off in the very vigor and manhood of his days, for he was * " He died," said the Inca G-arcilaso de la Vega, in his Chronicle, " like a Catholic Christian, imploring mercy of the most Holy Trinity ; relying on. the protection of the blood of Jesus Christ our Lord, and the intercession of the Virgin, and of all the Celestial Court, and in the faith of the Roman Church. " With these words, repeating them many times, resigned his soul to God this magnanimous, and never-conquered cavalier, worthy of great dignities and titles, and deserving a better historian than a rude Indian." 380 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. but forty-two years old when he expired ; perishing in a strange and savage land, amid the din and tumult of a camp, and with merely a few rough soldiers to attend him ; for nearly all were engaged in the preparations making for their escape in this peril- ous situation. Hernando De Soto was well calculated to command the inde- pendent and chivalric spirits of which his army was composed ; for, while his ideas of military discipline were very strict, and he punished every breach of military duty, all other offences he easily pardoned. No one was more prompt to notice and reward all soldier-like merit. He is said to have been courteous and en- gaging in his manners, patient and persevering under difficulties, encouraging his followers by his quiet endurance of suffering. In his own person, he was valiant in the extreme, and of such vigor of arm, that wherever he passed in battle, he is said to have hewn himself a lane through the thickest of the enemy. Some of his biographers have accused him of cruelty towards the poor In- dians ; but, according to the Inca's account, we find him, in gen- eral, humane and merciful ; striving to conciliate the natives by presents and kind messages, and only resorting to violent means where the safety of himself and followers were at stake. A strik- ing contrast to his humanity, in this respect, will be presented in the conduct of his successor, Luis de Moscoso. CHAPTER LXXVJ. THE BURIAL OF DE SOTO THE CACIQUE SENDS TWO YOUNG INDIANS TO BE SACRIFICED TO HIS MANES WHAT LUIS DE MOSCOSO SAID IN REPLY DISPOSAL OF THE GOVERNOR'S EFFECTS. 1542. The death of the governor left his followers overwhelmed with grief: they felt as if made orphans by his; loss, for they looked up to him as a father : and they sorrowed the more, because they could not give him a proper sepulture, nor perform the solemn obsequies due to the remains of a captain and commander so much beloved and honored. They feared to bury him publicly, and with becoming cere- monials, lest the Indians should discover the place of his inter- ment, and should outrage and insult his remains, as they had done those of other Spaniards : tearing them from their graves, dismembering them, and hanging them piecemeal from the trees If they had shown such indignities to the bodies of the common soldiers, how much greater would they inflict upon that of their governor and commander ! Besides, De Soto had impressed them with a very exalted opinion of his prudence and valor ; and the Spaniards, therefore, dreaded, lest finding out the death of their leader, they might be induced to revolt, and fall upon their hand- ful of troops/ * Portuguese Relation, ft 80. 362 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. For these reasons, they buried him in the dead of night, with sentinels posted to keep the natives at a distance, that the sad ceremony might be safe from the observation of their spies. The place chosen for his sepulture, was one of many pits, broad and deep, in a plain, near to the village, from whence the Indians had taken earth for their buildings. Here he was interred, in silence and in secret, with many tears of the priests and cavaliers, who were present at his mournful obsequies. The better to deceive the Indians, and prevent their suspecting the place of his inter- ment, they gave out, on the following day, that the governor was recovering from his malady, and, mounting their horses, they as- sumed an appearance of rejoicing. That all traces of the grave might be lost, they caused mueh water to be sprinkled over it, and upon the surrounding plain, as if to prevent the dust being- raised by their horses. They then scoured the plain, and gallop- ed about the pits, and over the very grave of their commander ; but it was difficult, under this cover of pretended gayety, to con- ceal the real sadness of their hearts. With all these precautions, they soon found out that the In- dians suspected, not only the death of the governor, but the place where he lay buried ; for, in passing by the pits they would stop, look round attentively on all sides, talk with one another, and make sign with their chins and their eyes toward the spot where the body was interred. The Spaniards perceiving this, and feeling assured that the Indians would search the whole plain until they found the body, determined to disinter it, and place it where it would be secure from molestation. No place appeared better suited to the pur- pose than the Mississippi ; but first they wished to ascertain whether there was sufficient depth to hide the body effectually. BURIAL OF DE SOTO. 363 Accordingly, Juan de Anasco, and other officers, taking with them a mariner, embarked one evening in a canoe, under the pre- tence of fishing and amusing themselves ; and, sounding the river where it was a quarter of a league wide, they found, in the mid- channel, a depth of nineteen fathoms. Here, therefore, they* de- termined to deposit the body. As there was no stone in the neighborhood wherewith to sink it, they cut down an evergreen oak, and made an excavation in one side, of the size of a man. On the following night, with all the silence possible, they disinterred the body, and placed it in the trunk of the oak, nailing planks over the aperture. The rustic coffin was then conveyed to the centre of the river. The hooded priests and steel-clad cavaliers gathered round the remains of the chief who had led them through all their perilous wanderings, and at the still hour of midnight they committed the body to the stream, watching it sink to the bottom through scalding tears, and commending anew the soul of the good cavalier to Heaven, they sadly worked their way back to the shore. " The discoverer of the Mississippi slept beneath its waters. He had crossed a large part of the continent in search of gold, and found nothing so remarkable as his burial place."* The Indians, soon perceiving that the governor was not with the army, nor buried, as they had supposed, demanded of the Spaniards where he was. The general reply prepared for the oc- casion, was, that God had sent for him, to communicate to him great things, which he was commanded to perform, as soon as he should return to earth. With this answer, the Indians remained apparently content.f * Gl-arcilaso de la Vega, P. i. Lib. iv. c. 8. f Alonzo de Carmona and Juan Coles. Garcilaso de la Vega, P. i. Lib. v. c. 8. 16 364 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. The cacique, however, who believed him to be dead, sent two handsome young Indians to Moscoso, with the message, that it was the custom of his country, when any great prince died, to put to death some persons to attend him, and serve him on his journey to the land of spirits ; and for that purpose, these young men presented themselves. Luis dc Moscoso replied, that the gover- nor was not dead, but gone to heaven, and had chosen some of his Christian followers to attend him there ; he therefore prayed Gua- choya to receive again the two Indian youths, and to renounce so barbarous a custom for the future. He accordingly set the In- dians at liberty on the spot, and ordered them to return to their homes ; but one of them refused to go, saying that he would not serve a master who had condemned him to death without a cause, but would ever follow one who had saved his life.* De Soto's effects, consisting in all of two slaves, three horses, and seven hundred swine, were disposed of at public sale. The slaves and horses were sold for three thousand crowns each ; the money to be paid by the purchaser on the first discovery of any gold or silver mines, or as soon as he should be proprietor of a plantation in Florida. Should neither of these events come to pass, the buyer pledged himself to pay the money within a year. The swine were sold in like manner, at two hundred crowns apiece. Henceforth, the greater number of the soldiers possessed this desirable article of food, which they ate of on all days save Fridays, Saturdays, and the eves of festivals, which they rigidly observed, according to the customs of the Roman Catholics. This abstinence they were not able to practise before, as they were fre- quently without meat for two or three months together, and when they found any, were glad to devour it, without regard to days.f * Portuguese Relation, c. 80. f Ibid, CHAPTER LXXVII. THE SPANIARDS, UNDER THE COMMAND OP LUIS DE MOSCOSO, COM- MENCE THEIR MARCH TO THE WESTWARD ARRIVAL AT THE PROVINCE OP CHAGU-ATEj WHERE THEY FIND SALT. 1542. After their first grief for the loss of their illustrious commander, many in the army began to doubt whether it was really a calam- ity. Some even thought it matter of rejoicing ; for many of the officers and soldiers had long been disheartened and discontented by their toils and sufferings, and the disappointment of their ex- pectations of golden spoils. Nothing but their respect for De Soto, and the sway he maintained over them, had prevented their abandoning so disastrous a country. They were now in hopes that the new governor, who was devoutly inclined, would choose rather to seek rest and repose in some Christian land, than to follow out the schemes of De Soto. Luis de Moscoso immediately called a council, to deliberate; upon what was to be done ; and it was determined, by the com- mon consent of the leading men, to leave their present position as soon as possible. Moscoso requested eacK officer to hand in his written opinion, whether they should follow the course of the river, or strike across the country to the westward. 366 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. Juan de Anasco. the contador, was for carrying out the views and plans of De Soto. He not only opposed the idea of sudden- ly abandoning the country, but offered to guide the army in a brief space of time, to the frontiers of Mexico : for he piqued himself upon his knowledge of geography, and presumed by its aid to deliver his comrades out of all their difficulties. The proposition of Afiasco derived support from the recollec- tion of certain rumors which the Indians had brought, some months before, that not far to the westward, there were other Spaniards, who were going about conquering the country. These rumors, being brought to mind, were now adopted as truths ; and it was concluded that those Spaniards to the westward must have sallied forth from Mexico, to conquer new kingdoms ; and as, ac- cording to the account of the Indians, they could not be far dis- tant, it was determined to march with all speed in that direction, and join them in their career of conquest. On the fourth or fifth of June the army set out on its march, under the command of its new governor and captain-general, Luis de Moscoso ; directing its course westward, determining to turn neither to the right nor the left. By keeping in that di- rection, they supposed that they must arrive at the confines of Mexico : not perceiving that, according to their geography, they were in a much higher latitude than that of New Spain. A young Indian, sixteen or seventeen years of age, finely formed and handsome in countenance, followed the Spaniards of his own accord, when they left this province. The circumstance was mentioned to Luis de Moscoso, from a suspicion that he might prove to be a spy. The general ordered the stripling to be brought before him, and, through his interpreters, demanded the cause of his leaving his parents, his relations and friends, to CUSTOM OF BURYING ALIVE. 367 follow a people whom lie did not know? " Senior," replied he, a I am poor, and an orphan ; my parents died when I was very young, and left me destitute. An Indian chief of my native village, a near relative of the cacique, took compassion on me, led me to his home, and brought me up among his children. When you left the village, he was grievously sick, and his life was des- paired of. His wife and children determined that, in case he should die, I should he buried with him alive ; because, they said, that my master had cherished an dtenderly loved me, and that I must therefore go along with him to serve him in the world whither he had gone. Now, although I am deeply grateful to him for having sheltered and fostered me, and love his memory, yet I have no desire to share his grave. Seeing no other way to escape this death, but by going with the strangers, I preferred being their slave to being buried alive. This, and this alone, is the cause of my coming."* The Spaniards perceived, by this and the instance already mentioned, that the superstitious custom of burying alive the wives and servants with the dead body of the master, was ob- served in this country, as in all the other regions yet discovered in the new world. After leaving Guachoya, the Spaniards passed through the province of Catalte ; then across a desert country, to another province called Chaguate, where they arrived on the twentieth of June. The cacique had already visited the Spaniards, during the lifetime of De Soto, when quartered at Utiangue, and now resumed a friendly intercourse. Near the chief village of this province they found the Indians busily employed in making salt, at a saline spring like a fountain-head. Here the troops re- * Garcilaso de la Vega, Lib. v. Part ii. c. 2. 368 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. mained six days, supplying themselves with this necessary article. They then continued their march westward, in quest of the prov- ince of Aguacay, which they were told lay at the distance of three days' journey. CHAPTER LXXVIII. DISAPPEARANCE OF DIEGO DE GUZMAN CAUSE OF HIS DESERTION. 1542. On the second day of their march, the governor was informed that one of their number, named Diego de Guzman, was missing. He immediately ordered a halt, and entered into a diligent inves- tigation of the matter ; apprehending that G-uzman might have been been detained or murdered by the Indians. This Diego de G-uzman was one of the many young Spanish cavaliers, who had joined this expedition with romantic notions of conquest, and glory, and golden gain. He was of a good family, and rich, and enlisted in the enterprise in brilliant style ; with costly raiment, splendid armor and weapons, and three fine horses. Unluckily, he was passionately fond of play, and had but too fre- quent opportunities of indulging in it ; for the Spaniards passed much of their leisure time in their encampments in gambling, as is usual with soldiery, and especially with young hap-hazard adven- turers, such as formed a great part of this band of discoverers. In the conflagration of Mauvila, all their cards were burned ; but they made others of parchment, painted with admirable skill ; and, as they could not make a sufficient supply for the number of gamesters, the packs went the rounds, and were lent from one to 370 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA, the other for limited times. With these they gambled under the trees, in their wigwams, or on the river banks; or wherever they might have any idle hours to while away, Diego de Guzman was one of the keenest ; but a run of ill-luck had gradually stripped him of all that he had brought to the army, or captured on the march ; and but four days before the march, he had lost his clothes, his arms, a horse, and a female cap- tive, recently taken in the course of a foray. De Guzman had honorably paid all his losses, until it came to his captive, but here there was a struggle between pride and affection The girl was but eighteen years of age, and extremely beautiful ; so that he -r had conceived a passion for her. He had put off the winner, therefore, with the assurance that he would give her up to him in the course of four or five days. De Guzman had been seen in the camp the day before the march : he was now missing, and the girl had disappeared likewise. On hearing all these circumstances^ the governor concluded that, ashamed of having lost his arms and steed, and unwilling to give up his Indian beauty, he had escaped with her to her people. He was confirmed in this suspicion, on hearing that the female was the daughter of the cacique of Cha- guate. The general now summoned before him four chiefs of the province, who were among his escort, and ordered them to cause the Spaniard who had deserted to be sought out and brought to the camp; telling them, that unless he was produced, he should conclude that he had been treacherously murdered, and should revenge his death. The chiefs, terrified for their own safety, sent messengers in all speed. They returned with the account that De Guzman was with the cacique, who was feasting him and treating him with all ABSENCE OF DE GUZMAK 371 possible kindness and distinction, and that he could not be pre- vailed upon to return to the army. The governor refused all credit to this story, and persisted in his surmises that De Guzman had been murdered. Upon this, one of the chiefs turned to the governor with a proud and lofty air. " We are not men," said he, " who would tell you falsehoods. If you doubt the truth of what the messengers have said, send one of us four to bring you some testimonial of the fact ; and if he bring not back the Spaniard, or some satisfactory proof that he is alive and well, the three of us that remain in your hands will answer for his loss with our lives." The proposition pleased the governor and his officers ; and, after consultation, Baltazar de Gallegos, who was a friend and townsman of De Guzman, was instructed to write to him, con- demning the step he had taken, and exhorting him to return and perform his duty as became a cavalier ; assuring him that his horse and arms should be restored to him, and others given to him in case of need. An accompanying message was sent to the cacique, threatening him with fire and sword unless he delivered up the fugitive. The following day the messenger returned, bringing back the letter of Gallegos, with the name of De Guzman written upon it in charcoal ; a proof that he was alive. He sent not a word, how- ever, in reply to the contents of the letter ; and the messenger said that he had no intention nor wish to rejoin the army. The cacique, on his own part, sent word, assuring the governor that he had used no force to detain Diego de Guzman in his ter- ritories, nor should he use any to compel him to depart ; but rather, as a son-in-law who had restored to him a beloved daughter, he would treat him with all possible honor and kindness, and 16* S12 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. would do the same to any of the strangers who chose to remain with him. If, for having done his duty in this matter, the gover- nor thought proper to lay waste his lands and destroy his people, he had the power in his hands, and could do as he pleased.* The governor, seeing that Diego de Guzman would not return, and feeling that the cacique was justifiable in not delivering him up, abandoned all further attempt to recover him, and set the Indian chiefs at liberty, who continued, however, to atend him until he reached the frontier. * Garcilaso de la Vega, P. i. Lib. v. c. 2. CHAPTER LXXIX. THE ARMY ARRIVES AT NAGUATEX A SEVERE BRUSH WITH THE NATIVES IMMINENT PERIL OP TWO TROOPERS AND FOUR FOOT- SOLDIERS SEVERE TREATMENT OF THE INDIAN CAPTIVES IN- TERVIEW BETWEEN THE CACIQUE NAGUATEX AND MOSCOSO THE SPANIARDS PERPLEXED BY A PHENOMENON. 1542. The next province traversed by the Spaniards was named Agua- cay, and abounded with salt ; they encamped one evening on the borders of a lake, the waters of which were strongly impregnated with it. The Indians formed the salt into small cakes, by means of earthen moulds, and used it as an article of traffic. At the chief village of the province, the Spaniards fancied, from the re- plies of the inhabitants to their questions, that they had some knowledge of the South Sea ; but it is probable they were de- ceived by the blunders of their interpreters. After leaving Aguacay, they crossed the province of Maye, and on the twentieth of July encamped beside a pleasant wood, on the confines of the province of Naguatex. They had scarce come to a halt, when a body of Indians were observed hovering at a distance. A party of horse immediately sallied forth, and dashing into the midst of them, killed six, and brought two prisoners to the camp. They confessed that they were a scout- ing party, sent by the cacique to reconnoitre the strangers, and 376 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. The Spaniards, perplexed at this phenomenon, and little ac- quainted with the great extent of these rivers, and the sudden effects of rain among the distant mountains and extensive prairies where they take their rise, surmised that the swellings, during the waxing of the moon, might be caused by the influx of the sea into the river, although none of the Indians had any knowledge of the sea. At the end of eight days the river had subsided sufficiently to be fordable ; the army then crossed ; but, on coming to the town of the cacique, found it abandoned. The governor en- camped in the open fields, and sent for the cacique to come to him and furnish him with a guide. Naguatex, however, was afraid to venture to the camp. Upon this the ire of Moscoso was again kindled, and he sent out two captains with troops of horse, to burn down the villages and make captives of the inhabitants. The country was soon wrapped in smoke and flame, and several Indians were captured. The cacique was again brought to terms, and sent several of his principal people as hos- tages, and three guides who understood the language of the countries the Spaniards were to march through. The governor was once more pacified, and set forward on his western march. Such were the rough circumstances that attended the sojourn of the Spaniards in the province of Naguatex.* * The name of this province is spelled in the same manner (Naguatex) both in the Spanish and Portuguese narrations. It has been identified with Nachitoches, by some modern writers, who suppose the village of the cacique to have stood on the site of the present town of that name. It appears to the author, however, that the modern Nachitoches lies to the south of the route of Moscoso, though it may have been called after the old Indian village, situated more to the northward. It is almost impossible to identify any of the places visited by the Spaniards in their wild wanderings west of the Mississippi. CHAPTER LXXX. VAGUE TIDINGS OF EUROPEANS TO THE WEST WANDERING IN A WILDERNESS TREACHERY OF AN OLD INDIAN GUIDE, AND HIS FATE THE HUNTING GROUNDS OF THE FAR WEST. 1542. The army now pressed forward, by forced marches, more than a hundred leagues, through various provinces, more or less popu- lous and fertile ; but some of them extremely barren, and almost uninhabited. The Portuguese narrator of the expedition gives the names of some of these provinces, such as Missobone, La- cane, Mandacao, Socatino, and G-uasco. In one of the provinces, they observed wooden crosses placed on the tops of the houses, and were struck with the sight of this Christian emblem. They began to flatter themselves that they were approaching the con- fines of New Spain, and made incessant inquiries, in every pro- vince that they entered, whether the inhabitants knew any thing of Christian people to the west. Where all intelligence had to pass from mouth to mouth, through several interpreters, in- differently acquainted with each other's language, and finally to be communicated by an Indian lad, who was but moderately versed in Spanish, it is easy to perceive what vague and erroneous ideas must be imparted. Some of the natives, it is probable, wilfully deceived the Spaniards ; others misunderstood the kind 318 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. of people about whom they were inquiring. In this way they re- ceived tidings, as they thought, of Europeans that had been seen farther to the west ; and whom they persuaded themselves were parties of discoverers, making incursions from New Spain. They brightened up with the hopes of meeting with some narty of the kind, or, at any rate, coming to regions subjugated and colonized by their countrymen, where they would no longer be in danger of perishing in a trackless wilderness, but might choose either to abide securely in the new world, or return to their native country. Thus they went on, from place to place, lured by false hopes and idle tales. When they reached places where they had been assured they would come upon the traces of white men, the in- habitants declared their utter ignorance of any people of the kind. In the transports of vexation and disappointment, Mos- coso would order the poor savages to be put to the rack. This only served to extort from them false replies, suited to his wishes, but which led him and his army to farther unprofitable wandering and additional disappointment.* Moscoso and his followers, moreover, suffered extremely for the want of intelligent and faithful guides. Sometimes they erred from misinterpretation of the routes ; at other times, they were purposely led astray. When they had journeyed far to the west, they came to a vast uninhabited region, where they wandered for many days, until their provisions were exhausted, and they had nothing to appease their hunger but herbs and roots. To their great dismay, also, they found that an old Indian warrior, who had been furnished by a cacique as a guide, was leading them in a circle, heading from time to time to different points of the com- * Garcilaso de la Vega, Lib. v. P. i. c. 2. CRUEL REVENGE. 379 pass. Upon this, Moscoso, suspecting his fidelity, ordered him to be tied to a tree, and the dogs to be let loose upon him. One of them sprang upon him instantly, and began to shake him. The Indian, in his terror, confessed that he had been ordered by his cacique to bewilder and lose them in uninhabited deserts, but offered to take them, in three days, to a populous country to the west. Moscoso, however, listening only to his indignation at this treachery, again ordered the dogs to be let loose, who, ravenous with hunger, tore the unfortunate wretch to pieces. Having in this shocking manner gratified their passion, the Spaniards found themselves worse off than before, for they had no one to guide them, having given permission to the other Indians, who had brought the supplies, to return home. In this dilem- ma, they followed the directions of their victim, by marching directly westward ; thus giving credit, after his death, to what they disbelieved while he was living. They travelled three days, suffering excessively for want of food. Fortunately the forests were clear and open ; had they been so dense as those through which they had formerly passed, they would have perished with hunger before they could make their way through them. They journeyed always to the west- ward, and at the end of three days descried, from a rising ground, the signs of human habitations. The inhabitants, however, fled to the woods on their approach, and they found the country meagre and sterile. The villages differed from the past, the houses being scattered about the fields in groups of four and five, rudely con- structed, and resembling the hovels erected in melon fields in Spain to guard the fruit, rather than habitable houses. In these cabins they found abundance of fresh buffalo meat, with which they appeased their hunger. There were many buffalo hides, also, 380 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. recently flayed ; but the Spaniards could never meet with the living animals. From the abundant traces of horned cattle thus found in the habitations, they called this the Province of the Vaqueros, or Herdsmen.* * It is evident that the Spaniards were on the hunting grounds of the Far "West — the great buffalo prairies. It is probable that the scattered and slight wigwams thus visited, were mere hunting camps. CHAPTER LXXXL FEATS OF INDIVIDUAL PROWESS OF THE INDIANS OF THE FAR WEST. 1542. The Indians of the far west have always been noted for their gallant and martial bearing, and their proneness to feats of indi- vidual prowess and bravado. In their wanderings through this wild hunting region, the Spaniards had frequent instances of the kind, two or three of which are worthy of especial notice. In the course of their inarch through the province of Los Vaqueros, they encamped one afternoon in an open plain. The Spaniards stretched themselves on the ground to repose, while their Indian attendants prepared their repast. While thus reclining, they ob- served an Indian warrior sally out of an adjacent wood and ap- proach the camp. He was gayly painted, had a bow in his hand, a quiver of arrows over his right shoulder, and waving plumes upon his head. The Spaniards, seeing him advance alone, and peacefully, im- agined that he was charged with some message from his cacique to the governor, and allowed him to draw nigh. He came within fifty paces of a group of soldiers, who were conversing together ; then, suddenly fixing an arrow in his bow, he sent it in the midst of them. The Spaniards seeing him bend his bow, some sprang aside, 380 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. recently flayed ; but the Spaniards could never meet with the living animals. From the abundant traces of horned cattle thus found in the habitations, they called this the Province of the Vaqueros, or Herdsmen.* * It is evident that the Spaniards were on the hunting grounds of the Far West — the great buffalo prairies. It is probable that the scattered and slight wigwams thus visited, were mere hunting camps. CHAPTER LXXXI. FEATS OF INDIVIDUAL PROWESS OF THE INDIANS OF THE FAR WEST. 1542. The Indians of the far west have always been noted for their gallant and martial bearing, and their proneness to feats of indi- vidual prowess and bravado. In their wanderings through this wild hunting region, the Spaniards had frequent instances of the kind, two or three of which are worthy of especial notice. In the course of their march through the province of Los Vaqueros, they encamped one afternoon in an open plain. The Spaniards stretched themselves on the ground to repose, while their Indian attendants prepared their repast. While thus reclining, they ob- served an Indian warrior sally out of an adjacent wood and ap- proach the camp. He was gayly painted, had a bow in his hand, a quiver of arrows over his right shoulder, and waving plumes upon his head. The Spaniards, seeing him advance alone, and peacefully, im- agined that he was charged with some message from his cacique to the governor, and allowed him to draw nigh. He came within fifty paces of a group of soldiers, who were conversing together ; then, suddenly fixing an arrow in his bow, he sent it in the midst of them. The Spaniards seeing him bend his bow, some sprang aside, 8§a rONQUKST OF FLORIDA. others throw themselves upon the ground, The arrow whistled by without touching them, but flying beyond, whore live or six female [ndians were under a tree, preparing dinner for their masters, it struck one in the shoulders, and passing through her body, buried itself in the bosom of another j they both tell and expired. The savage then turned, and fled with surprising speed to the WOOds. The Spaniards beat the alarm and shouted after him. The captain. Halta/.ar de GtallegOS, being bv chance on horseback, hoard the shout, and saw the savage living; suspecting the cause, be gave ehaso, overtook him olose to the wood, and transfixed him with his laiuv. Three days after this, the army halted for a day to repose in a beautiful plain, oi' the same province. While thus indulging, thov saw. about ten in the morning, two Indian warriors approach- ing across the plain. They were tine looking fellows, decorated with lofty plumes, bearing their bows in their hands, and their quivers at their backs. Thov stalked to within two hundred paces o( the camp, and then began to walk round a large nut-tree, not side by side, but circling in opposite directions. SO as to pass each other, ami guard one another's backs. In this way they kept on all dav, without deigning to take any notice of the Negroes. Indians, women and bo\s, who occasional! v passed near them, bringing water and wood The Spaniards understood from this that thov came not for the domestics, but for them, and they forthwith reported to the governor what thov had observed lie ordered that no soldier should go out to them, but that they should be left alone as mad- men. The [ndians continued their circumvolutions about the tree, waiting patiently, it would seem, for some o\' the Spaniards to RESCUE OF PAEZ. 88* take up this singular challenge. H. was near sunset, when a company of horse, who had been out since morning scouring the country, returned. Their quarters were near the place where this extraordinary scene was acting, and observing it, they asked) "What Indians are these?" Having- learnt tin; order of the governor, that they should be unmolested as two madmen, it was obeyed by all except, a headlong soldier named Juan l\i,oz, who, eager to exhibit, his valor, exclaimed, " A. pest, upon them ; here's one madder than they, who will cure their madness !" So saying, he spurred towards them. When the Indians saw but a single Spaniard advancing to attack them, the one who was nearest to Paez stepped forth to receive him, and the other, separating, placed himself under a tree ; thus manifesting a wish to fight man to man, and disregarding the advantage that the Spaniard had in being mounted. The soldier spurred upon the Indian at full speed, to bear him down with the shock. His adversary waited, with an arrow in his bow, until he came within shot,, when he sped his shaft. It struck Juan Paez in the muscular part of the left arm, passed through it, and through both sides of a sleeve of mail, and remained crossed in the wound. The arm dropped powerless, the reins slipped from the hand, and the horse, feeling them fall, stopped of a sudden, as horses are often trained to do. The companions of Juan I'aoz, who had not, yet alighted, Seeing his peril, galloped to his rescue. The Indians, not choosing to encounter such odds, fied to a neighboring wood, but before they could reach if, were overtaken and lanced fco death. In this affair the savages certainly .showed a spirit of chivalry, and a punctilio as to the laws of fche duel, which merited a better return at the hands of Spanish cavaliers.* * GarcihiHo was1 ire them, infi od h\ barbarous people with whom it was impossible to keep ap a t'vuMuih understanding fax want of an interpreter it was al beginning of October j if the) Lingered much lonj :ui snows of winter would out off theii return, ami the) might perish with oold and hunger Moseoso was wearj in soul and body, wad Longed to be in a plaee where his sleep would m>t be broken bj continual alarms He eall< email, there ins offi< -i proposed that the) should give up aU further progress to the west, make the the m build vessels there, and deseend that mm- to the ;tl n. .- ' j i ■ ■ . ' ed bj ■ ■•■ a ? withstanding all thou- suffering ppointments, had still a Lingering b . ■ ■ . then Chej ■■ v - x \ i had told the emperor of his baring i eountrj woe pro Dhat thej had •■ ■ j a of w \ •. i ;e but might do • wrward Besides the) had setualty »•.-.. ktlou mantle! tor quois 1 had r. od from the DESPERATE MARCH. 387 natives that they came from a country to the irest; wliieli wuh doubtless the country that Alvar tfuiiet bad spoken of. They were, therefore, for persisting in their desperate march westward; nay, some of them declared they would rather perish in the wilderness, than return beggared and miserable to Europe, from an expedition undertaken with Bueij Jii;/li and vaunting antici pal, ions. Sager counsels, however, prevailed, and after much deliber ation it was determined to retrace their steps to the Mississippi. Note, — The march of :a<,<- oi the Mi i lippi ban been rendered from the Spani h and Portuguese account*; but they rary so much on some points, and are so vague en others, and the regions to which they relate arc ho v;i-i and, until rery recently, so little known, that it is next to impossible to trace the route oj t J j * - wanderers with any thing approaching : '- precision They evidently traversed the bunting grounds of the Par West, the range of the buffalo, and got upon the uppei prairies, which, in many parts, arc little better than deserts, The river Daeayo, which is only mentioned by the Poi tuguese narrator, has been supposed to be the 'Bio del Oro' of Oabeza de Vac-i. He makes them return from the banks of thi rivei ; but the Spanish historian affirms that they saw great chains of mountain! and forests to the ,<- t, which they understood were uninhabited. It has been conjectured that these were the skirts of the Rocky Mountains. As, according to the Portu- ■ account, they departed from the banks of the Mississippi ftw the Far west, '-I! the fifth of June, and did not get back there until the beginning of December, they were sis months on this march and countermarch, which, with all their baitings, would give them time to penetrate a great di itance into the interior, 17 CHAPTER LXXXIII. HARASSING MARCH OF THE SPANIARDS THE TROOPER — HIS MISAD- VENTURE. 1542. The Spaniards had now a long and dreary march before them, with no novelty ahead to cheer them on, and a country to traverse, the savage inhabitants of which had been rendered hostile by their previous invasion, and its resources laid waste by their foraging parties. They endeavored to remedy these disadvantages as much as possible by making a bend to the south, so as to avoid the des- olate tracts they had recently traversed, and to find regions more abundant in provisions. They journeyed by forced marches, and took every precaution not to provoke the Indians ; the latter, however, were on the alert, and harassed them at all hours of day and night. Sometimes they concealed themselves in woods, by which the Spaniards had to pass ; in the more open country they would lie upon the ground, covered by the tall grass and weeds, and as the soldiers, seeing no enemy, came carelessly along, the wily savages would suddenly spring up, discharge a shower of arrows, and immediately take to flight. These assaults were so many and frequent, that one band ASSAULTS ON THE SPANIARDS. 389 would scarcely bo repulsed from the vanguard, when another at- tacked the rear, and frequently the line of march was assailed, in three or four places at the same time, with great loss and injury both of men and horses. In fact, it was in this province of Los Vaqueros that the Spaniards, without coming hand to hand with the enemy, received more injury than in any other through which they passed. This was especially the case in the course of the last day's march, when their route was extremely rough, through woods, and across streams and ravines, and other dangerous passos, peculiarly fit for ambush and surprise. Here the savages, who were well acquainted with the ground, had them at their mercy, waylaying them at every step, wounding Spaniards, and horses, and the Indian servants who accompanied the army. The last of these assaults happened just before arriving at the place of encampment, as they crossed a brook overhung with trees and thickets. Just as one of the horsemen, named Sao jurgo, was in the middle of the brook, an arrow shot from among the bushes on the bank struck him in the rear, pierced his cuirass of mail, passed through the muscle of his right thigh, then through the saddle-tree and paddings, and buried itself in the horse. The woundod animal sprang out of the brook, sallied forth upon the plain, and went on plunging and kicking to get clear of the arrow and his rider. The comrades of Sanjurge hastened to his assistance. Find- ing him nailed, in a manner, to the saddle, and the army having halted to encamp hard by, they led him on horseback as he was to his allotted quarters. Lifting him gently from his seat, they cut off the shaft of the arrow between the saddle and the wound; after which, taking off the saddle, they found that the injury to the horse was but slight. Wliat surprised them, however, was 390 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. that the shaft, which had penetrated through so many substances, was a mere reed, with the end hardened in the fire. Such was the vigor of arm with which these Indian archers plied their bows. This Sanjurge had enjoyed a kind of charlatan reputation among the soldiers, for curing wounds with oil, wool, and certain words, which he called a charm. At the battle of Mauvila, how- ever, all the oil and wool had been burnt, and Sanjurge's miracu- lous cures were at an end. His whole surgical skill being confined to his nostrum and charm, he was now fain to call in the aid of the surgeon to extract the head of an arrow which was lodged in his knee. The operation was so painful, however, that he railed at the surgeon for a bungler, and swore he would rather die than come again under his hands, and the latter replied that he might die and welcome, before he would have any thing to do with him again. In his present wounded state, however, Sanjurge was in a sad dilemma, having no nostrums of his own, and being precluded from the assistance of the surgeon. At length he thought of a substitute for his old remedy, and, making use of hog's lard, instead of oil, and the shreds of an Indian mantle, instead of wool, he dressed his wound with them, and pronounced his vaunt- ed charm. Faith and a good constitution work miracles in quack- ery. In the course of four days that the army remained encamp- ed to attend to the sick, Sanjurge had so far recovered as to resume his saddle, galloping up and down in vaunting style among the soldiery, whose faith in his nostrum and his charm became stronger than ever.* * Garcilaso de la Vega, Part ii. Lib. v. c. 5. CHAPTER LXXXIV. FRANCISCO, THE GENOESE, WITH SEVERAL OP HIS COMRADES, LIE IN AMBUSH TO ENTRAP SOME OP THE NATIVES THE SEVERE SKIB.- MISH THEY HAVE WITH AN INDIAN, AND THE RESULT. 1542. After leaving the disastrous province of Los Vaqueros, the Spaniards continued for twenty days, "by forced marches, through other lands, of which they did not know the name, taking but lit- tle pains to gain information, their only object now being to get to the Mississippi. Although they avoided all pitched battles with the natives, they continued to be harassed by them incessantly. Did a soldier chance to wander a short distance from his comrades, he was in- stantly shot down. In this manner no less than forty Spaniards were picked off by lurking foes. By night the Indians would enter the camp on all fours, or drawing themselves along like snakes, without being heard, and thus shoot down horses, and even sentinels who were off their guard. One day, when the army was about to march, Francisco, the Genoese carpenter, obtained permission of the governor for him- self and several troopers, who were in want of servants, to remain 392 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. behind, and lie in ambush at the place of encampment, for the Indians were accustomed to visit those places as soon as the Spaniards had abandoned them, to pick up any articles they might have left behind. A dozen horse and twelve foot concealed themselves, accord- ingly, in a thick clamp of trees, one of their companions climb- ing to the top of the highest to look out and give notice should any Indians approach. In four sallies they captured fourteen of the enemy without any resistance. These they divided among them, two falling to the share of Francisco the shipwright, as leader of the detachment. The party would then have rejoined the army, but Francisco refused, alleging that he needed another Indian, and that he would not return until he had captured one. All the efforts of his comrades to shake this foolhardy deter- mination were in vain ; each of them offered to give up the In- dian that had fallen to his share, but he refused to accept the boon. Yielding, therefore, to his obstinacy, they remained with him in ambush. In a little while the sentinel in the tree gave warning that an Indian was near. One of the horsemen, the same Juan Paez who had recently been wounded in the arm, dashed forth with his wonted impetuosity, and rode full speed at the Indian. The lat- ter, as usual, took refuge under a tree. Paez galloped close by the tree, giving a passing thrust with his lance across the left arm at the Indian. He missed his aim, but his enemy was more suc- cessful ; for as the horse passed, he drew his arrow to the head, and buried it just behind the left stirrup leather. The horse plunged several paces forward, and fell dead. Francisco de Bolanos, a comrade and townsman of Paez, had followed close behind him ; he attacked the Indian in the same way, and failed INDIAN TRANSFIXED. 393 In his blow likewise ; his horse received a similar wound, and went stumbling forward to fall beside his predecessor. The two dismounted horsemen, recovering from their fall, made at the Indian with their lances, while, from the other side, a cavalier, named Juan de Vega, came galloping towards him on horseback. The Indian, thus assailed on both sides, rushed forth from under the tree to encounter the horseman, perceiving, that if he could kill the horse, he could easily escape from his dis- mounted antagonists by his superior swiftness of foot. With this intent he sped an arrow at the breast of the horse, as he came charging upon him, which would have cleft his heart but for a breastplate of three folds of tough bull-hide with which his rider had provided him. The arrow passed through the breast- plate, and penetrated a hand's breadth in the flesh. The horse continued his career, and Juan de Yega transfixed the savage with his lance. The Spaniards grieved over the loss of the two horses, more valuable now that their number was so diminished ; but their chagrin was doubly heightened when they came to see the enemy who had cost them so dear. Instead of being well made and muscular, like the most of the natives, he was small, lank, and diminutive, giving no promise in his form of the valor of his spirit. Cursing their misfortune, and the wilfulness of Francis- co, which had caused it, they set forward with their companions to rejoin the army.* * Garcilaso de la Vega, Part ii. Lib. v. c. 5 and 6. CHAPTER LXXXV. THEY PASS THROUGH THE PROVINCE OF CHAGUATE, AND MOSCOSO DISPATCHES A PAE,TY OF TWELVE TROOPERS AFTER DIEGO DE GUZMAN SUFFERINGS OF THE ARMY THEIR ARRIVAL AT THE PROVINCE OF ANILCO, AND THEIR DESPONDENCY CHEERED UP BY NEWS OF THE FERTILE COUNTRY OF AMINOYA ANASCO DISPATCH- ED TO THAT PROVINCE, AND WHAT HE FOUND THERE. 1542. With similar adventures and disasters did the Spaniards continue their weary journey. Fearful of making too great a bend to the south, and of striking the Mississippi below the province of Gua- choya. which was the point where they wished to arrive^ they now inclined to the northeast, so as to strike the track they had made on their western course. This led them back through the province of Naguatex, where they found the villages which they had burnt already rebuilt, and the houses well stocked with maize. In this province the natives made earthen ware of a very tolerable quality. In passing through the province of Chaguate, the governor bethought him of the Spanish cavalier, Diego de Guzman, who had taken refuge among the Indians, and sent twelve troopers in search of him ; but he had notice of their approach from the In- DESPERATE SITUATION. 395 dian spies, and concealed himself. The army, in the mean time, were suffering from scarcity of food, so that the governor, seeing that Gruzman was bent upon remaining among his Indian friends, gave up all further search for him, and proceeded on his march.* The winter was now set in with great rigor, with heavy rains, violent gales, and extreme cold : yet in their eagerness to arrive at their destined place of repose, they continued to press forward in all weathers, travelling all day, and arriving at nightfall, drench- ed with rain, and covered with mud, at their place of encampment. They had then to sally out in quest of food, and most of the time were compelled to gain it by force of arms, and sometimes at the expense of many lives. The rivers became swollen by the rain : even the brooks were no longer fordable, so that almost every day they were obliged to make rafts to cross them ; and at some of the rivers they were detained seven or eight days, by the unceasing opposition of their enemies, and the want of sufficient materials for constructing the rafts. Often, too, at night they had no place whereon to lie, the ground being covered with mud and water. The cavalry passed the night sitting upon their horses, and as to the infantry, with the water up to their knees, their situation may easily be con- ceived. For clothing, too. they had merely jackets of chamois and other skins, belted round them, serving for shirt, doublet, and coat, and almost always soaking wet ; they were in general bare- legged, without shoes or sandals. With these continual sufferings, both men and horses began to sicken and die. Every day two, three, and at one time seven Spaniards fell victims to the hardships of the journey, and almost all the Indian servants perished. There were no means of carry- * Portuguese Relation, c. 35. 17* 396 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. ing the sick and dying, for many of the horses were infirm, and those that were well, were reserved to repel the constant attacks of the enemy. The sick and exhausted, therefore, dragged their steps forward as long as they could, and often died by the way, while the survivors, in their haste to press onward, scarce paused to give them sepulture, leaving them half covered with earth, and sometimes entirely unburied. Yet, notwithstanding this sickness and exhaustion, they never failed to post sentinels, and keep up their camp guard at night, to prevent their being surprised and massacred. At length they arrived at the fertile province of Anilco, the cacique of which had experienced such rough treatment from them, and their savage ally, Gruachoya, on their previous visit. They had been, for some time past, cheering themselves during their famished march with the prospect of solacing themselves in this province, which abounded in maize, and of procuring a suffi- cient supply to sustain them during the time necessary for the construction of their vessels. To their bitter disappointment, however, they found the province of Anilco almost destitute of maize ; and had the additional chagrin of knowing that they were the cause of this scarcity. The hostilities they had waged with Anilco, during their residence at Gruachoya, had deterred the in- habitants from cultivating their lands ; thus seed-time passed un- improved, and the year had produced no harvest. Many of the Spaniards, worn out by past trials, could not stand this new disappointment, but gave way to despair. Without a supply of maize, it would be impossible to subsist through the winter, or to sustain the daily and protracted toils of building the vessels for their departure. Their imaginations magnified the difficulties before them, and painted every thing in dark DESPONDENCY IN THE CAMR 397 colors. How were they to build vessels fitted to stand a sea voyage, destitute as they were of pitch and tar, of sails and cord- age 1 How were they to navigate without map, or sea-chart, or pilot ? — How were they to ascertain at what place the great river on which they were to embark disembogued itself into the ocean? Sorely did they lament their having returned from the far west, and given up their project of reaching New Spain by land. As to the plan of escaping by sea, nothing, said they, but a miracle would enable them to carry it into effect. Such were the despondmgs of many of the Spaniards ; and, indeed, a general gloom prevailed through the camp, when they were again encouraged by intelligence derived from some of the Indians of Anilco. They told them that at the distance of two days' journey, on the banks of the Mississippi, there were two towns near to each other, in the country of Aminoya, a region of exuberant fertility ; in these they would probably find maize, and other provisions, in abundance. On receiving this cheering intelligence, the governor imme- diately detached Juan de Anaseo, with a strong party of horse and foot, to visit these places.* They were accompanied by many of the Indians of xlnilco, who were at war with those of Aminoya. After a hard march of two days, they came to the towns, which were situated close together, in an open champaign country, and surrounded by a creek or ditch, filled with water from the Missis- sippi, so as to form an island. De Anaseo entered the villages without opposition, the in- habitants having fled on their approach. To the great joy of the Spaniards, the houses were abundantly stocked with maize, and other grain ; vegetables, nuts, acorns, and dried fruits, such as * Portuguese Relation, c. 35. Mfi CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. grapes and plants, [a one of the bouses they found an old woman, who wa:~; too infirm to make hor escape. Sho ankod thorn why they came to that rillage. They replied, to printer there. The old beldame Hhook hor hoad. and told thorn that iras no place for wintor quarters. Every fourteen years, she said, there was an uncommon rise of* the great rivor, so as to inundate all the surrounding country, and compel the inhabitants to take refuge in the upper part of thoir houses. This,sbe added, vras the four- teenth year, and an inundation vras to ho expected The Span- iard:-;, however, made light of her warning, considering it an old wives' fable, without reflecting that ancient residents of the kind are the chronicles of local fact. CHAPTEB n THE STA3FIAR1>S ARRIVE AT AMESOYA COMMIT Aimaneg — barrel between the a, asto THE CAPTAiX OESERAk OF A>. ..AR CHALLENGE OF THE LATTER, Havixo fixed himself in one of the towns, De Afiaseo sent. f his success, si that prevailed around him, Mosooso immediately get off with the re- sidue of the army to join hiin. Notwithstan'; of speedy repoge and goo his was as hard a march as any the troops had experienced Enfeebled by sickness and ain, and a hitter north wi.. The hearts of the poor way-worn Span' them when they once . ne in gight of * they regarded it as tb* highway hy wl land of disaster, as a haven of w 'id tha 1 that they ha vrhere they might rest a while from their wayfar- ing, Indeed, had they not found, at th abundance, it is probable most of them would have perished un- and privations of the winter As it was. many 400 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. of them but gained this place of rest to die. The excitement of the march had stimulated them beyond their strength ; when no longer exertion was necessary, they fell into sickness and lethar- gy, and in the course of a few days above fifty of them expired. Among those who had thus survived the toils and perils of the march, to perish in the place of refuge, was Andres de Vas- concellos, a Portuguese cavalier of noble blood, who had distin- guished himself on various occasions in the course of this fatal enterprise. No one, however, was more lamented by the army than the brave and generous Nuno Tobar, a cavalier no less valiant and noble than unfortunate. Having had the ill luck, at the outset of the enterprise, through an error of love, to displease the gover- nor De Soto, he had never been forgiven, although he had repaired his wrong to the lady by marriage, and atoned to his commander by repeated acts of chivalrous bravery. On the contrary, he had ever been treated by De Soto with a rigor and disdain, from which his great merits and services should have shielded him ; nor had he been restored to his military rank under that gener- al's successor, Moscoso. Seeing the favorable situation of the village of Aminoya, and the abundance of the surrounding country, the governor resolved to establish his winter quarters, and build his brigantines here.* It is true it was about sixteen leagues above the residence of Gruachoya, where he had intended to winter, but that was imma- terial ; the grand object was attained, a secure place on the Mis- * Mr. McCulloch supposes the village of Aminoya to have been situated in the neighborhood of the present town of Helena, about thirty miles above the Arkansas. EMBARKATION OF FORCES. 401 sissippi for the construction of his vessels, and his proposed embarkation. To render his position more comfortable and secure, he destroyed one of the two adjacent villages, and carried al] its provisions, wood, and provender, to the other. This was sur- rounded by palisades, and he set about strengthening its defences, but such was the debilitated state of his men, that it cost him twenty days to accomplish the work. Being now, however, in good quarters, with plenty of food, and suffering no molestation from the natives, they soon began to recover from their fatigues and maladies, and, with the renovation of their strength, their spirits likewise revived. They now set to work to construct seven brigantines, for the embarakation of all their force. They were built under the super- intendence of Francisco, the Genoese, the same who had on various occasions been efficient in constructing bridges, rafts, and boats, being the only person in the army who knew any thing of ship-building. He was assisted by four or five carpenters, of Biscay. Another Genoese and a Catalonian, skilled, as their countrymen usually are, in nautical affairs, engaged to calk the vessels. A Portuguese, who had been a slave among the Moors of Fez, had learned the use of the saw, and instructed some of the soldiers in the art. He was to reduce the timber felled in the neighbor- ing forests into suitable planks ; while a cooper, who was almost at death's door, promised, as soon as he was able to work, to make water-casks for the vessels. All the iron work treasured up from former embarkations was now brought forth, and every article of iron that could be spared from other purposes. The chains were knocked off the 402 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. Indian captives, even the iron stirrups of the troopers were given up, and wooden ones substituted in their place. A forge was erected to work up these materials into the necessary forms, and thus the whole undertaking soon began to wear an encouraging aspect. Assistance was also rendered from other quarters. The old friend and ally of the Spaniards. Gruachoya, hearing of their return, came with presents of provisions, and renewed his former inter- course. The cacique Anilco also, taught by the severe treatment he had brought upon himself by former hostility, now sent his captain general, with a numerous retinue, entreating the friend- ship of the governor, and pleading ill health as an excuse for his not coming in person. The captain general was received with great ceremony and respect ; he was shrewd and intelligent, and acquitted himself with great address in his intercourse with the Spaniards. He mingled among them familiarly, acquainted him- self with their plans and wishes, and transmitted an account of every thing to his cacique, who immediately contributed every assistance in his power. Every day or two came supplies from Anilco of fish and other provisions, together with various materials for the ships, such as cordage of various sizes, made of grass and fibrous plants, and mantles made of an herb resembling the mal- lows, containing a fibre like flax, which the Indians wrought into thread, and dyed with various colors. Gruachoya emulated Anilco in supplying the various wants of the Spaniards, but fell short of him in constant assiduity. Both caciques furnished numbers of their subjects to serve in the camp, and to do the rough work about the ships. To carry on their ship-building without interruption from storms and inundations, the Spaniards erected four large frame JEALOUSY OF GUACHOYA. 403 buildings. Within these both officers and men toiled without distinction, sawing planks, twisting cordage, making oars, and hammering out iron, and their only pride was shown in striving who should do the most work. The cordage furnished by Anilco was fabricated into rigging and cables, and when this was not sufficient, the rinds of mul- berry-trees were substituted. The Indian mantles, when sound and entire, were formed into sails ; the old ones were picked into shreds to calk the vessels. For this latter purpose, also, use was made of an herb resembling hemp, called Enequen ; and in place of tar the seams were payed with the rosin and gum of various trees, and with an unctuous kind of earth. During the whole winter the captain general of Anilco was continually with the Spaniards, officiating as the representative of his cacique, mingling in all their concerns, administering to their wants, and seemingly taking as much interest in their plans as if they had been his own. His important services, and the hearty good will with which they were rendered, made him so popular with both officers and soldiers, that he received, on all occasions, such honors as would have been paid to his cacique. All this awakened the jealousy and anger of Guachoya. He had secretly sought to revive the former hostilities between the Spaniards and Anilco, but his intrigues had been in vain. His spleen at length broke forth, in presence of the governor and his officers, on the occasion of some new honors which they paid to the captain general. He represented the latter as a mere servant and vassal, base in his origin, poor in his circumstances, and re- monstrated with the Spaniards for paj^ing more honors to a man of such condition, than to a powerful chieftain. The general of Anilco listened with a calm, unchanging coun- 404 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. tonance until he had finished, then, asking permission of the gov- ernor, he replied with generous warmth, showing his honorable descent from the same ancestors as his cacique, and his high standing, as second only to his chieftain, and commander of his forces. He reminded Guachoya of victories which he had gain- en over his father, himself, and his brothers, all of whom he had, at different times, had in his power and treated magnanimously ; finally, as a mortal trial of prowess, he defied Guachoya to enter alone with him into a canoe, and launch themselves on the Mis- sissippi. The abode of Guachoya lay several leagues down the river, that of the general of Anilco up the tributary stream which entered into the Mississippi. He who should survive the mortal struggle of the voyage, and navigate the canoe to his home, would be the undisputed victor. The captain general of Anilco concluded his warm and in- dignant speech, but Guachoya neither accepted the challenge nor answered a word, but remained with confused and downcast coun- tenance. From that time forward the general was held in higher estimation than ever by the cavaliers and the army in general.* * Garcilaso de la Vega, Lib. v. P. ii. c. 10. CHAPTER LXXXVIL THE LEAGUE OF THE CACIQUES AGAINST THE SPANIARDS GONZALO SILVESTRE ROUGHLY HANDLES AN INDIAN HOW THE DESIGNS OF THE HOSTILE CACIQUES WERE FRUSTRATED. 1543. While the Spaniards were diligently employed building their brigantines, the natives of the surrounding provinces were plotting their destruction. On the opposite side of the Mississippi, a few leagues below Aminoya, extended the vast, fruitful, and populous province of Quigualtanqui ; the same province which had been visited by a scouting party, sent by Hernando De Soto, during his sojourn at G-uachoya ; on which occasion, the reader may re- collect, taunting messages were sent by the cacique to the gover- nor. The cacique of Quigualtanque was young and warlike ; beloved throughout his extensive dominions, and feared by his neighbors on account of his great power. Retaining his former enmity to the Spaniards, he learnt with alarm that they were again in his neighborhood, and building great barks, which might give them command of the river, or en- able them to leave the country, and return in greater force to conquer it. He sent envoys, therefore, among the neighboring 406 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. caciques on both sides of the river, and a league was formed to combine their forces at a certain time, for a general assault upon the Spaniards. The cacique of Anilco was invited to enter into the league, but he remained true to the Spaniards, and sent the governor secret intelligence of the conspiracy. Moscoso ordered addition- al guards to be stationed about the camp, and patrols kept up by night and day, and vigilant watch to be maintained over the places where the arms and munitions of war were deposited. In the mean time, envoys arrived at all hours of the day and night from the cacique of Quigualtanqui and his allies, bringing mes- sages of friendship, accompanied by presents. The governor perceived, by their roving about the camp, and taking note of every thing, that they were mere spies. He gave peremptory orders, therefore, that no Indian should come by night to the vil- lage ; but his mandates were disregarded. One night, Gronzalo Silvestre. with a comrade, was on duty as sentry at one of the gates of the village. He was just recover- ing from a severe illness, and was yet feeble. About the mid-watch, he descried in the clear moonlight two Indians approaching, with bows and arrows in their hands, and lofty plumes on their heads. They advanced towards the gate across a fallen tree, which serv- ed as a bridge over the fosse. Silvestre, who knew the peremptory orders of the governor, and the lurking treachery which sur- rounded them, felt his blood boil at sight of these interlopers. " Here come two Indians," said he to his comrade ; how dare they come at night, in defiance of the prohibition of the governor % By the mass, the first that enters this gate shall feel the edge of my sword." His comrade begged him to leave the Indian to him, as he THREATENED VENGEANCE. 407 was strong and well, and Silvestre but feeble in health. " By no means," replied the other ; " I am strong enough to give these impudent savages a lesson." The Indian drew nigh, and finding the gate open, entered without hesitation. In an instant, Silvestre gave the foremost a blow in the face with his sword, and felled him to the ground. The savage recovered himself, snatched up his bow and arrows, and plunging into the fosse, swam to the other side. His com- panion fled across the fallen tree, and leaping into his canoe, made the best of his way across the Mississippi. At sunrise, four Indian warriors appeared at the camp, com- plaining in the name of all the neighboring caciques of this vio- lation of the peace existing between them, and demanding that, as the wounded Indian was a warrior of rank, the soldier who struck him should be put to death. Embassies of the kind were repeated at noon, and in the evening, the latter announcing that the warrior had died of his wound. Luis de Moscoso gave evasive and haughty replies to the am- bassadors, which greatly incensed the chieftains of the league. They concealed their rage and hatred, however, consoling them- selves with the idea that the day of vengeance was at hand. In the mean time, each cacique assembled his warriors, and prepared for the signal blow. Their plan was to burst suddenly upon the Spaniards, and massacre every one of them. Should they fail in this, they were to set fire to the hulks of the vessels, and thus prevent their departure. They might then exterminate them by degrees ; for they were aware of their diminished numbers, and that but few horses survived — these objects of their chief terror — above all, they knew that the brave Hernando de Soto was no more. 408 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. The Spaniards were aware that the momentous day was near at hand : for some of the spies who visited the camp had comfort- ed the Indian captives with assurances of speedy deliverance and revenge ; all which the Indian women had revealed to their mas- ters. Added to this, as the nights were still and serene, they would hear the murmuring sound of Indian gatherings on both sides of the river, and could see the camp fires gleaming in differ- ent directions. When this storm of war was about to burst upon the Span- iards, there came on a sudden rising of the river. The predic- tion of the old Indian woman was verified. Although there had been no fall of rain for a month, yet the Mississippi, in the month of March, swelled above its banks, and inundated the coun- try for several leagues on both sides of the river. The green fields and forests were transformed into a broad sea, with the branches and tops of the trees rising above the surface, and ca- noes gliding between them in every direction. The town in which the army was quartered was on a rising ground, yet the water rose in the lower parts of the houses, and obliged the troops to take refuge in the garrets, or on sheds erected on strong piles. They had to quarter their horses in the same manner ; and for some time it was impossible to go abroad, excepting in canoes, or on horseback, when the water would reach to the stirrups of the trooper. It was in consequence of these inundations, says the Spanish historian, that the Indians built their villages on high hills, or artificial mounds. The houses of the chieftains were often built upon piles, with upper floors, where they might take refuge from the freshets. CHAPTER LXXXVIII. THE CACIQUES OP THE LEAGUE AGAIN PREPARE TO ATTACK THE SPANIARDS AN INDIAN SPY A PLOT DETECTED. 1543. The swelling of the Mississippi and inundation of the surround- ing country, dispersed the hordes of savage warriors, and forced them to take refuge in their villages. The cacique, however, did not abandon their evil design, but kept up a semblance of friend- ship, sending repeated messages and presents. Moscoso ordered a vigilant watch to be kept about the village, and especially about the brigantines, permitting no Indians to come near them in their canoes, through fear of some treacherous design. The swollen river subsided as slowly as it had risen, and it was two months before it shrunk within its natural channel. As soon as the surface of the country was sufficiently dry, the ca- ciques again gathered their forces for their premeditated attack. The General of Anilco gave the governor warning of their movements, and offered to bring a large force of Indians to assist him ; but Moscoso declined his offer, lest his services should em- broil the generous Anilco with his neighbors, after the departure of the Spaniards. 410 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. Anxious to procure particular information of the plans of the conspirators, Moscoso ordered an Indian, who was loitering about the town, and whom he suspected to be a spy, to be put to the rack. This is always a sure mode of forcing out round assertions, whether true or false. The Indian, under torture, declared that twenty caciques of the neighborhood were about to attack the camp with a large army : that to put him off his guard and con- ceal their treachery, they were to send a present of fish three days before the attack, and another present on the appointed day. That the Indians who brought the fish, combining with those who served in the camp, were to seize upon all lances and other wea- pons that were at hand, and set fire to the houses. At the sight of the flames, the caciques, with their troops, were to rush from the places where they lay in ambush, and assail the Spaniards on all sides, in the height of their confusion. The governor, having heard the story, ordered the Indian to be kept in chains. On the day he had mentioned, thirty Indians came into the town, bearing presents of fish and messages of kindness. The governor immediately ordered them to be seized, taken aside separately, and examined concerning the conspiracy. They attempted no defence, but made full confession of the. plot. Moscoso, with his usual rigor, ordered forthwith that their right hands should be cut off, and that they should be sent, thus muti- lated, to their homes, to give warning to the caciques that their treachery was discovered. The stoical savages bore their punish- ment without flinching ; scarce was the hand of one stricken off, when another laid his arm upon the block. Their patience and firmness extorted the pity and admiration even of their enemies. This sanguinary punishment of their envoys put an end to the league of the caciques, who gave up their plan of attacking AN INDIAN SPY. 411 the camp, and returned eaeh one to his province, but with hearts bent on further hostility. Guachoya had more than once been suspected by the Span- iards of secret participation in this plot, and had even been charg- ed with it by the Indian spy, when under the torture. There does not appear to have been certain proof; and, indeed, all these stories of plots and conspiracies related by Indians of each other, are to be received with great distrust. The Spaniards, doubtless, were often deceived by their allies, who sought through their means, to cripple their rivals and antagonists ; and much need- less hostility and bloodshed did they bring upon themselves by some harsh measure, either to punish or prevent some imputed treason. 18 CHAPTER LXXXIX. FINAL PREPARATIONS OF MOSCOSO AND HIS FOLLOWERS. 1543. Moscoso and his officers, convinced of their perilous situation thus surrounded by open and secret foes, applied themselves as- siduously to complete their armament, and provide stores for the voyage. Gruachoya, conscious of the late suspicions entertained of him, redoubled his zeal in furnishing maize, fish, and other supplies, and Anilco continued to the last his friendly offices. Throughout all their wanderings the Spaniards had preserved a number of the swine which they had brought with them to stock their intended settlement. These had, in fact, multiplied during the march, and others which had strayed away, or been given to the Indians, had likewise produced their increase. The Spaniards now killed those that remained with them, excepting a dozen and a half which they retained alive, in case they should yet form a set- tlement near the sea coast, and a few which they made presents to Anilco and G-uachoya. The carcasses were then cut up and made into bacon for ships' provisions. Of fifty horses that remained, they determined that twenty of the least valuable should be killed and put up for provisions. This was a painful alternative, on ac- count of their long companionship in wayfaring, and the faithful COMPLETION" OF ARRANGEMENTS. 413 services they had rendered. They were tied to stakes at night, a vein opened, and they were thus left to bleed to death. The flesh was then parboiled and dried in the sun, and laid up among the sea stores. Canoes were linked together, two and two, to convey the others, their fore feet being placed in one canoe and their hind feet in the other, and the canoes were barricaded with boards and hides to ward off the arrows of the Indians. When the brigantines were ready for service, there was an unusual swelling of the river, so that the water reached the place where they were on the stocks, and they were launched with great ease. This was a fortunate circumstance, for they were built of such thin planks, and fastened with such short nails, that they might have bulged in being transported over land. They were merely large barks, open except at the bow and stern, where they had coverts to protect the sea stores. Along the gunwales were bulwarks of boards and hides, and boards were laid athwart them to serve as decks. They had seven oars on each side, at which all were to take their turns indiscriminately, excepting the cap- tains. Each brigantine had two commanders, so that in emer- gencies, one might act on shore, while the other remained to govern on board. The little squadron being now afloat and all ready for embark- ation, the governor made his final arrangements on shore. Two days before his departure he took a kind farewell of Gruachoya, and the captain general of Anilco, sending them both back to their homes, first making them promise to live in friendship with each other after he was gone. The next day he dismissed the greater part of the Indians, male and female, who had been in the service of the camp, retaining those only, of both sexes, who were of distant tribes and had followed the army in its wander- 414 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. ings. But a remnant survived, not above thirty, out of a multi- tude that had from time to time been captured and reduced to servitude, in the course of their extensive marchings. The rest had perished by degrees, in the various hardships to which they had been exposed. These survivors had, for the most part, be- come attached to the Spaniards, and moreover, dreaded to be left among the strange tribes, who might enslave and maltreat them.* * The Portuguese Relation makes the number of Indians thus embarked, amount to one hundred. The number given by the Inca is most probable, both narratives having previously stated that most of the Indians who had followed the army in its last march perished before arriving at Aminoya. CHAPTER XC. EMBARKATION OF THE SPANIARDS UPON THE MISSISSIPPI A GRAND AND CONCERTED ATTACK BY A LARGE FLEET OF CANOES, AND HOW THE SPANIARDS FARED GONZALO SILVESTRE SENT ON SHORE WITH A DETACHMENT OF MEN FOR PROVISIONS LOSS OF THEIE. HORSES. 1543. - On the second day of July, the Spaniards embarked on hoard their seven hrigantines. The largest one, named the Capitana, was commanded by Luis de Moscoso, as admiral of this little fleet. Of the numerous and brilliant host that had entered on this heroic but disastrous enterprise, not quite three hundred and fifty survived ; and these in forlorn and wretched plight ; their once brilliant armor battered, broken, and rusted : their rich and silken raiment reduced to rags, or replaced by the skins of wild beasts. The sun was setting as they got under way, and the gloom of evening seemed an emblem of their darkening fortunes. They were abandoning the fruit of all their labor and hardships, the expected reward of their daring exploits, the land of their golden dreams. They were launching forth on a vast and unknown river, leading they knew not whither, and were to traverse, in 416 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. frail and rudely constructed barks, without chart or compass, great wastes of ocean, to which they were strangers, bordered by savage coasts, in the vague hope of reaching some Christian shore, on which they would land beggars ! With sail and oar they pursued their course all night, and on the following morning passed by the residence of G-uachoya. Here they found many of the inhabitants waiting in their canoes to receive them, and beheld a rustic bower of branches of trees prepared for their reception. The governor, however, excused himself from landing, whereupon the Indians accompanied him in their canoes to where the river forked into two branches. They warned him that he was near the residence of Quigualtanqui, and offered to accompany him, and make war upon that cacique ; but the governor, who desired nothing less than any hostile encoun- ter with the natives, declined their offer, and dismissed them. The little fleet continued its course by the main branch of the river, where there was a rapid current ; and in the afternoon hauled to shore on the left bank, where the Spaniards passed the rest of the day in a spacious wood. At night they re-embarked, and continued their course. On the following day, they landed near a village which the Indians had abandoned, and took a woman prisoner, who informed them that the cacique of Quigual- tanqui had assembled all his forces further down the river, and was waiting to attack them. This intelligence put them on their guard, but made them ready to suspect hostilities, where perhaps they were not intended. They had not proceeded much farther down the river, when, as they were foraging on shore, and carrying off provisions wherever they found them, they perceived a number of canoes hovering on the opposite side of the river, and, as they thought, menacing hostili- CONCERTED ATTACK 41* ties. The cross-bow men immediately leaped in the canoes that were astern of the brigantines, pushed across the river, and readily dispersed the savages. No sooner had the cross-bow men returned to the brigantines, and the latter got under weigh, than the light barks of the savages were again in sight ; keeping ahead of the squadron, and drawing up near a village that stood on a high bank, they seemed disposed to make battle. The canoes were again manned, the Indians were once more dispersed, and the Spaniards landing, set fire to the village ; after which, they en- camped for the night in an open plain. Whatever may have been the previous disposition and inten- tions of the Indians, they had now fair grounds for hostility ; nor did they fail to wage it to the utmost. On the following morn- ing, a powerful fleet of canoes was in sight, apparently the com- bined force of the hostile caciques. Some of them were of great size, with from fourteen to twenty-five paddles on a side, and car- ried from thirty to seventy warriors. They darted across the water with the speed of race horses. The canoes of the caciques, and some of the principal war- riors, were brilliantly painted, both within and without ; the pad- dles, the rowers, and even the warriors themselves, from the feet to the scalping tuft, were painted of one color. Some were blue, others yellow or white, red, green, violet or black, according to the device or taste of the chieftain. For that day, and part of the next, they followed the Span- iards without attacking them, keeping time in rowing by chanting wild songs of different cadences, short or long, slow or fast, accord- ing to the speed with which they desired to move, and closing each chant with a terrific and deafening yell, shouting the name of Qui- gualtanqui. The burthen of these wild war songs, was the chiv- 418 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. alrous exploits of tlieir ancestors, and the daring deeds of thel? chieftain, by recalling the memory of which, they roused them- selves to battle. They proudly vaunted their own fearlessness and valor, while they taunted the Spaniards with cowardice in fly- ing from their arms, and threatened to overthrow them, and make them food for fishes. About noon of the second day, there was a movement among the fleet of canoes. They separated into three different divisions, forming a van, centre, and rear, and approached the right bank of the river. The canoes in the van then darted forward, glided along to the right of the brigantines, and crossing the river obliquely, discharged a shower of arrows, which wounded many Spaniards,, in spite of their shields and bulwarks. They then wheeled round, and recrossing the river in front of the brigantines, sta- tioned themselves on the rigiit bank. The second squadron 7 composing the centre of the fleet, performed the same manoeuvre, and having discharged tlieir arrows, reerossed the river, and stationed themselves in front of the van. The rear did likewise, and then took up their position in front of all. As the caravels advanced, the Indians repeated their attack after the same manner, always returning to the right bank of the river. In this manner the savages battled with the Spaniards all the day long, never giving them a moment's rest, and breaking their repose during the night by incessant alarms. When the Spaniards were first attacked, they manned the canoes in which the horses were, for the purpose of protecting them, as they expected to combat hand to hand with the savages. Perceiving, however, the intention of the enemy to fight at a dis- tance, and gall them with their arrows, and finding themselves exposed to their fire, they returned to the brigantines, leaving SILVESTRE SENT FOR SUPPLIES. 419 the horses with no other defence save the skins of animals thrown over them. In these contests, the Spaniards had to return the enemy's fire from their cross-bows, for their arquebuses had never been of use since the destruction of their gunpowder, at the conflagra- tion of Mauvila, and they had been wrought up with other articles into iron work for the brigantines. They sought not, however, to make offensive war, but merely to keep the enemy at bay, while the rowers plied their oars ; and they sheltered themselves as well as they were able, with buffalo skins, and shields made of double mats, through which an arrow could not penetrate. This harassing warfare continued for several days and nights, until most of the Spaniards were wounded, and all were worn out with fatigue and watching, and with the weight of their armor. Of the horses, also, only eight remained alive. The Indians, at length, desisted from their attacks, and hovered at the distance of half a league. The Governor, imagining they had given over all further hos- tilities, and supposing that the sea could be at no great distance ahead, was desirous of procuring a fresh supply of provisions. Observing a small village on the banks of the river, he sent Gron- zalo Silvestre on shore with a hundred men and the eight horses, to seek supplies. The inhabitants of the village fled with loud yells at the approach of such strange people, and strange animals. Silvestre found abundance of maize and dried fruits, with skins of different animals, and among the rest, a martin skin, decorated with strings of pearl, which appeared to have been used as a ban- ner. While he and his party were making plunder of every thing in their way, they heard the trumpet clamorously sounding their recall. Hurrying to the river bank, they beheld a fleet of canoes 18* 420 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. pulling towards them with all speed, while a band of Indians were running to cut them off by land. Springing into their canoes, they pulled with desperate exertions to the brigantines, abandon- ing the horses to their fate. The Indians turned to vent their fury upon the latter. The gallant animals defended themselves by kicking and plunging ; some of the savages were so frightened at what they took for ferocious beasts, that they leaped into the water ; the rest, however, hunted the poor horses like so many deer, transfixed them with their arrows, and made an end of them. Thus miserably perished the remnant of the three hundred and fifty noble steeds, that had entered Florida in such gorgeous array. As the Spaniards beheld these generous and faithful animals slaughtered before their eyes, without being able to aid them, they sorrowed deeply, and shed tears for them as though they had been their own children.* * Garcilaso de la Vega, Lib. vi. c. 5. Portuguese Relation, c. 38. CHAPTER XCI. CONTINUATION OP THE VOYAGE DOWN THE MISSISSIPPI THE POOL- HARDY EXPLOIT OF ESTEVAN ANEZ THE FEAT OF PEDRO MORON, THE HALF-BREED UNCERTAIN FATE OF DE GUZMAN. 1543. The Indians continued to follow at some distance in the rear of the Spaniards, attacking any of their vessels that lagged behind, until the sixteenth day of this harassing voyage. On board of one of the brigantines was a soldier named Estevan Anez. He was of low birth, but had joined the expedi- tion as a trooper. His steed, though of sorry appearance, had proved tough and strong, and was among the last that perished. Owing to his being mounted, Anez had been engaged in some of the most perilous service of the expedition, and though he had never performed any thing of note, had gained the reputation of a gallant man. This, added to his natural rusticity and narrow spirit, had rendered him weak and vainglorious. This day he got into the canoe, attached to the stern of the brigantine, under pretence of going to speak with the governor, but in reality on a hare-brained project. He enticed with him five young cavaliers of buoyant spirits and daring valor, promising them some bril- liant exploit. One of them, Carlos Enriquez, scarce twenty years 422 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA, of age, graceful in form, and with a countenance of surpassing beauty, was the natural son of Don Carlos Enriquez, who fell bravely fighting in the battle of Mauvila. Estevan Anez, with these five gallant young cavaliers, pulled directly for the Indian fleet that stretched across the river in the rear. The governor witnessing this mad freak, ordered the trumpets to sound a recall. The captains of the brigantines likewise shouted and made signs to them to return. The louder they shouted the more obstinate and vainglorious grew Estevan Anez, and instead of returning he made signs for the brigantines to follow him. When Luis de Moscoso beheld the stubbornness of this madman, he dispatched forty-six Spaniards in three canoes after him, vowing to hang him the moment he should be brought back. Juan de Guzman, the commander of one of the brigan- tines, was the first to leap into the canoe, followed by his friend Juan de Vargas, Guzman prided himself upon his skill in man- aging a canoe, and resisted the entreaties of his friends that he would remain in the brigantine. The savages perceiving their approach, made a retrograde movement, for the purpose of leading them away from the brig- antines, which, having furled their sails, were pulling slowly against the current to reinforce their comrades. Estevan Anez, however, being blinded by his sottish vanity, instead of mistrust- ing their designs, was deceived by this stratagem, and pulled with redoubled might towards them, crying, " they fly ! they fly f at them ! at them !" The other three canoes increased their ef- forts likewise, hoping either to detain him or lend him suceor. The Indians allowed their foes to draw nigh, then altered the disposition of their forces, the centre retreating, so as to form a half moon, and thus luring the Christians into the midst of them. FEAT OF PEDRO MORON. 423 They then assailed them furiously in front and flank. Some leap- ed into the water and overturned the canoes of the Spaniards, many of whom were carried down by the weight of their armor and drowned. Some who kept themselves up by swimming were shot with arrows, or struck over the head with paddles, and others who clung to the overturned canoes were beaten off. In this manner, without being able to make the least defence, forty-eight Spaniards miserably perished. Four alone escaped. One was Pedro Moron, the half-breed, who was an expert swimmer, and exceedingly skilful in the management of a canoe ; he had fallen in the river, but with great dexterity and strength recovered his bark and made his escape, bearing off with him three other sol- diers. One of them, named Alvaro Nieto, battled alone and kept the savages at bay, whilst Pedro Moron guided the canoe ; but neither the prowess and valor of the one, nor the dexterity and skill of the other, would have availed them aught, had not the brigantine of Juan de Griizman fortunately been near. This bark was in advance of the rest, the crew having made greater exertion, aware that their much loved leader was in the midst of the affray ; thus they rescued four of their comrades. Another Spaniard, Juan Terron, reached the brigantine, but as his com- panions were raising him out of the water, he breathed his last in their arms, being pierced with more than fifty wounds. The survivors asserted that they had seen the gallant De G-uzman borne off by the Indians in one of their canoes, but whether dead or alive they could not tell. Luis de Moscoso once again arranged his fleet in order, and resumed his eventful voyage, deeply lamenting the loss of these generous and valiant cavaliers. This was the last assault of the savages, for they seemed satis- 424 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. fied with this signal blow. All the rest of the day, and during the doleful night that succeeded, they kept up continual shouts and yells of triumph. When the sun rose on the following day they appeared to worship him and to return thanks for their victory, then raising a deafening din of voices, mingled with the sound of trumpets, shells, and drums, they turned their prows up the river and departed for their homes. CHAPTER XCII. THE SPANIARDS REACH THE OCEAN DISEMBARK ON AN ISLAND OF DRIFT-WOOD FIERCE ENCOUNTER WITH THE NATIVES OF THE COAST THEY ANCHOR OFF AN UNINHABITED ISLAND. 1543. The poor harassed Spaniards once more began to breathe, when they saw their cruel enemies depart. They now cast about their thoughts as to their position. The river had expanded until it was several leagues in breadth, so that, when in the midst, they could not descry firm land on either side ; nothing was to be seen but a border of swamp or marsh, with tall reeds, that looked like forests at a distance. The departure of the Indians led them to conjecture that the sea was near at hand. Keeping the centre of the current, therefore, lest they should wander into some deep bay, they continued onward, with sail and oar and favoring breeze, until on the twentieth day, a broad expanse of water opened before them. On their left lay a large island, formed by vast quantities of drift-wood, swept down the river and piled up by the waves. About a league further was an uninhabited island, such as is often found at the mouths of great rivers, formed by alluvial deposits. The Spaniards were convinced by these signs, that they had reached the mouth of the river, and that the boundless ocean lay before them. They now steered for the island of drift-wood, and found a 426 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. secure harbor for their brigantines ; for they could lay them along side of the floating masses of timber, which rose and fell with the tide, and, fastening them to trunks of huge trees which lay imbedded there, leave them as secure as if at a pier head. Here, then, they landed, and overhauled their vessels, to repair any damage that they might have sustained, and to fit them for the buffetings of the ocean. Others killed the few hogs that yet re- mained alive, and made them into bacon. These labors, however, required but little time ; the great object in landing on the island was repose ; and so exhausted were they from the constant watch- fulness they had been obliged to sustain for three weeks past, that during three days they did little else than sleep ; and that so profoundly, that they lay about like so many dead bodies. About noon on the third day, they were roused from their repose by the appearance of enemies. Seven canoes issued from among reeds and rushes, and approaching within hail, a gigantic Indian, black as an Ethiopian, either from paint or natural com- plexion, stood up in the prow of the foremost, and addressed them in a thundering voice. After a brief harangue, accompanied by menacing looks and gestures, he turned his prow, and, followed by his companions, shot back again among the rushes ; where, from time to time, other canoes were perceived gliding about as if in ambush. On the words of this black warrior being explained, as they were partially understood by the Indian domestics, they proved to be insulting epithets, and threats of hostility. The governor fear- ed they might put their threats into execution, and attempt to sur- prise him in the night, and burn his vessels ; he determined there- fore to be beforehand with them, and strike the first blow. He ac- cordingly detached a party of picked men, in five canoes, to beat up [NDIAN ARMAMENT. 427 the cane-brake. Among them were twenty-two cross-bow men and three archers. One of these archers was an Englishman by birth ; another had lived in England from his boyhood nntil his twenty- eighth year, and had acquired there his skill with the long-bow and the cloth-yard arrow, for which the English were renowned. Throughout the expedition these two archers had used no other weapon, and had been noted for their deadly aim. The third archer was an Indian, servant of the gallant Juan de Guzman, who had fallen in the late battle, whom he had served faithfully on all occasions, with bow and arrow, since his first landing in Florida. The detachment was commanded by Gonzalo Silvestre and Alvaro Nieto. They discovered the canoes of the enemy drawn up in battle array among the rushes, in formidable numbers. The savages waited until they were within bow-shot, when, having let fly a cloud of arrows that wounded several soldiers, they swept in among the rushes, and came to a second stand. In this way, they fired and wheeled about, and came again to the charge like so many horsemen. The cross-bow men and the three archers kept up a well directed fire, and galled the Indians excessively ; at length the Spaniards were able to come to close quarters, over- turned three of the canoes of the enemy, killed several of the crew, and put the whole armament to flight. They however came out of this affray very roughly handled ; most of them were wounded, and among the number, the two commanders. Fearing an attack in the night, and that fire might be set to the vessels, the governor embarked all the forces and made sail for the uninhabited island, under the lea of which he anchored, in forty fathoms of water. All that night the Spaniards slept on their arms, on board of their vessels, ready for action ; the enemy, however, offered no further molestation. CHAPTER XCIII. A COUNCIL OF OFFICERS CALLED TO DETERMINE UPON THEIR FUTURE COURSE THEY SET SAIL ANASCO PREVAILS UPON THEM TO FOL- LOW HIS ADVICE. 1543. When the day dawned, the governor called a council of his offi- cers to determine what course to steer. To attempt to cross to Cuba or Hispaniola was considered entirely out of the question : as they knew not in what quarter to seek them, nor were they provided with nautical instruments necessary for such a voyage : it was determined, therefore, to make for the coast of Mexico, or New Spain : in seeking which, they would have the land always on their right, to resort to as occasion required. Juan de Anasco now stood forth with his usual bustling zeal, whenever any important measure was to be adopted. He piqued himself much on his knowledge of maritime affairs, as he did upon various other kinds of knowledge, and declared that, according to maps which he had seen, the coast from the place where he sup- posed them to be, bore east and west to the river of Palms, and from that river to New Spain it ran north and south, making a complete bend or gulf. He advised, therefore, that they should put out to sea in a south-west direction, so as to steer across the gulf; by this route they might reach the Mexican shores in ten COUNCIL OF OFFICERS. 429 or twelve days, whereas, if they kept near the land, and followed the windings of the coast, the voyage would necessarily be pro- longed, and they might be overtaken by winter before they could reach a Christian country. To illustrate his ideas, he drew a rough sea-chart, according to his notions of the coast, upon a piece of parchment, made from a deer's skin ; he also produced an old astrolabe, which, being of metal, had escaped the conflagration at Mauvila, and which he had preserved with curious care ; and a forestall, which he had made from a carpenter's rule ; with these to take observations and to steer by, he offered to pilot the squad- ron across the gulf, to the shores of New Spain. The governor was at first inclined to adopt this council, espe- cially as it was concurred in by some of the officers. The major- ity, however, opposed it ; partly through doubts of the nautical knowledge of Juan de Anasco, who they knew had but little practical experience ; partly, perhaps, from jealousy of the lead so often given to him in services of moment, but chiefly because of the real dangers of his proposition. They argued, that the brigantines, being so slightly built, and without decks, would be in danger of foundering in the least storm. That their peril would be almost equally great on the high sea, in calms or head winds, from the want of fresh water, having so few casks to put it in. And that it would be the height of rashness to attempt to cross a vast and unknown gulf without a compass to steer by, and an experienced pilot to direct them. They concluded, therefore, that, though it might be the slower, it would be the far surer course to keep along the coast, where they could land occasionally for supplies, and take refuge in creeks, and bays, and river mouths, in case of tempestuous weather. This council finally prevailed, much to the chagrin of Juan de Anasco. 430 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. Orders were now given to make sail, when, as they were weigh- ing anchor, the cable of the governor's brigantine parted. Un- fortunately, there was no buoy to mark the place, and the water was extremely deep. For six hours the most expert divers were employed in search of it, but in vain : so they had to supply its place with a heavy stone, and the bits from the troopers' bridles, to increase the weight. It was not until three o'clock in the afternoon that they made sail. The governor took the lead, and close to his brigantine was that commanded hy De Anasco. They kept on for two or three leagues into the broad sea, when the captains of the other vessels bore up. and, hailing the governor, demanded whether he intended to quit the shore, contrary to the resolution of the council ; de- claring that if he did so, they would abandon him, and take each one his own course. Moscoso replied, that he did but stand to sea to sail with more security during the night, but that he would return to the coast in the day time. All that night, and the next day, they kept on with a fair wind, ancL/to their surprise, in fresh water, owing to the immense quantity disembogued by the Mississippi. About nightfall, they anchored at a small rocky island, that they might take a little repose. Here the zealous Juan de Anasco again produced his deer- skin chart, and inveighed against the loss of time and labor in thus creeping pusillanimousLy along the shore, instead of stand- ing boldly across the gulf. His arguments at length prevailed, and. on the following morning, with one consent, they all stood out to sea. For two days the stout Juan de Anasco piloted them triumphantly with the aid of his astrolabe and forestafF, and fre- quent consultations of the deer-skin chart ; at length the water A DESTITUTE CONDITION. 431 growing scanty, they felt inclined to stand toward to shore, but were met in the teeth by a contrary wind. Two days did this wind continue, and kept them beating about in the high seas until their water was nearly expended. Bitterly now did they curse Juan de Anasco for giving his ad- vice, and the governor for following it, and swore that if they once more got in with the land, they would keep along it, let Moscoso and his nautical counsellor take what course they pleased. On the fourth day, when they were at their last drop of water, the wind veered a little, and, plying every oar, they made for land. Those on board of the vessels who knew any thing of nautical matters now vented their spleen upon Juan de Anasco as a meddling pretender, who had never been at sea be- fore this expedition, and knew nothing of maritime affairs ; and the common soldiers made merry at the expense of his astrolabe and deer-skin chart. This coming to the ears of the irritable Anasco, he flung his forestaff into the sea, with the chart, which was tied to it, and would have sent the astrolabe after them, but that prudence tempered his wrath. Fortunately, the forestaff and chart floated, and were picked up by the brigantines which followed, and Juan de Anasco was gradually pacified. He seems, in fact, to have been the person in the squadron who had the best notion of their situation and true course, and his idea of the run of the coast was in the main correct. CHAPTER XCIV. VESSELS IN DANGER OF STRANDING COME TO SOME SMALL ISLANDS, WHERE THEY REPAIR THE BRIGANTINES OVERTAKEN BY A VIO- LENT GALE, AND TWO CARAVELS DRIVEN TO SEA MUTINY OF JUAN GAYTAN'S CREW. 1543. It was with much toil and difficulty that the Spaniards rowed to shore, where they landed on a sand beach without shelter. In the evening the wind freshened up directly from the south, and drove the vessels from their weak anchors, so that they were in danger of stranding. The crews were obliged to leap in the water, and bear up against them to keep them from bilging. When the wind had subsided, they dug pits in the sand, from which they procured fresh water enough to fill their casks. In this way they supplied themselves with water throughout the voyage, whenever there were no springs or streams at hand. After sailing about fifteen days, they came to four or five small islands, not far from the main land. Here they found innumerable quantities of sea-birds, that built their nests upon the sand, and so close together, that it was almost impossible to walk without treading upon them. The men land- ed, and returned to the vessels laden with eggs and young birds which were almost too fat to eat. Threading these islands, they coasted along until they came to a beautiful beach, free from rushes, CLOUDS OF MOSQUITOES. 433 skirted by a grove of large trees, clear of Lush, brake, or under- wood. Here they found great quantities of that scum of the sea. called copeck, resembling pitch. They therefore remained here several days careening their brigantines on the beach, calking their seams, and paying them with this copeck, mixed with hog's- lard. While thus employed they were visited several times by a few of the natives, armed with bows and arrows, but pacific in their conduct, who brought maize to give in exchange for skins. Continuing their voyage, the Spaniards were exceedingly molest- ed in some parts of the coast by clouds of mosquitoes, so viru- lent in their sting, that the faces of the men were swollen out of all shape, and it was necessary to stand by the rowers and drive off these pestilent insects from their heads a? they labored at the oar. "When the weather was pleasant the men fished, while others went on shore and gathered shell-fish, for they were on short al- lowance, their pork being expended, and but little maize remain- ing, Some of the fish taken were of a very large size, one of which jerked with such violence as to pull the unwary fisherman into the water. For fifty-three days did the Spaniards keep on along the coast, steering to the westward. A great part of the time, how- ever, was expended in occasionally repairing the vessels, in fish- ing, and in sheltering themselves from rough weather. Juan de Anasco insisted that, from the distance they had come, they could not be far from the river of Palms, from which, as he had be- fore represented, according to his recollections of -the map he had seen, the coast bore from north to south. The fleet stood a little out to sea, and the next morning early they perceived palm-trees raising above the surface of the water at a distance, and observed 434 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. that the coast actually lay north and south. In the afternoon high mountains began to loom up afar off. the first they had seen on any part of the sea coast since their first landing at Espiritu Santo. The opinions of Juan de Anasco now rose in estimation, and it was concluded that they had passed the river of Palms in the night time. If so, they could not be above sixty leagues from the river of Panuco, in the neighborhood of Spanish settlements. They had not proceeded far, however, when a violent gale rose from the north. Five of the brigantines, among them that of the governor, made for the land, the other two caravels, one un- der the command of the treasurer, Juan Gaytan, who, since the untimely death of De Guzman, had remained sole captain, and the other, commanded by Juan de Alvorado and Christoval Mosquera, not taking timely warning of the coming gale, stood off too far from the coast, and were consequently exposed all the night long to the fury of the tempest. The caravel of Juan Gaytan was at one time in imminent peril. A sudden flaw of wind struck her and wrenched the mast out of the beam in which it rested, and it was with the utmost difficulty they could again right it. When morning dawned, the gale, instead of lulling, as the mariners had predicted, raged with renewed violence. They observed the other five brigantines enter some river or creek, and anchor in safety : this stimulated them to redouble their efforts to reach their companions. It was all in vain, however, for the wind was exactly ahead, and by their fruitless struggles, they were several times in danger of foundering. Still, they persist- ed until the afternoon, when, convinced that they were toiling to no purpose, they bore off, and ran along the coast with the wind on the quarter, the billows all the while breaking over them, so that they were in the utmost danger of being swamped. THREATENED MUTINY. 485 For six and twenty hours did this gale continue with unabat- ed fury, during which time the Spaniards were struggling with the winds and waves, without a moment's repose, and scarcely tasting food. Just as the sun was going down, their was a cry of '• land ahead ! ; ' A boy named Franciseo, who was in the brig- antine under the command of Juan de Alvorado and Francisco Mosquera, said to these captains, " Senores, I know this coast ahead, as I have visited it twice before, as cabin-boy of a ship ; the dark land stretching along to the left is a rough and rock- bound coast, extending to the harbor of Vera Cruz. In all that distance there is neither port nor shelter, but it is studded with sharp pointed rocks, which, if we strike, all will be lost. The light-colored land turning off to the right is a soft sand beach, whieh we can attain ere nightfall ; should the wind drive us upon those dark and gloomy shores, we have little chance of our lives !" So soon as the vessels drew nigh to each other, the two cap- tains warned Juan G-aytan and his crew of their danger. They immediately determined to shape their course for the white shore. But Juan Gaytan, who was a better treasurer than captain, oppos- ed this measure, saying it was not well thus to lose a valuable bark This exasperated the crew, who began to mutiny and murmur, " Is this vessel of more worth than our lives ?" said they. " You presume upon your rank of royal treasurer. Did you cut wood, or make charcoal for the forges, or beat out the iron for the nails, or ealk the vessel, or do any thing else 1 No ! you excused yourself as an officer of the Emperor; pray, then, what do you lose if the brigantine is wrecked ?" Upon this the principal soldiers sat to work trimming the sails, and a Portuguese, named Domingos de Acosta, seized the helm, and turned the prow of the bark towards the desired shore. Af- 19 436 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. ter making several tacks, they struck upon the sand-beach, be- fore the sun had set, and succeeded in unlading and hauling the vessel on dry land. The other brigantine effected a landing in a similar manner, and with like success. CHAPTER XCV. EXPEDITION OF GONZALO SILVESTRE TO OBTAIN INFORMATION ABOUT THE COUNTRY WHAT HAPPENED TO MOSCOSO AND THE REST OF THE FLEET HOW THE SPANIARDS WERE RECEIVED BY THE IN- HABITANTS OF PANUCO. 1543. The crews of the two barks now assembled together to decide what was to be done. It was unanimously resolved to send mes- sengers to seek the governor, and bear him tidings of their situ- ation. But who would undertake this perilous journey'? They would have to travel thirteen or fourteen leagues through an un- known land, ford rivers, and peradventure encounter enemies. Gronzalo Quadrado Xaramillo and Francisco Mufizo under- took the task. Taking a small supply of provisions, and buck- ling on their shields and swords, they set forth at midnight on their hazardous errand, Their comrades then returned to their brigantines, posted sentries, and slept until the following morning. No sooner was it light, than they chose three captains to set out, each with twenty men, to obtain information respecting the country. One party followed the coast to the north, another to the south, and the third, under Gonzalo Silvestre, struck in a westwardly direction to penetrate into the interior. 438 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. The two first named parties returned in a short time, one bringing a half dish of white porcelain, of Spanish manufacture, the other a broken porringer of painted earthenware. The rap- ture of their comrades is easier to be conceived than described at beholding these signs of the neighborhood of some Spanish set- tlement. Gonzalo Silvestre and his band penetrated a little more than a quarter of a league, when, from a hillock, they beheld a beauti- ful lake of fresh water spread out before them, a half league in extent Upon its waters were several canoes, with Indians fish- ing. Fearing that these might see them, and spread the alarm, they struck into a wood that bordered the lake, and keeping silently on for a quarter of a league, they espied two Indians be- neath a huge guava-tree, gathering the fruit. Dragging them- selves along on the ground among the herbage until near at hand, they rose at the same time, and rushed to seize them. One of the Indians plunged into the lake, and escaped by swimming ; the other they took prisoner. They made prize of two baskets of guavas, a Mexican turkey, two Spanish fowls, and some maize, and then pushed for the vessels. On arriving at the sea-shore, they found their comrades joy- fully examining the tokens of civilization found by the two captains. When, however, they beheld the articles brought by Silvestre and his party, they leaped and danced about like mad. At length a surgeon, who had formerly been in Mexico, asked the Indian the name of a pair of scissors he held in his hand. He immediately called it by its Spanish name. This convinced them that they were in the territory of Mexico, and so overjoyed were they that they embraced Silvestre and his men, and hoisting that captain upon their shoulders, bore him about the shore in triumph. HOSPITABLE RECEPTION. 439 When this wild ebullition of joy was over, they inquired more particularly concerning the country. They learnt that the river into which Luis de Moscoso, with the five brigantines, had taken refuge, was the Panuco ; and that on its banks, twelve leagues above, stood a city of the same name. The Indian told them, moreover, that about a league off, lived a cacique, who could read and write, and had been educated by the priests. These joyful tidings gladdened their hearts, and having feast- ed the Indian, and given him presents, they dispatched him to the Christian cacique, with a request that he would either bring or send a supply of ink and paper. He soon returned, and with him the cacique, followed by a train of eight Indians, laden with fowls, bread of maize, and various fruits and fish, together with paper and ink. The Spaniards immediately sent off an Indian with a letter to Moscoso, giving him an account of all that had happened, and requesting 'directions as to their future move- ments. In the mean time, the governor, Moscoso, when with his five brigantines he took refuge in the river from the gale, beheld, to his great joy, several Indians on shore clothed in the Spanish fashion. Calling out to them in Spanish, he demanded in what country they were. The Indians answered in the same language, that they were on the river of Panuco, and that the town was not fifteen leagues distant. Upon this the Spaniards leaped on shore, kissed the ground repeatedly, and throwing themselves on their knees, poured out their thanks to G-od. They now made the best of their way to the town of Panuco, where, in a few days, they were rejoined by their shipwrecked comrades. Their first act on entering the town was to repair to the church, and offer up thanks to Grod for having preserved them 440 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. through so many perils and hardships. The burghers of the town crowded to the church to offer them assistance. The cor- regidor took Moscoso into his house as his guest ; the others were quartered among the inhabitants. The town was for the most part built of stone, and contained about seventy families, who lived simply but abundantly, the wealthiest not having above five hundred crowns of income. Many of the inhabitants, however, were courteous cavaliers, and all were touched with pity at beholding this forlorn remnant of the gallant armament, that had created such a noise on its outset from Cuba. The survivors in fact were blackened, haggard, shrivelled, and half naked, being clad only with the skins of deer, buffaloes, bears, and other animals, so that, says the Spanish narrator, they looked more like wild beasts than human beings. CHAPTER XCVL DISCONTENTS AND BROILS AMONG THE SOLDIERY — -THEIR SUBSEQUENT FORTUNES, 1543. The chief magistrate of Panuco dispatched a messenger forth- with to Don Antonio de Mendoza, the viceroy of Mexico, which city lay some seventy leagues distant, to apprise him that a small remnant of Hernando de Soto's army had returned from Florida. The viceroy sent word, without delay, that they should he shown every kindness and honor, and furnished with whatever was neces- sary for their journey, when sufficiently recovered from their fatigues. He accompanied his message with a supply of shirts and sandals, and also four mules laden with delicacies and medi- cines for the sick. Luis de Moscoso and his men, while sojourning in this city, had time to reflect upon the beautiful country they had abandoned, and they began to draw comparisons between it and Panuco. They found that here the people were but indifferently circum- stanced, having neither mines of gold nor silver, nor any other treasure. Their dress was mere garments of cotton ; their only source of wealth the breeding of horses, and planting mulberry- trees. They now began to retrace in memory the beautiful pro- 442 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. vinces they had discovered ; their wild fertility and prodigal abundance ; their capabilities for raising maize and grain and vegetables ; their verdant meadows and rich pasturages ; their vast tracts of woodland, watered by running streams, so well adapted to the raising of herds and flocks. Bat above all, they called to mind the treasures of pearls, which they had not appre- ciated, as each one had fancied himself lord of boundless domains. Turning these things over in their minds, they began to mur- mur among themselves. " Could we not," said they, " have dwelt in Florida as these Spaniards live in Panuco ? and had we re- mained and settled there, would we not have been more opulent than these our hosts 1 Is it well, that we should come and re- ceive alms and hospitality from others poorer than ourselves, when we might have entertained all Spain ? Is it just or credit- able to our honor, that we, who might have been chieftains, have come to beg? Better far would it have been to have bravely perished there, than to live here in poverty !" These murmurings and repinings produced violent discord among them. Their greatest rage, however, was against the offi- cers of the royal revenue, and the captains and cavaliers, who, after the death of the governor Hernando de Soto, had insisted upon leaving Florida, and had obstinately forced Luis de Mos- coso to undertake that long and disastrous journey to the pro- vince of Los Yaqueros, instead of sending two brigantines for reinforcements, as had been intended. Several affrays took place, in which blood was shed and some lives lost. The officers and cavaliers were fain to keep within doors, and the town was con- tinually distracted by the broils between the soldiery. The corregidor of Panuco, finding that this discord increased from day to day, sent word to the viceroy, Bon Antonio de Men- ARRIVAL AT MEXICO. 448 doza, who ordered them to be sent immediately to Mexico, in bands of ten and twenty, and that care should be taken to se- parate those who were at variance, lest they should fight by the road. In pursuance of this order, they left Panuco twenty-five days after their arrival there. The inhabitants along the road throng- ed to see them ; eager to behold men who had survived such toils and endured such hardships. The fame of their great sufferings and daring exploits had spread throughout the land, and both Indians and Spaniards entertained them with great kindness and hospitality throughout their journey. When they arrived at the renowned city of Mexico, throngs of the citizens flocked out to receive them, and conducted them to their homes, where they feasted them and clothed them in sumptuous apparel. The vice- roy treated the governor and his officers with distinguished at- tention, and extended his kindness to the humblest of their fol- lowers. Some of the skins and furs which the army brought with them were highly prized in Mexico. A few strings of pearls, also, which remained among them, proved to be of immense value. The beautiful martin skins, however, were valued above all. Finding that men of wealth prized so highly what they had des- pised, their despondency increased ; they brooded bitterly over their folly in abandoning a country which had cost them so dearly to discover, and where these valuable articles abounded. Discon- tented with themselves, they forgot their former companionship and brotherhood in arms, and again broke out into fierce and san- guinary brawls. The viceroy, to console them, promised that, if they desired to return to Florida, he would himself undertake the conquest 19* 444 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. of the country ; in fact, he had an inclination for the enterprise, and offered employment and salaries to many of the officers and men, to occupy them whilst he should make preparations. Some accepted these appointments ; but most of them, when put to the proof, shrunk from returning to a country where they had suffer- ed so many hardships. The enterprising spirit of the stout-hearted Juan de Anasco was somewhat broken by disappointment, and, disgusted with the new world, where he had squandered his fortune, he returned to Spain. Juan G-aytan, the treasurer, the brave Baltazar de Gal- legos, the veteran Pedro Calderon, Alonso Homo de Cardenos, Arias Tinoco, and many others of less note, followed the example of De Anasco. Gromez Suarez de Figueroa returned home, to the estate of his father, the magnificent old cavalier, Yasco Porcallo de Figueroa. Some entered into the priesthood : a few remained in New Spain, among whom was the governor, Luis de Moscoso de Alvorado, who married a relative, a woman of rank and riches in Mexico. The greatest number, however, went to seek their fortunes in Peru. CHAPTER XCVIL THE VOYAGES OF MALDONADO AND GOMEZ ARIAS IN SEARCH OP DE SOTO DEATH OF DONA ISABEL DE BOBADILLA. 1543. To close this eventful history, it only remains to give some ac- count of the movements of the two generous and loyal cavaliers Diego Moldonado and Gomez Arias. The former, as we have be- fore related, set sail from Espiritu Santo, for the Havana, with two brigantines, to visit Dona Isabel de Bobadilla, the wife of the governor Hernando de Soto ; Gromez Arias having preceded him in a caravel. These two cavaliers were to procure vessels in Ha- vana, load them with supplies of food and arms, and munitions of war, and sail for the port of Achusi in the course of the fol- lowing autumn, where De Soto, after exploring the interior of Florida, was to meet them. They accordingly joined each other in the Havana, and, hav- ing sent to all the adjacent islands an account of the discovery of Florida, purchased three vessels and freighted them with sup- plies, and also loaded down the two brigantines and the caravel in which they came. They could, moreover, have laden two other vessels ; for the inhabitants of the islands, hearing such a favor- able report of Florida, prompted by their own interest as well as 446 CONQUEST OF FLORIDA. by their love for the governor, sent all the provisions they could gather together. The two captains set sail, and reached in safety the port of Achusi ; but not finding De Soto there, they separated and coast- ed in opposite directions, thinking it probable that he might have come out at some other place, either to the eastward or west- ward. They left signals in the trees and letters in the crevices of the bark, with statements of their intended movements the following summer, and after cruising about in vain until the win- ter set in, they returned dejected to the Havana. The subse- quent summer of the year 1541, they re-visited the shores of Florida, running along the coast as far to the westward as Mex- ico, and a great distance to the eastward, but meeting with no success, they returned to the Havana on the approach of winter. Early the ensuing summer they again sailed for Florida, and af- ter having consumed seven months in fruitless search, were com- pelled by the weather to return and winter in Cuba. Determined, however, not to give up the search until they had discovered traces of De Soto, for they could not believe that every soul of the expedition had perished, as soon as the spring of 1543 opened, they once again put to sea. They cruised about all this summer, suffering grievous privations and excessive labor, and about the middle of October arrived at Vera Cruz. Here they heard the melancholy account that the Spaniards had aban- doned Florida, that only three hundred of the gallant army had escaped, and that the governor, Hernando de Soto, had perished in the country he sought to conquer. With these sad tidings the two faithful captains repaired to Havana, and imparted them to Dona Isabel de Bobadilla. During three long years she had been racked with anxiety for the safety of her husband, and now DISASTROUS RESULTS. 447 came the news of the failure of his magnificent enterprise, the loss of his vast treasures, the ruin of his estate, the downfall of his house, and his own melancholy death. It was an overwhelming blow ; Dona Isabel never held up her head from this time, but died soon after of a broken heart. Such was the fruitless and tragical end of the vaunted con- quest of Florida : one of the most splendid and chivalrous expe- ditions to the new world, and one of the most disastrous. Never had a more gallant train of youthful cavaliers embarked on a crusade beyond the ocean ; never had adventurers embarked with lighter hearts, more fearless souls, or more sanguine expectations. Their vaunting preparations in the island of Cuba, and their tri- umphant landing on the shores of Florida, partake of the swell- ing spirit of the nation and the age ; nor is it possible to follow them through their subsequent career of blasted hope and baffled enterprise, without having our admiration incessantly elicited by their defiance of danger, their persevering struggles against dif- ficulties and almost impossibilities, and their manly, unshrinking fortitude, under hardships of every kind. If at times our feelings revolt at the outrages committed by them upon the poor Indians, and by their wrongs towards those native chieftains who fought and fell so heroically in the defence of their homes ; yet, our indignation passes away and is forgot- ten in the melancholy fate of the invaders. Scarce three years had elapsed from the time of their embarkation at Cuba, when nearly the whole train of youthful cavaliers had passed away : horse and rider alike had perished, and their bones lay bleaching amidst the savage wilds of America ! APPENDIX. As the principal authority cited in the foregoing work is Garcilaso de la Vega, a few particulars concerning him and his writings may be acceptable to the reader. He was a Peruvian by birth, a native of the city of Cuzco. His father was a Spanish adventurer of noble descent, and his mother the sister of Huayna Capac, the last of the renowned Incas. Hearing much in his youth of the land of his father, he left his country and repaired to Spain, where he took up his residence at Cor- dova, and soon distinguished himself by his translation of the dialogues of love of Leon Hebreos, and by his royal commentaries on the History of the Incas. These won him the favor of the sovereigns and the es- teem of the learned. Don Gabriel Deza de Cardenas, in his preface to the second edition of Garcilaso's History of Florida, remarks, that he was admired by the world as a man of piety, virtue, modesty, and de- votion to letters, and held in the highest estimation as a historian. He died in Cordova, in 1616, and was honorably interred in the Cathedral, in one of the chapels, called the chapel of Garcilaso ; where monumen- tal inscriptions on each side of the altar record his valor, his virtues, and his literary merits. Such is the general character of Garcilaso de la Vega ; which will enable the reader in some measure to judge of his credibility as a his- torian. In his introduction to his work on Florida, he gives an account of the sources from whence he drew his facts. He says that he had frequently, and in divers places, held long conversations with an old friend, who had been present in the expedition of Hernando de Soto ; and that, struck with the achievements both of the Spaniards and 450 APPENDIX. Indians, related by this cavalier, he determined to rescue such heroic deeds from oblivion, by recording them in history. His laudable resolve was for a time, however, postponed. He was called to lay down the pen and take up the sword ; other causes concurred to separate them, and thus twenty years elapsed before he could carry his plan into ex- ecution. The desire, however, of perpetuating this heroic expedition, and the names of the brave men concerned in it, increased with his years ; and, fearing that the death either of his friend or of himself, might defeat his wishes, he left his home and took up his residence for a time in the village where the cavalier resided. Here he took down the particulars of the expedition, as related by word of mouth, questioning and re- questioning his friend minutely and repeatedly, as to persons, and places, and transactions; thus stimulating his memory, and drawing piecemeal from it those anecdotes of individual prowess and adventure which give such stirring interest and vivacity to his narrative. He does not give the name of his friend, but says he was a brave soldier, who had been present in all the scenes of the expedition, and had many times acted as leader, in the exploits he related. He adds that he was of noble rank, a hidalgo, and as such, piqued himself on ut- tering nothing but the truth. Such confidence was placed in his vera- city, that the council royal of the Indies frequently sent for him to con- sult him about the events that chanced in this and in other expeditions in which he had been engaged. Besides the oral testimony of this cavalier, the Inca informs us that he had likewise written documents from two other soldiers who were engaged in the expedition. One of them, named Alonzo de Carmona, a native of the town of Priego, having returned to Spain, wrote his '' Two Peregrinations," as he called them, in Florida and Peru. They contained brief notices of facts and circumstances, skipping from one re- markable transaction to another, without much regard to dates or places, or the regular succession of events. These memoirs he sent to Garci- laso de la Vega, for his inspection ; not knowing at the time that he was occupied on a history of the expedition. The other soldier was Juan Coles, a native of Zafra; who likewise wrote an irregular and brief notice of the principal events of the expe- dition. This he gave to a Franciscan monk, named Fray Pedro Aguado ; who incorporated it in a collection of narratives relative to the new world, APPENDIX. 451 which he intended to publish. The manuscripts of the friar, however, remained in a crude and neglected state, in the hands of a printer in Cordova; where the Inca found them, covered with dust and half de- stroyed by rats. There was nearly a ream of paper, divided into quires, in the handwriting of the different narrators. From among these the Inca extracted the manuscript of Juan Coles, shortly after he had receiv- ed that of Alonzo de Carmona. At the time that these documents fell into his hands, he had already completed his narrative, as taken from the lips of his friend; but, having now two additional eye-witnesses, he went over the whole subject anew, availing himself of the particulars thus unexpectedly furnished him, to corroborate, strengthen, and enlarge the details already recorded. Such are the sources from whence Garcilaso de la Vega derived his facts, and for which we have the guarantee of his general character as a man of judgment and veracity. His account of the expedition of Her- nando de Soto was held in such credit in former times, and by those most capable of judging, that it was incorporated almost at full length, by Herrera, the great Spanish historian, in his history of American dis- covery. ROUTE OF HERNANDO DE SOTO. To assist any future research as to the route of Hernando de Soto and his followers, we here subjoin the various marchings, the distances and points of the compass, as gleaned from different parts of the Span- ish and Portuguese narratives. They will be seen to be contradic- tory and exaggerated, and have frequently caused us great perplexity. We have endeavored to guide ourselves through the maze they present, by certain general landmarks, and by the researches of various travel- lers. Indeed, the Inca himself remarks, " I cannot hold myself responsible for the accuracy of the distances I give, for, although I have spared no exertion, and have used all diligence to arrive at the truth, yet I have been unavoidably compelled to leave much to conjecture. The Span- iards had no instruments with them by which they could compute dis- tances ; their main object was to conquer the country, and seek for sil- 452 APPENDIX. ver and gold ; consequently, they gave themselves little trouble to note down the route." De Soto and his followers, says the Inca, landed at the bay of Espi- ritu Santo, whence they marched a little more than two leagues in a north-east direction, and halted at the village of Hirrihigua : resuming their march to the north-east, a journey of twenty-five leagues brought them to the village of Urribarracuxi. Hence to the province of Acuera, where they next arrived, was twenty leagues. Departing from Acuera, and marching towards the north, and sometimes to the north-east, about twenty leagues, they came to the town of Ocali; here they crossed the river Ocali, and, journeying sixteen leagues, reached Ochile; a frontier village of the province of Vitachuco. The Spaniards, says the Inca, marched more than fifty leagues through this province. We next find them in the village of Vitachuco : setting out from thence, they march- ed four leagues, to the river of Osachile; crossing this, they continued on six leagues, and came to the village of Osachile. Twelve leagues further they found the great swamp ; traversing this, which was one league and a half across, they continued on six leagues, and were arrest- ed by a deep stream : — having crossed this, they marched four leagues, to the chief village of Apalachee, where they went into winter quarters. The Inca states here, that the bay of Aute was about four leagues dis- tant. Leaving Apalachee, the ensuing spring, they marched to the north- ward five days, and came to the province of Atapaha : ten days more brought them to the province of Achalaque.* They were five days in traversing this province, and in four days more, came to the frontier village of the province of Cofa. Leaving this village, in six or seven days they came to the province of Cofaqui: from thence, a march of seven days brought them to a river ; marching up this for twelve leagues, they came to a frontier village of the province of Cofachiqui ; in four days more they arrived at Cofachiqui. Quitting this province, they came, at the end of eight days, to the province of Chalaque. Three days more brought them to the province of Xuala. The Inca here, observes, that the Spaniards were fifty-seven days * It will be seen, by referring to chap. xl. of our work, that we consider the Inca under a mistake in bringing them so soon to this province. "We pre- fer the Portuguese account, which makes their arrival a month later. APPENDIX. 453 marching from Apalachee to Xuala. He supposes that they must have marched about four leagues and a half a day ; and that, consequently, Xuala must have been nearly two hundred and fifty leagues from the pro- vince of Apalachee, and about four hundred from the bay of Espiritu Santo. They now struck, he says, in a westwardly direction, making a bend to the south ; and in five days came to the province of Guaxule. A march of six days more, or thirty leagues, brought them to Ychiaha : their next journey was to the village of Acoste, five leagues from Ychiaha. Leaving this, they traversed the province of Cosa, and in twenty-three or four days came to the village of Cosa, which was more than a hundred leagues distant from Acoste. Continuing onward towards the south, five days' march brought them to the town of Talise ; a jour- ney of five or six days more found them in Tascaluza, and marching two leagues further, they halted in the town of Mauvila. From thence, De Soto, to avoid the sea, struck northwardly, and, marching seven days, came to the village of Chicaza. A league distant from this village was Chicacilla, where they passed the winter. Setting out the following spring, the first place they arrived at was Alibamo, four or five leagues from Chicacilla ; a march of three days brought them to the village of Chisca, on the banks of the Mississippi. Following up along the banks of this river four days, they crossed it, and marching four or five days longer, they came to the village of Casquin. A journey of six days brought them to Capaha: from thence the army returned to the village of Casquin. Leaving that town behind them, they continued down along the river nine days, when they reached the village of Quiguate. Still following the course of the river, in five days they came to Colima. The next province they reached was Tula, ten days' journey form the last ; a march of six days more brought them to the town of Utiangue, where they wintered. In the spring, the army resumed its wanderings, and in seven days came to the village of Naguatex. A march of five days brought them to the frontiers of the province of Guancane, which they were eight days in traversing. From thence they struck in a south-eastwardly direction, to reach the Mississippi. They traversed seven provinces, a distance, the Inca conjectures, of about one hundred and twenty leagues, and arrived at the province of Anilco. Marching through this province for thirty leagues, they came to the village of Anilco — a journey of four days 454 APPENDIX. further, brought them to the province of Guachoya, where De Soto died. The army, he says, set out for the westward, under Luis de Mosco- so, and marching more than a hundred leagues, came to the province of Auche. Continuing on for six or seven days, they arrived at the prov- ince of los Vaqueros : they penetrated more than thirt)^ leagues into this province, when their westward march was arrested by the sight of lofty mountains. From hence they set out on their return to the Missis- sippi, and making a bend to the southward, arrived at the village of Ami- noya, three months from the time of their departure from Guachoya. The whole distance of their march to the west of the Mississippi, going and returning, he computes to have been more than three hundred and fifty leagues. Garcilaso de la Vega remarks, that it is difficult to give precisely the length of the voyage of the Spaniards down the Mississippi, as they were so engaged in fighting that they had not time to calculate the pro- bable distance ; but he adds, that some time afterwards, in Mexico, they consulted among themselves, in the presence of some men skilled in maritime matters ; and it was computed, that having had the aid of sails and oars, the average of a day and a night must have been about five and twenty leagues : and as they were nineteen days and nights in per- forming the voyage, the whole distance was not far short of five hun- dred leagues. According to the memorandum of Juan Coles, he says, it was considered seven hundred leagues. Garcilaso adds that the Mis- sissippi, at Aminoya, was nineteen fathoms deep, and a quarter of a league wide ; and that some persons, who pretended to a knowledge of cosmography, asserted, that from this place, where the Spaniards em- barked, to where the river takes its rise, was three hundred leagues, and some aver much more ; but I adopt, says he, the opinion most within bounds, which would make this river eight hundred leagues in extent, which was the distance the Spaniards penetrated into the country. Having given a sketch of the route as stated by the Inca in his Nar- rative, we annex a memorandum of the route accorning to the Portu- guese Narrator. From the port of the Holy Ghost (Espiritu Santo), he says, the army marched round the bay about two leagues, and came to the town APPENDIX. 455 of Ucita : from thence they went thirty leagues to the province of Par- acoxi : marching on, through the small villages Acela and Jocaste, they came to Cale ; leaving Cale, they passed through Itara and Potano, and on the third day came to Utimama. They next came to a habitation, which he says the Spaniards called de Mala Paz, and from thence went to Cholupaba. Here they crossed a river, and having marched two days, arrived at Caliquen ; five days' march brought them to Napetaca : con- tinuing on by Pelaya, they next reached Uzachil — in two days' march they came to Axille. Having crossed a river, they halted in Vitachuco, a village of the province of Palache. Passing through the town of Uzelu, they came to Anhayca of Palache, where they went into winter quarters. He says the sea was only ten leagues distance from this place. On the third of March they left Anhayca of Palache, and came to Copachiqui on the eleventh ; continuing on, they arrived at Toalli on the twenty-first of the same month. Leaving Toalli the twenty-third, they crossed a river and came to Achese. Resuming their journey on the first of April, they were at Altaraca on the fourth, and arrived at Ocute on the tenth : they parted form Ocute on the twelfth, and passing through Cafaqui, they came to Patofa. The narrator here observes, that it is fifty leagues from Ocute to Patofa, and not less than three hundred and sixty leagues from Ocute to Espiritu Santo. Leaving Patofa, they marched nine days, at the rate of seven or eight leagues a day, crossing two large rivers, and encamped in a desert. From hence they marched about twelve or thirteen leagues, and came to a small village called Aymay — they next arrived at the province of Cutifachiqui, two days' journey distant from Aymay. Departing from Cutifachiqui, they marched a hundred leagues in this province, and came to Chalaque — a journey of five days more brought them to the province of Xualla. The narrator observes here, that from Ocute to Cutifachiqui, it is reckoned a hundred and thirty leagues, and from Cutifachiqui to Xualla, two hundred and fifty. Leaving Xualla, they came in five days to Quaxule — two days' march brought them to Canasaqua : they jour- neyed on five days, and came to Chiaha. The next town they reached was Acoste, seven days' journey distant. On the ninth of July the army left Acoste, and went to Tali ; and thence to Cosa, where they ar- rived on the fifteenth. They parted from Cosa on the twentieth, and passing through Tallimuchase, Ulliballi, and Toasi, arrived at Tallise on 456 APPENDIX. the eighteenth of September. The narrator remarks in this place, that they usually marched five or six leagues a day in countries that were in- habited; but in the wilderness they journeyed as far as possible, lest they should be straitened for want of provisions. He says, that it is computed that Tascaluza is twenty leagues south of Cosa — Cosa one hundred and eighty leagues west of Xualla— Xualla two hundred and fifty leagues north of Cutifachiqui — Cutifachiqui four hundred and thirty leagues north-east of Palache — and Palache one hundred west from Espiritu Santo. — Leaving Tallise, the Spaniards passed through Ca- siste, and came to the town of Piache ; here they crossed a wide river, and continuing on, arrived at Maville the eighteenth of October. They departed from Maville the eighteenth of November, and in five days en- tered the province of Pafallaya : they passed through the villages of Taliepatave and Cabusto, and crossing a wide river, arrived at Chicasa, on the eighteenth of December. Here they went into winter quarters. Resuming their march in the spring, they came to the village of Alimamu — hence they journeyed seven days, and arrived at Quizquiz : a march of half a league brought them to the Mississippi. From Tasca- luza to the great river, observes the narrator, we reckon three hundred leagues. Crossing this river, they marched a league and a half, to a village in the province of Aquixo ; continuing on, they came to the village of Cas- qui — they next reached the village of Pacaha, about a day's journey distant from Casqui. Returning to the latter place, they continued their march, and arrived at Quigate, which was one hundred and twenty leagues from Pacaha. Leaving Quigate, they marched about forty leagues to the province of Coligoa. Five days more brought them to Palisema: they next came to Tafalicoya. Four days' journey distant was the province of Cayas, which they entered, and halted in the town of Tanico. After a march of three days they came to Tulla : they next arrived, at the end of five days, at Quipana. Continuing onward, they passed through Anoixi and Catamaya, and arrived at Autiamque, where they passed the winter. Setting out from Autiamque on the sixth of March, they passed through the province of Ayays, and came to the town of Tultelpina. After three days' march, they arrived at Tianto ; and the next day, the fifteenth of March, they came to Nilco. Soon after, they came to APPENDIX. 457 Guachoya, where De Soto dies. Luis de Moscoso set out on the fifth of June, and passing through the province of Catalte arrived at Chagu- ate on the twentieth. Three days' journey from thence brought them to the province of Aguacay. They continued on, and passing by Pato, on the fourth day came to the province of Maye : — they next reached Naguatex. At the end of three days' march, they came to the small hamlet of Missobone : thence they passed through Lacane, Mondacao, and the province of Aays, and arrived at Soeatino. After twenty days' march, they came to the province of Guasco. They continued on to the river Daycao, ten days' journey from Guasco, where they arrived in the beginning of October. The narrator says here, that from Daycao to the great river it was one hundred and fifty leagues, which they had travelled, marching always to the westward. From hence they set out on their return, and passing through Nag- uatex, Chaguete, and the town of Cilano, arrived at Nilco in the begin- ning of December : from thence they went two days' journey to Minoya. Here they embarked upon the Mississippi. Their course, he says, con- tinued seventeen days, in which time they made two hundred and fifty leagues. THE END. '" W10 6 G : s: Hi L* N I* »<11 V © N '."..*««* *o ^ ,/ % £*• ^ a* *VrfW> ^ V £* *-<# ♦ *~ ♦ " N ^ ^ WERT BOOKBINDING Grantville, Pa- May— |uoe 1965 Wt'rt Qmfcr *eu«* t • o °o » « »